Skip to main content

Kitchens

Black & Decker The Complete Guide to Kitchens - Do-it-yourself and Save,Third Edition

Source: Black & Decker The Complete Guide to Kitchens - Do-it-yourself and Save,Third Edition.pdf

Source file: Black & Decker The Complete Guide to Kitchens - Do-it-yourself and Save,Third Edition.pdf

                                Mantesh

                                          DVD
                                          INCLUDED

THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO

kitchenS Do-It-Yourself and Save • 3rd Edition • Design & Planning • Quick Updates • Custom Cabinetry • Remodeling Projects On Budget

       MINNEAPOLIS, Minnesota
          www.creativepub.com

                                                                                                                                                                                                       Mantesh

                                                                                                                            Contents
                                                                                                                            Introduction  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  . . 5

                                                                                                                            PLANNING & DESIGN  .  .  .  .  . . 7
                                                                                                                            Gallery of Kitchen Ideas  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  . 8

Copyright © 2009 President/CEO: Ken Fund Creative Publishing international, Inc. VP for Sales & Marketing: Kevin Hamric Design Standards … … … … … . 18 400 First Avenue North, Suite 300 Minneapolis, Minnesota 55401 Home Improvement Group Remodeling Plans … … … … … . 24 1‑800‑328‑0590 www.creativepub.com Publisher: Bryan Trandem Budget & Finance … … … … … . 30 All rights reserved Managing Editor: Tracy Stanley Senior Editor: Mark Johanson Printed in China Editor: Jennifer Gehlhar CABINETS … … … … . . 37

10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Creative Director: Michele Lanci‑Altomare Cabinet Selection … … … … … . 38 Senior Design Managers: Brad Springer, Jon Simpson Two-level Tile Island … … … … . . 134 Sheet Vinyl … … … … … … … . 224 Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data Design Manager: James Kegley New Cabinet Prep … … … … … . 42 Concrete Countertop Island … … . . 138 Resilient Tile … … … … … … . . 230 The complete guide to kitchens : with DVD : do-it-yourself and Lead Photographer: Joel Schnell Cabinet Installation … … … … … 48 save, design & planning, quick updates, custom cabinetry, major Photo Coordinator: Cesar Fernandez Rodriquez Island Vent Hood … … … … … . 146 Laminate Flooring … … … … … . 234 remodeling projects. — 3rd edl. Production Managers: Linda Halls, Laura Hokkanen Freestanding Cabinets … … … … 56 p. cm. At head of title: Black & Decker. Contributing Writer: Karen Ruth Cabinet Upgrades … … … … … . 58 FIXTURES & APPLIANCES . . .151 LIGHTING … … … … . . 241 Includes index. Page Layout Artist: Shanda Nelson Summary: “Includes information on installing and updating all Shop Help: Charles Boldt Slide-out Storage … … … … … . . 60 Appliance & Fixture Selection … … . 152 Lighting Selection … … … … … . 242 areas of a kitchen, including cabinets, countertops, flooring, lighting and appliances”—Provided by publisher. Cover Photography Credit: Todd Caverly Pull-down Shelves … … … … … . 64 Ranges, Ovens & Cooktops … … . . 158 Ceiling Lights … … … … … … . . 246 ISBN-13: 978-1-58923-480-2 (soft cover) ISBN-10: 1-58923-480-4 (soft cover) Customizing Cabinets … … … … . 66 Refrigerator Icemaker … … … … . 160 Canister Lights … … … … … … 250

  1. Kitchens—Remodeling—Amateurs’ manuals. I. Title. Vertical Dividers … … … … … . . 68 Dishwasher … … … … … … … 164 Undercabinet Lights … … … … . . 254 TH4816.3.K58C655 2009 643’.3—dc22 Customizing Cabinets … … … … . 70 Food Disposer … … … … … … . 172 EASY UPDATES … … … 259 2009020710 Kitchen Cabinet Paint … … … … . 82 Range Hood/Vent Fan … … … … . 178 Painting … … … … … … … … 260 Drop-in Sink … … … … … … … 182 COUNTERTOPS … … … . 85 Childproofing … … … … … … . . 264 The Complete Guide to Kitchens Created by: The Editors of Creative Publishing international, Inc. in cooperation with Black & Decker. Undermount Sink … … … … … . 184 Countertop Selection … … … … . 86 Convert a Closet to Black & Decker® is a trademark of The Black & Decker Corporation and is used under license. Apron Sink … … … … … … … . 190 Pull-out Pantry … … … … … . 266 Post-form Countertop … … … … . 92 New Banquette … … … … … … 268 NOTICE TO READERS Butcher Block Countertop … … … 96 Kitchen Faucets … … … … … … 196

For safety, use caution, care, and good judgment when following the procedures described in this book. The Publisher Kitchen Drains & Traps … … … . . 200 Garden Window … … … … … … 272 Laminate Countertop … … … … . 102 and Black & Decker cannot assume responsibility for any damage to property or injury to persons as a result of mis- Hot Water Dispenser … … … … . 204 Framed Soffits … … … … … … . 276 use of the information provided. Tile Countertop … … … … … … 110 The techniques shown in this book are general techniques for various applications. In some instances, additional Pot Filler … … … … … … … . 208 Granite Countertop … … … … … 120 techniques not shown in this book may be required. Always follow manufacturers’ instructions included with products, Conversion Charts … … 280 Carbon Water Filter … … … … . . 210 since deviating from the directions may void warranties. The projects in this book vary widely as to skill levels required: Tile Backsplash … … … … … … 124 some may not be appropriate for all do-it-yourselfers, and some may require professional help. Reverse-Osmosis Filtration System . 212 Resources … … … … . 282 Consult your local Building Department for information on building permits, codes, and other laws as they apply to ISLANDS … … … … . . 129 your project. FLOORING … … … … . 219 Photo Credits … … … . 283 Kitchen Island Selection … … … . . 130

                                                                                                                            Stock-Cabinet Island .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  . 132          Flooring Selection .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  . 220              Index .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  .  . 284

Introduction I n recent years, kitchens have received an enormous amount of attention from high-end design magazines, television home décor shows, and even manufacturers of expensive appliances. Without question, the trendsetters in the industry have concocted some amazing rooms with jaw-dropping features. In fact, the kitchens we see featured in most media today are primarily room sets built purely to showcase an impressive style rather than pleasing, efficient rooms from which we feed our families and carry on those “kitchen table discussions” politicians are always talking about. That’s okay: everyone loves to dream about surrounding themselves with beauty, opulence, and state-of-the-art living accessories. But if, like most of us, your goal is to find a few practical ways to make your kitchen better meet your needs (and maybe show off just a little bit), then you need a guide that features rooms that look something like your house. The Complete Guide to Kitchens is exactly that kind of book. In this freshly updated edition, we show you dozens of instant-payback projects that make your kitchen brighter and easier to use—from painting the walls to updating the lighting, childproofing cabinets and appliances, or installing pull-out shelves to convert a broom closet into an efficient pantry. We also cover some more involved kitchen improvements, such as installing all-new cabinets and countertops or replacing the flooring. These are all projects that can be done by most do-it-yourselfers with moderate skills. And for the most part they require more elbow grease than capital. Because so much activity in kitchens centers around major household appliances, we show you how to hook up and maintain your refrigerator, stove, icemaker, water filter, and more. By doing it yourself you can save money, but you’ll also build the skills to be prepared for an appliance emergency. Plus, you can do the work on your own schedule—no setting aside a full day just so you can wait for a delivery or a repair call. For the truly ambitious homeowner who has more advanced carpentry skills, we even show you how to build your own custom cabinets yourself—the ultimate “luxury you can afford”. The Complete Guide to Kitchens reflects the most current design thinking on relevant issues that matter today. Throughout this book, you’ll find pointers about eco-friendly options, shopping tips to clue you in on features to look for, and notes on Universal Design, which creates accessibility for a wide range of people. After all, if your kitchen doesn’t meet your needs, it doesn’t work—no matter how fancy it may look. The kitchen is the most frequently remodeled room in the house. From modest makeovers to down-to-the-studs re-dos, planning and know-how are the variables that make the difference between creating a kitchen that really meets your long-term needs versus one that you’ll be remodeling again in a couple of years. The Complete Guide to Kitchens is the best tool you’ll buy to ensure that your kitchen project has real staying power.

                                                                                                                   ■ 5

Planning & Design T he initial step for any home improvement project is to assess the space you already have and to develop a firm concept for the ideal appearance and function. Although most of us have a fair idea which styles (traditional, contemporary, etc.) we generally gravitate toward, today’s vast selection of materials, appliances, and upgrades has complicated the process of choosing products and materials. With so many customizable options—from cabinet hardware to floor tiles—the possibilities can seem endless. Whether you’re looking for a dramatic transformation or simply an easy update, however, you should consider these vast selections to be opportunities for making your kitchen project a success—perhaps in ways you hadn’t imagined. In this chapter you’ll find a portfolio of kitchens and kitchen details that display a wide range of achievable ideas. These well-selected images represent a good starting point, but with just a little exploring you’ll find a small universe of additional shots from other sources, including magazines, television shows, design groups, design centers, or trade association websites (see Resources, page 282). Following the gallery of ideas section, you’ll find some helpful, highly practical information on kitchen design and the fundamental strategies for devising a remodeling plan.

This chapter shows: • Gallery of Kitchen Ideas • Design Standards • Remodeling Plans • Budget & Finance

                                                   ■ 7

Gallery of Kitchen Ideas This classic look carries on the long- standing tradition of painted cabinetry in the kitchen. Darker countertops and shades soften the room. Subway tile and a fireclay sink add extra reflection.

The Shaker style cabinetry and colonial colors in this kitchen combine with knotty wood flooring for an old-fashioned yet completely fresh look.

                                                                                                                                  Although its visual effect is minimized by the wood                Even a galley kitchen can be laid out to create efficient
                                                                                                                                  panel door coverings and trimwork, a large side-by-side re‑        workflow. In a two-sided galley, the main issues are to leave
                                                                                                                                  frigerator is a hallmark of a restaurant-inspired kitchen. Other   enough space between opposing sides and to locate the sink
                                                                                                                                  giveaways include massive amounts of countertop and island         and stove close together.
                                                                                                                                  work surface.

Glass lites add interest and gleam to a kitchen, but if you are Simple, geometric lines, warm wood tones, and natural not a stickler for cabinet organization look for multi-lite doors stone countertops can be found in kitchens of just about with frosted or textured glass. any style. But this kitchen makes clever use of a couple of additional details to pull a feeling of rustic appeal from these raw elements. Specifically, the tile backsplash and the framed cabinets.

8 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Planning & Design ■ 9

Homework has become yet another function of the kitchen. A spacious breakfast bar offers a comfortable, supervised Air drying dishes uses zero energy and does not spread bacteria Living in an apartment or small townhome with a modest space where kids can finish up school work while dinner is being prepared. or other contaminants as cloth-drying can. These wall-hung metal kitchen can mean you need to incorporate other elements into shelves function as drying racks because they are positioned the room’s function. Choose appliances that blend with your directly over the integral drainboard that’s cast into the countertop. décor and use cabinetry to tie it all together visually.

Kitchens invite conviviality, so why not plan for it? By creating dedicated seating and eating areas adjacent to the kitchen, a Flow is as important for the eye as it is for the feet. If you direct the feet to move toward an eye-catching feature, like this chef who enjoys entertaining can insert himself or herself into the fun without creating obstacles that can threaten the delicate picture window with a stunning skyline view, the eye tends to keep going after the feet stop. timing of a gourmet meal.

10 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Planning & Design ■ 11

                                                                                                                                                                                                 Streamlined details make small kitchens appear larger.
                                                                                                                                                                                                 Here, contemporary flat-front cabinets with sleek handles
                                                                                                                                                                                                 allow the furnishings and décor to be the room’s focus.

A minimalist’s dream, this contemporary kitchen makes a dramatic design statement mostly by virtue of what it leaves out. A concrete countertop and matching backsplash work with the clean lines of the bamboo drawer and door fronts to create a soothing effect. What else do you really need?

Counter space can double as an eating space in many kitchens. Provide approximately 24” per seated diner. Fitted pieces create the appearance of furniture rather than cabinets. Choosing pieces with legs and eliminating toe kicks helps emphasize this custom look.

12 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Planning & Design ■ 13

Elements of a commercial kitchen include a stainless steel side-by-side refrigerator and specialty appliances. The sink and Traditional materials don’t have to be dull. Here, old-world clay tile makes a lively backsplash and the painted wood cabinets faucet also elevate the appearance of this residential kitchen. The multi-lite cabinet doors offset the commercial look just enough topped with butcher block countertop are on-trend in any modern kitchen. to keep the room from feeling too institutional.

Fun colors, playful shapes, and unusual textures don’t cost Freestanding kitchen furnishings offer convenience, ease Black and white never go out of style. If you’d rather not any more than ordinary ones, but they can create a delightful of installation, and excellent portability—you may end up liking revamp your kitchen every couple of years to keep up with the and unexpected kitchen environment. them so much that you take them with you when you move. latest trends, you can’t go wrong with this classic combo.

14 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Planning & Design ■ 15

Glass mirrors and stainless steel create a repeating theme of An apron sink and plantation shutters add rustic, rural charm Modern results can come from the most ancient materials. This ultra-contemporary Open shelving adds visual interest to this reflection and brightness in kitchens. to this kitchen. The wall-mounted faucet set and cut-marble backsplash is fashioned with edge-glued strips of bamboo—just about the oldest contemporary setting. countertop complete the effect. building material known to man.

                                                                                                                               Bamboo makes an exceptionally beautiful and durable                An undermount sink and a single-body faucet make up
                                                                                                                               cabinet material and is commonly available with blond (natural)    a one-two punch that is a current favorite among kitchen

This semicircular raised eating area echoes the shape of Glass doors brighten the cabinets above this sink, relieving and various darker colors. designers. The combination is also highly practical because it is the range hood, softening the room’s dynamic lines. shadows in corners. easy to clean and thoroughly hygienic.

16 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Planning & Design ■ 17

Design Standards Common Kitchen Layouts Galley W hile you may imagine that the answer to every cramped kitchen is to knock down walls and add more space, that’s often not the easiest or best L-shape: This corner kitchen layout can feel roomier than it is in reality, because of the L-shape floor plan. However, the two “arms” might also create solution. One alternative to tearing down the walls is an awkward workstation, with little room to set to install windows for light. An extra door or even a items down midway through a meal. Consider taking pass-through window—from the kitchen to an adja- advantage of the lost central space with a counter- cent room—can also help make the space feel more height dining table that can double as a prep station or airy. In short, the cramped feeling may only be one of even a freestanding central island. perception. U-shape: This layout takes the benefits of a gal- Most kitchens fall into one of four categories: ley kitchen—space-saving solution plus accessibility Galley, L-shaped, U-shaped, and Open Plan. Whether for one user—and adds a third wall to create the ulti- they are small or large, old or new, these floor plans mate triangular floor plan. In a compact space, placing have proven to be popular models for efficient kitch- the sink at the far end with the refrigerator and range ens, though that doesn’t mean they’ll necessarily be on opposing walls creates a simple workstation. On a the most efficient for your needs. larger scale, a sizable island can anchor the center of the room and provide more storage. Galley: In small homes or city apartments, the Open Plan: Whether the kitchen is located in galley kitchen is a space-saving choice that is ideal for the middle of a larger great room or off to one side, one or two users. The components may all be lined up an open plan layout works best with the addition of along one wall or divided between two parallel walls. a central island or a dividing counter of some type. For this floor plan to work best, the central galley Perfect for family kitchens or entertaining spaces space should be large enough to allow all appliances to where the cooks can easily visit with guests, it’s impor- be open at the same time, with enough space remain- tant for this floor plan to be well organized so that all ing for someone to walk through the middle. necessities are close at hand. L-Shape U-Shape

                                                                             Whichever layout plan you opt for, the
                                                                             most fundamental principle that you don’t
                                                                             want to violate is to maintain plenty of free
                                                                             area between appliances, sinks, and other
                                                                             elements of the work triangle. In a galley
                                                                             kitchen like the one seen here, the corridor
                                                                             between kitchen walls should be at least
                                                                             4 ft. wide, and preferably wider.

                                                                                                                              Open Plan

18 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Planning & Design ■ 19

    Whether you are doing the work yourself or hiring            Another set of guidelines, known as standards,              If two people frequently work in the kitchen          others may not have enough space to accommodate

others, once you have a good idea of the features you are informal recommendations developed over time simultaneously, the layout should include two work the classic triangle. want in your new kitchen, it’s time to create detailed by kitchen designers, cabinetmakers, and appliance triangles. In a two-triangle kitchen, the triangles may For general traffic design, it is recommended to plan drawings. Good planning drawings will help you manufacturers. These design standards suggest share one side, but they should not cross one another. leave 4-feet “corridors” between all stationary items in several phases of the planning process: parameters for good kitchen layout and following them Don’t fret too much if you can’t make the triangle for walking comfort. Some designers will allow this helps ensure that your kitchen is comfortable and layout work perfectly. Some kitchens, for example, standard to be reduced to 3 feet in smaller kitchens. • Selecting cabinets and appliances to fit your convenient to use. may have four workstations instead of three, and kitchen layout; • Soliciting accurate work bids when negotiating with plumbers, electricians, and other subcontractors; ■ Guidelines for Layout The goal of any kitchen layout is to make the cook’s • Obtaining a building permit at your local Building work easier and, where possible, to allow other people Industry Standards ▸ inspections office; to enjoy the same space without getting in the way. • Scheduling the stages of a remodeling project; Understanding the accepted design standards can • Evaluating the work of contractors. If a carpenter help you determine whether your present layout is or cabinetmaker fails to meet your expectations, sufficient or if your kitchen needs a more radical Standard Appliance Dimensions your plan drawings serve as proof that the layout change or expansion. A classic kitchen design contractor did not complete the work as agreed. concept, the work triangle theory, proposes that the Appliance Standard Minimum Comments sink, range, and refrigerator be arranged in a triangular Dimensions (width) Countertop space layout according to the following guidelines: Refrigerator 30” to 36” 15” on latch side 12 cu. ft. for family of four;

■ Codes & Standards • Position of the triangle should be such that traffic

                                                                                                                          Sink         27" single
                                                                                                                                       36" double
                                                                                                                                                      24" on one side
                                                                                                                                                      18" on other side
                                                                                                                                                                                                        2 cu. ft. for each additional person
                                                                                                                                                                                                        Minimum of 3" of countertop space
                                                                                                                                                                                                        between sink and edge of base cabinet

Creating plans for a kitchen can seem like an over- flow will not disrupt the main functions of the whelming challenge, but fortunately there are guide- Range 30”, 36” 15” on one side kitchen; 9” on other side lines available to help you. Some of these guidelines • Total distance between the corners of the triangle Cooktop 30”, 36”, 42”, 15” on one side If a window is positioned above a are legal regulations specified by your local building should be no more than 26 feet and no less than 12 48” 9” on other side cooking appliance, the bottom edge of code and must be followed exactly. Most codes have feet; the window casing must be at least 24” very specific rules for basic construction, as well as for • Each side of the triangle should be between 4 feet above the cooking surface plumbing and electrical installations. and 9 feet in length. Wall oven 24”, 27”, 30” 15” on either side Oven bottom should be between 24” and 48” above the floor Microwave 19”, 24”, 30” 15” on either side When built in, place low in wall cabinets or just under counter The work triangle is a layout concept that lets you develop a convenient arrangement of the range, sink, and refrigerator in Eating Surface Standards Cabinet Standards the kitchen.

                                                                                                                            Height of Eating Surface   30"       36"      42"                Recommended Minimum For Size of Kitchen

                                                                                                                                                                                                                Less than       More than
                                                                                                                            Min. width for             30"       24"      24"
                                                                                                                                                                                                                150 sq. ft.     150 sq. ft.
                                                                                                                            each seated diner
                                                                                                                                                                                             Base cabinets       13 lin. ft.      16 lin. ft.
                                                                                                                            Min. depth for each        19"       15"      12"
                                                                                                                            seated diner                                                     Wall cabinets       12 lin. ft.      15.5 lin. ft.

                                                                                                                            Minimum knee space         19"       15"      12"                Roll-out shelving 10 lin. ft.        13.75 lin. ft.

20 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Planning & Design ■ 21

    The sizes of base cabinets and wall cabinets are                          Not every manufacturer will offer all these sizes                                                                   but kitchen designers have additional recommendations:

fairly uniform among manufacturers, and unless you have them custom-built in unusual sizes, they will and styles, so it’s a good idea to obtain product catalogs when planning the layout of cabinets. Some ■ Door Guidelines • A general lighting circuit (120-volt, 15-amp) that Exterior entry doors should be at least 36 inches wide conform to the following standards: other tips: operates independently from plug-in outlets; and 80 inches high. Interior passage doors between • Plentiful task lighting, usually mounted under wall rooms must be at least 30 inches wide. A kitchen must • Base cabinets: height 341⁄2”; depth 23 to 24”; width • Use functional corner cabinets rather than cabinets or soffits, to illuminate each work area; have at least two points of entry, arranged so traffic 9 to 48”, in 3” increments. “blind” cabinets that provide no access to • Decorative lighting fixtures to highlight attractive patterns don’t intrude on work areas. • Wall cabinets: height 12”, 15”, 18”, 24”, 30”, 33”, 42”; the corner area; cabinets or other features of the kitchen. depth 12”; width 24”, 30”, 33”, 36”, 42”, 48”. • Include at least five storage/organizing units, • Oven cabinets: height 84”, 96”; depth 24”; such as swing-out pantry units, appliance ■Service Guidelines for Electrical • width 27”, 30”, 33”. Utility cabinets: height 84”; depth 12”, 24”; width garages, and specialized drawers or shelves. & Lighting Most major kitchen-remodeling projects require some ■ Plumbing Guidelines 18”, 24”, 36”. Eating areas. Kitchen tabletops and countertops used Minimum plumbing requirements for kitchens are for dining are generally positioned 30”, 36”, or 42” upgrading of the electrical service. While your old enforced by your local code agency and many times above the floor, and the recommended space for each kitchen may be served by a single 120-volt circuit, it’s are based on the Uniform Plumbing Codes (UPC). person varies according to the height of the surface. not uncommon for a large modern kitchen to require Like the NEC, the UPC is updated every three years, as many as seven individual circuits, including a pair so make sure you are working with current information Islands. A kitchen island should be positioned so there of dedicated 20-amp small-appliance circuits. In a (the best way to assure this is to involve your local is at least 36” of clear space between the edges of its few cases, the extra demands of the new kitchen may building inspector). Most codes relate to the size and countertop and surrounding walls or cabinets. require that the main electrical service for your entire material of water supply lines, the amount of pitch Maximum house be upgraded by an electrician. By comparing height 80” on branch drain lines, and venting of drain lines. The the electrical service in your present kitchen with the ■Construction Guidelines for Basic requirements described below, you’ll get an idea of how extensive your electrical service improvements types of fittings and transitions that may be used also are closely watched by inspectors. For example, old-style saddle valves that pierce supply lines to feed will need to be. Your plan drawings should indicate an auxiliary fixture, such as an icemaker, have been Plans for a major remodeling project that involves the locations of all the outlets, lighting fixtures, and disallowed by virtually every municipality. moving or adding walls or building a new room electrical appliances in your new kitchen. addition must accurately show the locations and Many areas enforce kitchen codes that are ■Air-conditioning 12” dimensions of the new walls and all doors and based on the National Electric Code (NEC) Heating, Ventilation & windows. This will allow the construction carpenter Minimum 18” to give you an accurate bid on the work and will standards. Among the more important NEC Guidelines requirements are: allow him to obtain the necessary building permits. Detailed plan drawings should show the locations of If you will be moving walls or adding windows or • Two small-appliance circuits (120-volt, 20-amp) heating/air-conditioning registers or fixtures in your doors, you must identify load-bearing walls and to supply power for the refrigerator and plug-in kitchen. If you’re planning a cosmetic makeover or a Sink 80” provide appropriate support during removal countertop appliances; simple layout change, there is a pretty good chance and rebuilding. • Wall outlets spaced no more than 12 ft. apart; you can get by with the same registers, radiators, or 44” • Countertop outlets spaced no more than 4 ft. apart; heaters found in your present kitchen. But if your

                                                        36"
                                                                          ■ Window Guidelines                                          • GFCI (ground-fault circuit interrupter) protected
                                                                                                                                           receptacles installed in any general use outlet,
                                                                                                                                                                                                  new kitchen will be substantially larger than it is now
                                                                                                                                                                                                  or if the ratio of wall space filled by glass windows
                                                                          Most building codes require that kitchens have at                whether above the counter or at floor level,           and doors will be greater, it’s possible that you’ll need
                                                                          least one window with at least 10 sq. feet of glass              including receptacles that are mounted inside          to expand its heating and cooling capacity. Unless
                                                  24"                     area. Some local building codes, however, will                   cabinets;                                              you happen to be a mechanical engineer, you’ll need
                                                                          allow windowless kitchens, so long as they have              • Dedicated circuits for each major appliance. Install a   to consult a professional to evaluate your heating/
                                                                          proper venting. Obviously, if your kitchen does                  20-amp, 120-volt circuit for a built-in microwave,     ventilation/air-conditioning (HVAC) system. The code
   36" min.             3 1⁄2" min.                                       not have an exterior wall it cannot have a window                a 15-amp circuit for the dishwasher and food           requirements for room heating are quite simple, but
                                                                          (although a skylight is a great solution if it makes             disposer. An electric range, cooktop, or wall oven     the methods used to calculate required energy needs
                                          15"                             sense structurally). Kitchen designers recommend                 generally requires a dedicated circuit with service    of a room are fairly complex.
              3" min.                                                     that kitchens have windows, doors, or skylights that             ratings of at least 50 amps and 240 volts.                  Finally, your cooktop should be equipped with an
                                   24"                                    together have a total glass surface area equal to at                                                                    electric vent hood to exhaust cooking fumes, smoke,
                             30"                                          least 25 percent of the total floor area.                        The electric code only requires that a kitchen         and moisture from the kitchen. The minimum volume
                                                                                                                                       have some form of lighting controlled by a wall switch,    of air moved by a vent fan is specified by code, so you

Dimensions and positions of cabinets follow accepted should always check with a building inspector before design standards, as shown here. selecting a vent hood (but don’t assume that more

22 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Planning & Design ■ 23

Remodeling Plans A floor plan is a scaled drawing made from an overhead perspective, showing the exact room Once you’ve completed floor plans and elevation drawings of your kitchen-to-be, you’re ready to begin dimensions, as well as the location of windows, choosing the appliances, cabinets, and other materials doors, cabinets, appliances, electrical and plumbing for your new kitchen. Create a detailed shopping list

N ow the fun starts. Armed with a vision of the features you want to include in your new kitchen and equipped with an understanding of the code about appliances and other materials. As you begin to research the price of cabinets and appliances and receive bids from contractors, you may well decide fixtures. Elevation drawings are plans depicting a wall surface as if viewed from the side. For clarity, use an architectural template to show the position of that includes dimensions and specifications for each item you’ll be buying. Now would be a good time to enlist the aid requirements and design standards, you’re ready to put that it’s prudent to scale back for the sake of your appliances and fixtures in your kitchen plans. These of an interior designer to help you select colors pencil to paper and begin to develop plan drawings— bank account, and these changes may require you to templates are available at drafting and office supply and patterns for flooring, countertops, and wall the next important step in transforming your dream revise your plan drawings. stores, or you can photocopy the examples on pages 28 materials. Many installation contractors can also help kitchen into reality. The process of creating finished plans for a and 29. Carpenters, electricians, plumbers, and other you with design decisions. The key to success when developing plan kitchen project takes time and is done in three phases. contractors will understand exactly what you want if drawings is to take as much time as you need and to First, you’ll be drawing a floor plan of your present your plan drawings speak their language. remain flexible. A professional kitchen designer might kitchen, providing a reference on which to base your take 30 to 80 hours to come up with precise floor new design. Next, you’ll be experimenting with various plans and elevation drawings, so it’s not unreasonable layout options to find a design that best suits your to allow yourself several weeks if you’re doing this needs, a process that can take several days, or even Creating Kitchen Plans ▸ work yourself. You will almost certainly revise your weeks. Finally, you’ll be creating precise, finished plans several times before you settle on a layout that floor plans and elevation drawings, which you will use Although some homeowners have the artist’s eye feels right to you. And it’s not uncommon for kitchen when you begin interviewing contractors to needed to draw accurate plans, others find this difficult, plans to undergo changes as you make decisions do the work. if not impossible. If you fall into the latter category, don’t be afraid to seek help. Home centers and cabinet manufacturers often have designers on staff who can help you draw up plans if you agree to buy materials from them. In addition, there are computer software programs that can help you develop accurate plans that can be printed out. And, of course, there are professional kitchen designers and architects who specialize in creating kitchen plans.

                                                                                                                                           Detailed Plan Drawings ▸
                                                                                                                                           Whether you are doing the work yourself or hiring others, once you have a good idea of the features you want in
                                                                                                                                           your new kitchen, it’s time to create detailed plan drawings. Good plan drawings will help you in several phases of the
                                                                                                                                           planning process:

                                                                                                                                           •    Selecting cabinets and appliances to fit your kitchen layout;
                                                                                                                                           •    Soliciting accurate work bids when negotiating with plumbers, electricians and other subcontractors;
                                                                                                                                           •    Obtaining a building permit at your local Building Inspections office;
                                                                                                                                           •    Scheduling the stages of a remodeling project;
                                                                                                                                           •    Evaluating the work of contractors. If a carpenter or cabinetmaker fails to meet your expectations, your plan
                                                                                                                                                drawings serve as proof that the contractor did not complete the work as agreed.

Most kitchen remodeling projects should have a plan Literature from manufacturers provides key information drawing. A fully developed drawing includes elevations, floor that you’ll need for planning and for making your plan plans, (you’ll need these to get your construction permit), and drawings. Stock cabinetry suppliers, in particular, produce very any other visual details that are of use, such as the style of the useful materials that you can use to identify and represent cabinets and the sizes of the new appliances you plan to buy. precisely the exact size and style of cabinets you want. Lighting and plumbing illustrations also are helpful.

24 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Planning & Design ■ 25

■ How to Create Floor Plans & Elevation Drawings Once you settle on a layout, use graph 1 2 4 paper to draw a very detailed floor plan of your new kitchen. Use dotted lines to fill in the base cabinets and appliances, and use solid lines to show the wall cabinets and countertops. (For straight runs of cabinets, leave a margin of about 3” to allow for adjustments during cabinet installation.) In the margins around the wall outline, indicate dimensions of kitchen elements and the distances between them.

Measure each wall in your kitchen as it now exists. Take Using tracing paper overlaid on your kitchen drawing, begin Use colored pencils to mark the locations 5 accurate measurements of the position and size of every sketching possible layouts for your new kitchen, again using feature, including doors, windows, cabinets, countertops, and of plumbing fixtures, electrical outlets, and a scale of 1⁄2” equals 1 ft. As you develop your kitchen plan, appliances. Also note the locations of all light fixtures and lighting fixtures; also show the locations of refer often to your wish list of kitchen features and the kitchen electrical outlets. Using graph paper, create a scaled floor the heating registers, radiators, or fixtures. standards and Code requirements listed earlier in this section. plan of your present kitchen, using a scale of 1⁄2” equals 1 ft. The goal is to create a kitchen that meets all your needs with Indicate doors, windows, interior, and exterior walls. Add the the minimum possible impact on the present kitchen, because cabinets, appliances, countertops, electrical outlets and lights, this will reduce the overall cost of your project. plumbing fixtures and HVAC registers. In the margins, mark the exact dimensions of all elements.

                                                                                    If simple rearrangement of kitchen
 3                                                                                  elements doesn’t do the trick, explore the
                                                                                    possibility of expanding your kitchen, either
                                                                                    by enlarging the kitchen into an adjoining
                                                                                    room or by building a room addition. A
                                                                                    kitchen designer or architect can help with
                                                                                    this task.

                                                                                                                                           Draw a detailed, precise front elevation
                                                                                                                                       6   for each wall of your kitchen, using a scale
                                                                                                                                           of ½" equals 1 ft. Mark the vertical and
                                                                                                                                           horizontal measurements of all features,
                                                                                                                                           including doors, windows, wood moldings,
                                                                                                                                           cabinets, countertops, appliances, and soffits.
                                                                                                                                           Draw a side elevation of each wall of the
                                                                                                                                           kitchen, complete with all measurements.
                                                                                                                                           When satisfied with the elevation drawings,
                                                                                                                                           add the locations for plumbing pipes,
                                                                                                                                           electrical outlets, and lighting fixtures. Create
                                                                                                                                           close-up detailed drawings of problem spots,
                                                                                                                                           such as the areas where appliances butt
                                                                                                                                           against window frames.

26 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Planning & Design ■ 27

Create Your Drawings

  Use the icons shown here and 1⁄4" graph paper to create drawings for your new kitchen. Use a scale of        Basic construction symbols (not to scale)   Electrical symbols
  1
   ⁄2"= 1 ft. (1 square = 6") when drawing your plans; the icons are drawn to match this scale.

                                                                                                               Wall with insulation                        120-volt                         Range
                                                                                                                                                           GFCI outlet               GFCI   outlet                  R
  Plan view (overhead) templates for 24"-deep base cabinets
                                                                                                               Exterior door
                                                                                                                                                           Single-pole switch        S      Three-way          S3
                                                                                                                                                                                            switch

                                                                                                               Interior door
                                                                                                                                                           Vent fan              F          Thermostat         T

     9"        12"             18"               24"                   30"                       33"

                                                                                                               Folding door                                                                 Incandescent
                                                                                                                                                           Telephone outlet                 ceiling fixture

                                                                                                               Patio door                                  Wall-mounted                     Recessed
                                                                                                                                                           light fixture                    light fixture      R

                36"                                42"                                   48"                   Double-hung window
                                                                                                                                                           Fluorescent light fixture

                                                                                                               Bay window

                                                                                                                                                           Track light fixture
                                                                                                               Skylight
                                                                                                                                                  SKY

                 54"                                       60"
                                                                                               Corner base
                                                                                                               Stairway

                                                                                                                                                                                            Single-bowl sink
                                                                                                                                                           Double-bowl sink

                                                                                                                                                                                              Utility sink
  Plan view (overhead) templates for 12"-deep wall cabinets
                                                                                                                                                                                                       GD
                                                                                                               Range/cooktop,             Oven,               Built-in microwave
                                                                                                               30" wide                   27" wide                                           Garbage disposer

   Refrigerator wall cabinet
   36" wide × 24" deep                                                          Corner
                                     12"         18"             24"

    Refrigerator wall
                                                                                                Corner
    cabinet                                36"                          42"                                    Dishwasher,            Refrigerator,
                                                                                                wall cabinet
    33" wide × 24" deep                                                                                        24" wide               32" wide             Refrigerator,                       Compactor,
                                                                                                                                                           36" wide                            15" wide

28 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Planning & Design ■ 29

Budget & Finance ■ Budgeting Establishing a budget is an important step in the remodeling process, and it involves more than

A ny successful kitchen remodel starts with dreams and becomes reality. Which means that at some point, after you’ve spent time wishing and dreaming, home, so that you can expect to recoup up to 80 or 90 percent of your investment in added real estate value. Something to consider when shopping for a loan determining how much money you have, or want, to spend. Additional factors, including the current value of your home and how long you plan to stay there, you’ll have to figure out where reality lies for you. to finance a kitchen renovation is that if you choose should have bearing on your budgeting decisions Dream kitchens can be very expensive, in some cases. to take out a home equity loan, the interest may be tax deductible. because they will help you set a sensible budget goal. But before you panic, take a deep breath and read this section. You’ll discover many practical ways to control Whatever your projected budget, comparison- costs and reduce the financial sting of remodeling. Although you probably have an idea of how much shopping can help keep you within your budget. Be sure to get three to four estimates for any work ■ Setting a Budget Goal Major appliances are likely to account for a big percentage of your total kitchen remodeling budget. But unlike other you hire out, and ask that the estimates be broken How much should you spend on your kitchen project? you’d like to spend on your dream kitchen, you’re aspects of the project, you have a great ability to control down by materials and labor costs. The same goes Real estate professionals offer the following rough the costs of appliances by choosing inexpensive but likely to find that the figure is too small to cover for appliances; a simple online search can help you guidelines, based on the market value of your home dependable models. Consider, however, that expensive, high- everything you want. To avoid disappointment later, determine the lowest rates for standard appliances, before the remodel and the complexity of your project. end ranges and refrigerators are likely to last longer, both you might as well know upfront: when budgeting functionally and stylistically. for a kitchen remodel, you need to be prepared to which will often be honored by any subsequent seller pay a bit more than you’ve planned and be willing to you find. A visit to your local supplier allows you to • For a full, down-to-the-wall-studs kitchen settle for a bit less than you’ve dreamed. Compromise touch and feel the products before buying. Be sure to remodeling job with a general contractor and is inevitable in the remodeling process, but with quote the lowest rate for the same model and style, to all new materials and fixtures, plan to spend Appliance Costs ▸ perseverance and a bit of luck, you can spend see if they can match it. 10 percent to 20 percent of your home’s value reasonably and still end up with a beautiful new As a guide, here are a few of the projected prices ($15,000 to $30,000 for a $150,000 home); Side-by-Side Refrigerator: $900 to $5,000 kitchen that you’ll love to use. for standard kitchen appliances and fixtures in brand- • For a full remodel that includes an addition to Self-cleaning Range: $800 to $2,000 Determining a budget depends primarily on the new condition. This does not account for top-of-the- your house, plan to spend up to 35 percent of your Gas Cooktop: $400 to $6,000 extent of remodeling needed in your kitchen. When line imported models available at the luxury end of the home’s value ($52,500 for a $150,000 home); Convection Oven: $1,000 to $4,000 budgeting for a kitchen remodel, you must also spectrum or bargain-basement discontinued models at • For a simple cosmetic makeover, plan to spend at Range Hood: $100 to $2,500 consider how much an updated kitchen will add to the lowest end. least 2 percent of your home’s value ($3,000 for a Dishwasher: $200 to $1,500 the value of your home. Kitchen remodels have the $150,000 home). Double-basin sink: $300 to $2,000 highest rate of return over every other room in the Faucet with Sprayer: $100 to $400 Do these sound like huge sums of money? There are good reasons to invest in a new kitchen. A remodeled Dream kitchens, even kitchen is one of the few home improvements that modest ones like this, can translates directly into a higher market value for your be shockingly expensive. Realistic decision-making, home. Even if you plan to sell in the near future, you’ll enjoy the improvements until that time, and the ■ Estimating Costs comparison shopping, and kitchen’s new look may help make the sale when the Begin your budgeting process by estimating the strict budgeting can feel time comes. However, it’s probably wise to scale back cost of your ideal kitchen, as you’ve envisioned it like they’re dampening so far, including appliances, countertops, cabinets, your dream kitchen on the project if you plan to sell immediately. If you’ll be keeping your home for many years, the investment flooring, lighting, and miscellaneous materials. at times, but they are important aspects risk of the project lies in your enjoyment of the new Note that the cost figures for products and services of turning your dreams kitchen. But with thoughtful planning and careful can involve guesswork; minimize it by checking into a real kitchen. selection of appliances and materials, you’re sure to get the prices in appliance stores and building centers, a great return on your investment over the years. While and ask contractors about their rates. Also add any it may be best to pay for a remodel with disposable additional labor charges you expect, such as interior income—that is, accumulated savings—there are design, cleanup help, and trash hauling. several legitimate ways to pay for an improvement Finally, total all your costs, then add a project and even more ways to reduce and manage the 10 percent to 20 percent contingency fund to cost of a new kitchen. the total. The contingency fund is essential: few remodeling projects come in exactly on budget, and it’s difficult to list every expense at this stage, so keep your estimates on the high side to avoid any unpleasant surprises.

30 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Planning & Design ■ 31

■ Use Your Rough Estimate ■Contractors Comparison-Shop for Financing Options ▸ Don’t panic when you see the total; your first rough Once you’ve reduced the cost estimate to a realistic amount, it’s time to consider where the money will come from. The estimate is simply a starting point. In addition, it can While cost shouldn’t be your first consideration when following are six of the most common methods of financing a major remodeling project. Some methods of financing involve help you answer some crucial questions: looking for a contractor, it’s an important one for most considerable paperwork that can take several weeks to process, so the sooner you start, the better. people. If you want to reduce your total labor expense, • Is your rough estimate within the recommended Out-of-Pocket Funds it’s better to cut back on service rather than on the ratio of your home’s market value? If it exceeds The ideal way to pay for a remodeling project is to use accumulated savings. The advantage of this method is that you don’t contractor’s experience and abilities. the range shown above, look for ways to reduce have to pay any loan interest, which can mean a savings of thousands of dollars. For example, when you borrow $25,000 at Regardless of the contractor’s reputation or your budget. 10% interest and pay it off over 10 years, you actually end up paying over $39,000—the cost of the loan plus over $14,000 how much he or she charges, always check • Should you do the work yourself or hire a in interest. Although paying out-of-pocket is cheaper in the long run, it has one significant drawback: If the actual costs far references. Whenever possible, talk to several recent contractor? The elements with the highest labor exceed your estimates, you could end up in a pay-as-you-go situation, and the project would take a lot longer to complete. customers and visit some completed job sites. As the cost offer the greatest potential savings A sizable kitchen remodel could easily take many months to complete if you’re paying for it by squeezing a little bit from saying goes, “The best predictor of future success is if you do the work yourself. In most cases, each paycheck. past performance.” however, there are reasons why labor costs are high, so you should consider doing work yourself Revolving Credit only if you’re experienced and confident that you can successfully complete the job. ■ Do Some Work Yourself If you’re thinking of using credit cards to pay the bills for your new kitchen, think again. Unless it’s absolutely unavoidable, resist all temptations to pull out the plastic when remodeling your kitchen. The interest rates on credit cards, which typically Since labor is often the most expensive element range from 12% to 25%, are far higher than other financing options. This will add thousands of dollars to the cost of your • Are you getting accurate bids? If a contractor of a remodeling project, you may be able to save project, and none of the interest is tax-deductible. submits a bid that’s much higher or lower than the money by doing parts of the job yourself. However, ranges shown, ask why. tackle only those tasks that you’re confident you can Government-Backed Loans complete successfully. There are a number of programs that you may be able to turn to for help through the FHA (Federal Housing Administration). To find qualified lenders, contact your local HUD (Housing & Urban Development) field office. The interest rates and payback ■ Reducing Costs schedules for these government-backed loans are about the same as conventional mortgages, but obtaining them often has income-based eligibility requirements. At this point you should have a rough idea of how much your dream kitchen will cost. Are you already Mortgage Refinancing over your budget? If so, don’t worry; the first estimate Converting an old mortgage to a new loan is a common way to finance a new kitchen. This option is especially advisable if usually exceeds the budget. That’s why you’re figuring current interest rates are 1% or more below the rate of your old mortgage, and you have a sizable amount of equity in your costs before you get started—it allows you to make home. Refinancing is also a good choice if you’re doing a costly project that will add considerably to the market value of your carefully planned cutbacks now, which may save you home. One potential benefit of refinancing your current mortgage is that you may be able to take a tax deduction on the from having to make drastic ones later. There are interest you pay on the loan. Ask a mortgage company or bank about the current tax laws regarding mortgage loans; then several ways to begin lowering your remodeling costs. consult your tax advisor.

■Materials Comparison-Shop for Home Equity Loans If you prefer not to refinance your existing mortgage, you can opt to borrow money against your home equity—the difference between your home’s market value and the amount you owe on your mortgage. For example, if your home is worth $150,000 and your remaining mortgage balance is $100,000, you have $50,000 in home equity; you can use much If your heart is set on premium-quality materials, do of this money to serve as collateral for a loan. Find out the outstanding balance on your mortgage by calling your lender. some homework to make sure you’re getting the best There are two types of home equity loans. The first is a simple second mortgage, in which you borrow a lump sum at a fixed price you can. If the best price is still too high, bear interest rate and pay it back in regular installments over a period of 15 years or more. The second is an equity line of credit. in mind that good-quality materials can be just as Equity credit lines operate like revolving credit card accounts, in which you borrow money when you need it and pay interest serviceable as top-of-the-line luxury products. on the outstanding balance. The interest rates on these loans vary with the market rates, so your payments may change from Although contractors and subcontractors will month to month. Like credit cards, equity credit accounts can be dangerous if you aren’t a disciplined borrower. purchase appliances and materials for you, this service isn’t free; they typically take a markup on every item Home Improvement Loans they buy. It’s often cheaper to research and purchase This is the standard, everyday bank loan—the same type of loan you would use to buy a car. Any full-service bank or credit the materials yourself. union can process a home improvement loan. The advantage of a home improvement loan is that it can be processed Bargain hunting is a very practical way to control very quickly, no appraisal is needed and little paperwork is involved, other than a quick computerized credit check. The remodeling costs that many homeowners actually enjoy (but many others despise). Do bear in mind this simple bit of advice drawback is that the interest rates are generally 2% to 5% higher than the current rates for home equity loans. Since home however: Don’t buy junk. improvement loans are generally secured by your home, the interest may be tax-deductible. Ask your lender about the tax laws specific to your loan.

32 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Planning & Design ■ 33

                                                                                                                          The most important lesson of any DIY project is to         years, some conditions will cause them to deteriorate,

■ Practical Planning Tips know when to call in the professionals. While many of the how-to projects in this book are simply completed making it tricky to remove them safely. And while many hobbyists can pull off the replacement of upper by someone with little construction experience, cabinets with the help of a friend, there are plenty of There are plenty of practical things to consider before three months to complete. Even if it’s a small-scale some projects will be more involved than they first us who would require a team of carpenters to help starting a kitchen remodel, but some of the most project, be prepared to not have access to your kitchen appear. For instance, replacing a resilient tile floor hang and install new cabinets. important involve timing and preparation. In short, the while work is being done, since even paint fumes may seem like an easy enough project, but the plot The how-to lessons in this book have been more planning you can do before even touching a tool, can disrupt daily life for a day or two. One smart thickens when the subfloor is revealed to be in terrible carefully broken down into step-by-step manuals for the better you will be able to handle the inevitable solution is to create a temporary kitchen elsewhere shape and must be torn out and rebuilt. Another each project. Whether you need assistance or have setbacks. As long as you make sure that it doesn’t in your home where you can plug in a coffeemaker or time to call in expert assistance is when plumbing lots of experience at DIY home improvement, the right coincide with major holidays or extended houseguests, microwave, or even a mini refrigerator. or electrical systems are more than twenty years old. tools and smart safety precautions make it possible for a do-it-yourself kitchen remodel doesn’t have to take Another thing to consider is the need for permits Though wires and pipes are meant to last over fifty anyone to achieve dream-kitchen status. over your life. from your local building authority. Familiarize yourself The first tip is to be generous when creating a with local codes before you alter anything electrical timeline. You never know when ordered parts will be or structural. For plumbing projects, you’ll want to delayed or paint will take twice as long to dry as you look into the requirements in your area or determine Flextime: Your Little Secret ▸ estimated. For the most part, the simplest remodel the need for a new line before you get started. As for can be completed within a week with more extensive changes that involve ventilation, you’ll want to refer For added security, it’s a good idea to add at least 25 If contractors know that your schedule is padded, they remodels—that involve new cabinets, floors, and to some of the building codes and guidelines we’ve percent more time to your best guess when determining may feel free to bump your project for a day or two to professionally installed countertops—taking up to included earlier in the book. the overall schedule for your remodeling project. Building squeeze in a smaller rush job for another client. To ensure in a few flex days as a safeguard against unforeseen that your contractors stay on schedule, mark your flex days problems is also a good idea. However, keep this “cleanup” or “out of town”—don’t tell them you’ve built Like successful stand- information to yourself. some extra time into the schedule. up comedy, successful kitchen remodeling requires impeccable timing. Dedicate a calendar to the projects and be sure to keep it updated. Planning the timing is the Talk to Building Inspectors ▸ only way to keep the amount of time you’ll be without Although building inspectors aren’t paid a functioning kitchen to a consultants, they can be an excellent bare minimum, and it will let design and planning resource. They are contractors and tradespeople work more efficiently. your community’s field representatives, and their job is to inspect the work done on your project to ensure that it meets building code requirements.

                                                                                                                         As experts in their respective fields, the
                                                                                                                         building inspector, electrical inspector,
                                                                                                                         and plumbing inspector can give you
                                                                                                                         sound advice on designing your kitchen.
                                                                                                                         Not all inspectors have the time or the
                                                                                                                         willingness to answer a lot of design
                                                                                                                         questions, so make your questions short
                                                                                                                         and specific, and be sure to describe
                                                                                                                         your situation clearly. Also ask if the
                                                                                                                         inspections office provides a pamphlet
                                                                                                                         that summarizes the local code
                                                                                                                         requirements for kitchens.

34 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Planning & Design ■ 35

Cabinets Y ears ago the built-in kitchen cabinet was relatively rare. Food was stored in pantries and in freestanding cupboards, such as Hoosier cabinets, most of which are now considered antiques. Plates and silver resided in chests or in boxes stacked on open shelves. Today, you rarely see an American kitchen that doesn’t dwell in the shadow of large banks of built-in cabinets spanning floor to ceiling. But just as the kitchen furnishings have evolved, the cabinets themselves continue to change, mostly to reflect changes in style and design. It is also true that many cabinets installed in the last twenty or thirty years were, simply put, cheap. If your cabinets are dated or marred (or just plain ugly) but still structurally sound, you may be able to get by with painting them or replacing the cabinet doors. But in most cases, the inescapable conclusion you’ll draw when you evaluate your cabinets is that it is time for them to go. Installing cabinets yourself is easy. If you just want to modify your existing cabinets, you’ll find quick-fix projects in this chapter.

In This Chapter • Cabinet Selection • New Cabinet Prep • Cabinet Installation • Freestanding Cabinets • Cabinet Upgrades • Slide-out Storage • Pull-down Shelves • Customizing Cabinets • Vertical Divider • Custom Cabinets • Kitchen Cabinet Paint

                                                        ■ 37

Cabinet Selection Face-Frame vs. Frameless ▸ Once you have decided whether you will

W hen purchasing cabinets, you have a number of stock cabinets but still less than custom cabinets. be purchasing factory-made or custom decisions to make. First, you need to decide if Semi-custom is the best choice for homeowners cabinets, you need to decide which type you want to go with stock, semi-custom, or custom who want better-quality cabinets with some special of cabinet: face-frame or frameless. cabinets. Then you need to choose between face- features and a custom appearance, but at a lower frame or frameless styles. Materials, door and drawer price than custom cabinets. You should allow at least Face-frame cabinets have frames made styles, hardware and finishes must also be decided. three to eight weeks of lead time when ordering semi- of solid wood around the front of the Cabinets comprise three categories: stock, custom cabinets. cabinet box. Because the frame extends semi-custom, and custom. Stock cabinets and some into cabinet space, the door openings will be reduced and a certain amount of semi-custom cabinets are available for homeowners to install themselves; custom cabinets usually are installed by the cabinetmaker. There’s a growing ■ Custom “dead” space exists within the cabinet behind the frames. The hinges for Custom cabinets offer the most in terms of trend in “unfitted” kitchen systems, too. Seen most doors on face-frame cabinets mount options. These cabinets are designed, built, and frequently in European kitchens, the cabinets on the frame. The door itself may be installed to fit a unique space. It is wise to shop and shelves are modular—like pieces of storage flush within the frame or raised above around before settling on a custom cabinetmaker, as furniture—rather than built-in or fitted. it. Flush-fitting doors were common on price, quality, and availability will vary widely. The older cabinets, but because they require minimum lead time for custom cabinet construction a precise fit, which means more time ■ Stock is six weeks in most markets. When you get bids, find out if the lead time is from acceptance of the and craftsmanship, they will be more expensive and more difficult to find. Stock cabinets are available as either ready-to- bid or from when the condition of the kitchen allows Face-frame cabinets have openings that are completely surrounded by assemble (RTA) or ready-to-install. Ready-to-assemble the cabinetmaker to take accurate measurements. face frames made of vertical stiles and horizontal rails. They give kitchens a Frameless cabinets are often referred cabinets, also referred to as knockdown or flat-pack, Remember that exotic or difficult-to-machine traditional look. to as “Eurostyle.” These cabinets do not are shipped as flat components that the consumer materials and intricate custom designs will end up have a face-frame and the doors and puts together using connecting hardware. In other costing you more. drawers span the entire width of the words, in addition to installing the cabinets, you have carcass, which allows easier access to assemble them. Your options will be somewhat Standard Cabinet Sizes ▸ and a bit more storage space. The doors limited if you choose RTA cabinets, but you will be are mounted using cup hinges that are able to achieve a slightly different look from ready- Base cabinets (without countertop) invisible when the doors are closed. to-install cabinets. Although some RTA cabinets are Height 341⁄2” Frameless cabinets have a streamlined made with low-quality materials, not all are poorly Depth 24” look that makes them feel more constructed. Carefully inspect samples of assembled Width 6” to 42”, in 3” increments contemporary in style. One drawback cabinets to check material quality and engineering of frameless cabinets is that they do quality. If possible, also look at assembly directions to Wall cabinets not have the added strength of the face check for clarity. Height 12”, 15”, 18”, 24”, 30”, 36” frame, so it is critical that they are solidly Ready-to-install cabinets are purchased already Depth 12” constructed and properly installed. assembled. They tend to be lower on the quality level, Width 6” to 36”, in 3” increments but typical utility units are suitable for a workshop or a weekend home. Larger building centers typically carry Oven cabinets a single style of stock kitchen cabinets made from a Height 83”, 95” relatively economical species of wood, such as red oak. Depth 24” Width 30”, 33”

■ Semi-Custom Pantry cabinets Semi-custom cabinets are also factory-made to Height 83”, 95” Frameless cabinets, sometimes called “European-style,” are more standard sizes, but they offer far more options Depth 24” contemporary. Because they have no face frames, frameless cabinets offer in finish, size, features, and materials than stock Width 18”, 24” slightly more storage space than framed cabinets. The doors and drawers on cabinets. These are typically sold through higher-end frameless cabinets cover the entire unit. design showrooms, with prices much higher than

38 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 39

■ Cabinets & Universal Design Universal Design

When considering a design for kitchen cabinets, the Shelves so high you need a step stool are not the issue of accessibility should be a priority. Cabinets that safest bet for someone who is elderly. Considering the Design your kitchen around a clear, circular space of at least 5 ft. in diameter to provide room for a require constant bending down would be inappropriate needs of users—and future users—is a smart way to wheelchair. If your kitchen doesn’t have 60” of clear space, allow 48” for pathways. Plan for 30 to 48” of for someone with a bad back. start planning for a new kitchen. clear approach space in front of all appliances and workstations.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note: the
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        arrangement of
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        elements does not
   Accessible Cabinets ▸                                                                                                                                                                                                                reflect an actual
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        layout.

   Making a kitchen accessible to wheelchair users involves incorporating open, roll-in space in the base cabinets so that
   sink, cooktop, and countertops are within reach. Roll-in cabinets have no bottom or toe kick. The roll-in space can be
   concealed with a fold-away door. All other base cabinets should be modified to have an 8" toe kick. If upper cabinets are
   used, they need to have pull-down shelving. Base cabinets with pull-out shelves and pantries with lazy Susans are the
   best storage options.
                                                                                                                                                        Side-door                                                     Pull-down
                                                                                                                                          Pull-out      oven with            Cooktop with open    Foldaway            shelving
                                                                                                                                          surface       open space           space below          doors
                                                                                                                                                        below

                                                                                                                                                                                    36"                           Cabinet
                                                                                                                                                                                                                  with                                  32"
                                                                                                                                                               30" to 34"                                         drawers

                                                                                                                                                              36"                                36"                                           36"

                                                                                                                                                                                      Cabinets
                                                                                                                                                                                      with
                                                                                                                                                                                      pull-
                                                                                                                                                                                      down
                                                                                                                                                                                      shelving

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               Pantry
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               with
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               Lazy
                                                                                                                                                                                                                             Pull-out          Susan
                                                                                                                                                                      Foldaway                                               surface
                                                                                                                                                                      doors
                                                                                                                                                 Raised
                                                                                                                                                 dishwasher
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Rolling
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            cart
                                                                                                                                              38"                                                      Side-
                                                                                                                                                               32"                                     by-side           36"
                                                                                                                                                                                      Cabinet          refrigerator
                                                                                                                                                                                      with
                                                                                                                                                                                      drawers

                                                                                                                                                                       36"

Pull-out shelves for upper and lower cabinets offer the ultimate in easy access, not just for operators with restricted movement. If someone in your household requires a wheelchair, design your new cabinets so they have a full 8”-tall toe-kick area, not just the standard 21⁄2 to 3”.

40 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 41

New Cabinet Prep

I nstalling new cabinets is easiest if the kitchen is completely empty. Disconnect the plumbing and wiring, and temporarily remove the appliances. To remove old cabinets and countertops, see pages 44 to 45. If the new kitchen requires plumbing or electrical changes, now is the time to have this work done. If the kitchen flooring is to be replaced, finish it before Stud locations beginning the layout and the installation of cabinets. Cabinets must be installed plumb and level. Filled-in Using a level as a guide, draw reference lines on the low area walls to indicate cabinet location. If the kitchen floor is uneven, find the highest point of the floor area that will be covered by base cabinets. Measure up from 1×3 ledger this point to draw reference lines.

   Tools & Materials ▸
   Stud finder             Marking pencil
   Pry bar                 Tape measure
   Trowel                  1 × 3 boards
   Putty knife             Straight 6- to 8-ft.-long
   Screwdriver             2×4
   Straightedge            Wallboard compound
   Level                   21⁄2" wallboard screws

                                                                                  Reference
                                                                                     line

42 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 43

■ Removing Old Cabinets ■ How to Remove Cabinets Tools & Materials ▸ Old cabinets can be salvaged fairly easily if they are modular units that were installed with screws, and Tape measure Pry bar Reciprocating saw Hammer 1 2 some custom built-in cabinets can be removed Putty knife Eye protection in one piece. If you’re not planning to salvage Cordless screwdriver Scrap wood the cabinets, they should be cut into pieces or Sander 2×4 otherwise broken down and discarded. If you’re Stud finder Wallboard compound demolishing your old cabinets, the main danger is Taping knife 1 × 3 lumber causing collateral damage in the room, especially to Level 21⁄2” wallboard screws the plumbing, so work with care. Laser level

                                                                                                                              Remove doors and drawers to make it easier to get at        At the backs of cabinets, remove any screws holding the
                                                                                                                              interior spaces. You may need to scrape away old paint to   cabinet to the wall. Cabinets can be removed as a group or
                                                                                                                              expose hinge screws.                                        can be disassembled.

                                                                                                                                3                                                           4

Remove trim moldings at the edges and tops of the Remove base shoe from cabinet base if the molding is cabinets with a flat pry bar or putty knife. attached to the floor.

                                                                                                                              Detach individual cabinets by removing screws that hold     Countertops are usually not salvageable. Cut them into
                                                                                                                              face frames together.                                       manageable pieces with a reciprocating saw, or take them

Remove baseboards and other trim moldings with a pry Remove valances above cabinets. Some valances are apart, piece by piece, with a hammer and pry bar. bar. Protect wall surfaces with scraps of wood. Label the trim attached to the cabinets or soffits with screws. Others are boards on the back side so you can replace them correctly. nailed and must be pried loose.

44 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 45

■ How to Prepare Walls 1 2 5 6

                                                                                                                                                           34 1⁄ 2"
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            84"

                                                                                                                                                                      High
                                                                                                                                                                      point

Find high and low spots on wall surfaces using a long, Fill in low spots in the wall by applying wallboard Measure up 341⁄2” from the high-point mark (for standard Measure up 84” from the high-point mark and draw a second straight 2 × 4. Sand down any high spots. compound with a taping knife. Let the compound dry, and cabinets). Use a level (a laser level is perfect) to mark a reference line. Wall cabinets will be installed with their top then sand it lightly. reference line on the walls. Base cabinets will be installed with edges flush against this line. top edges flush against this line.

 3                                                                 4
                                                                                                                                      7                                                                   8

                                                                                                                                                                        30"

Locate and mark wall studs using an electronic stud finder. FInd the highest point along the floor that will be covered by Cabinets normally will be hung by driving screws into the studs base cabinets. Place a level on a long, straight 2 × 4, and move Measure down 30” from the wall-cabinet reference line and Install 1 × 3 temporary ledgers with top edges flush against through the back of the cabinets. the board across the floor to determine if the floor is uneven. draw another level line where the bottoms of the cabinets will the reference lines. Attach ledgers with 21⁄2” wallboard screws Mark the wall at the high point. be. Temporary ledgers will be installed against this line. driven into every other wall stud. Mark stud locations on the ledgers. Cabinets will rest temporarily on ledgers during installation (the ledgers alone will not support them, however).

46 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 47

Cabinet Installation ■ How to Install Wall Cabinets 1 2 C abinets must be firmly anchored to wall studs, and they must be plumb and level when installed. The best way to ensure this is by attaching a ledger board Filler strip

to the wall to assist in the installation. As a general rule, install the upper cabinets first so your access is not impeded by the base cabinets. (Although some pros prefer to install the base cabinets first so they can be used to support the uppers during installation.) It’s also best to begin in a corner and work outward from there.

   Tools & Materials ▸
   Handscrew clamps            Toe-kick molding
   Level                       Filler strips
   Hammer                      Valance
   Utility knife               6d finish nails                                                                                      Position a corner upper cabinet on a ledger and hold it in            Attach a filler strip to the front edge of the cabinet, if
   Nail set                    Finish washers                                                                                       place, making sure it is resting cleanly on the ledger. Drill 3⁄16"   needed (see page 48). Clamp the filler in place and drill
   Clamps                      21⁄2", 4" wood screws                                                                                pilot holes into the wall studs through the hanging strips at the     counterbored pilot holes through the cabinet face frame near
                                                                                                                                    top rear of the cabinet. Attach the cabinet to the wall with 21⁄2"    hinge locations. Attach filler to cabinet with 21⁄2" cabinet screws
   Drill                       21⁄2" cabinet screws or
                                                                                                                                    screws. Do not tighten fully until all cabinets are hung.             or flathead wood screws.
   Counterbore drill bit         flathead wood screws
                                                                Stock cabinets are sold in boxes that are keyed to door
   Phillips screwdriver        Sheet metal screws
                                                                and drawer packs (you need to buy these separately). It is
   Jigsaw                      #8 panhead wood screws           important that you realize this when you are estimating your
   1 × 3 lumber
   Cabinets
                               3" drywall screws
                               Shims
                                                                project costs at the building center (often a door pack will cost
                                                                as much or more than the cabinet). Also allow plenty of time
                                                                                                                                      3                                                                     4
   Trim molding                                                 for assembling the cabinets out of the box. It can take an hour
                                                                or more to put some more complex cabinets together.

   How to Fit a Corner Cabinet ▸
   Before installation, test-fit the corner and adjoining
   cabinets to make sure doors and handles will not interfere
   with each other. If necessary, increase the clearance by
   pulling the corner cabinet away from the side wall by
   no more than 4". To maintain even spacing between the
   edges of the doors and the cabinet corner, cut a filler
   strip and attach it to the corner cabinet or the adjoining
   cabinet. Filler strips should be made from material that
   matches the cabinet doors and face frames.
                                                                                                                                    Position the adjoining cabinet on the ledger, tight against           Check the front cabinet edges or face frames for plumb.
                                                                                                                                    the corner cabinet or filler strip. Clamp the corner cabinet          Drill 3⁄16" pilot holes into the wall studs through the hanging
                                                                                                                                    and the adjoining cabinet together at the top and bottom.             strips in the rear of the cabinet. Attach the cabinet with
                                                                                                                                    Handscrew clamps will not damage wood face frames.                    21⁄2" screws. Do not tighten the wall screws fully until all the
                                                                                                                                                                                                          cabinets are hung.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 (continued)

48 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 49

 5                                                               6                                                                       9                                                                10

Attach the corner cabinet to the adjoining cabinet. From Position and attach each additional cabinet. Clamp frames Remove the temporary ledger. Check the cabinet run for Use trim moldings to cover any gaps between the cabinets the inside corner cabinet, drill pilot holes through the face together, and drill counterbored pilot holes through the side of plumb, and adjust if necessary by placing wood shims behind and the walls. Stain the moldings to match the cabinet finish. frame. Join the cabinets with sheet-metal screws. the face frame. Join the cabinets with wood screws. Drill 3⁄16” the cabinet, near the stud locations. Tighten the wall screws pilot holes in the hanging strips, and attach the cabinet to the completely. Cut off the shims with a utility knife. studs with wood screws.

 7                                                               8                                                                       11                                                               12

Join the frameless cabinets with #8 × 11⁄4” panhead wood Fill the gaps between the cabinet and wall or neighboring Attach decorative valance above the sink. Clamp the Install the cabinet doors. If necessary, adjust the hinges so screws or wood screws with decorative washers. Each pair of appliance with a filler strip. Cut the filler strip to fit the space, valance to the edge of cabinet frames and drill counterbored that the doors are straight and plumb. cabinets should be joined by at least four screws. then wedge wood shims between the filler and the wall to pilot holes through the cabinet frames and into the end of the create a friction fit that holds it in place temporarily. Drill valance. Attach with sheet-metal screws. counterbored pilot holes through the side of the cabinet (or the edge of the face frame) and attach filler with screws.

50 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 51

■ How to Install Base Cabinets 5 6

 1                                                                    2

Begin the installation with a corner cabinet. Draw plumb Place the cabinet in the corner. Make sure the cabinet is Position and attach additional cabinets, making sure the Make sure all the cabinets are level. If necessary, adjust by lines that intersect the 341⁄2” reference line (measured from the plumb and level. If necessary, adjust by driving wood shims frames are aligned and the cabinet tops are level. Clamp driving shims underneath the cabinets. Place the shims behind high point of the floor—see page 46) at the locations for the under the cabinet base. Be careful not to damage the flooring. cabinets together, then attach the face frames or cabinet sides the cabinets near the stud locations to fill any gaps. Tighten the cabinet sides. Drill 3⁄16” pilot holes through the hanging strip and into the with screws driven into pilot holes. Tack the cabinets to the wall screws. Cut off the shims with a utility knife. wall studs. Tack the cabinet to the wall with wood screws or wall studs, but don’t drive screws too tight—you may need to wallboard screws. make adjustments once the entire bank is installed.

 3                                                                    4
                                                                                                                                       7                                                                    8

                                                                                                                                            Toe-kick molding

Clamp the adjoining cabinet to the corner cabinet. Use a jigsaw to cut any cabinet openings needed in the Make sure the new cabinet is plumb, then drill counterbored cabinet backs (for example, in the sink base seen here) for pilot holes through the cabinet sides or the face frame and plumbing, wiring, or heating ducts. Use trim moldings to cover gaps between the cabinets and Hang the cabinet doors and mount the drawer fronts, then filler strip. Screw the cabinets together. Drill 3⁄16” pilot holes the wall or floor. The toe-kick area is often covered with a strip test to make sure they close smoothly and the doors fit evenly through the hanging strips and into the wall studs. Tack of wood finished to match the cabinets or painted black. and flush. Self-closing cabinet hinges (by far the most common the cabinets loosely to the wall studs with wood screws or type installed today) have adjustment screws that allow you to wallboard screws. make minor changes to the hardware to correct any problems.

52 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 53

                                                                                                                                         Adjusting European Hinges ▸

■ Variation: Installing Face-Frame Cabinets European hinges (also called cup hinges) are the standard hinges used on frameless cabinets and some face- A The more traditional-looking face-frame cabinets frame cabinets. One advantage of these hinges is their C differ only slightly from frameless cabinets in terms of adjustability. This adjustability means that you will need installation. The opening of the cabinet is surrounded some patience to tackle this project. by vertical and horizontal frames called “stiles” and “rails.” The face frame typically overhangs the cabinet At first glance, European hinges appear to need a Phillips case on the outside by 1⁄16” to 1⁄8”. Because of this screwdriver to be adjusted, but you will have more B overhang, the frames must be the connection point success if you use a Pozidrive #2 screwdriver. This looks rather than the cabinet case. Use 21⁄2” No.10 wood like a Phillips driver, but it is engineered with extra blade A screws to connect the frames (or use special 21⁄2”- or tips for reduced slippage. Never use a power screwdriver 3”-long cabinet screws). Do not screw the cabinet for hinge adjustments. Long-arm European hinges. The standard long-arm sides together at any other point than the face frame, European hinge has four adjustment screws. The first pair as this will skew the cabinets and create structural European hinges have three adjustment screws that (A) attach the mounting plate to the side of the cabinet. To join face-frame cabinets, set the cabinets in position, stress. secure the hinge to the door and cabinet while moving the Loosen these screws slightly on both hinges to move aligned with the frame faces flush and the frame tops flush. Most face-frame cabinets use overlay doors. The Clamp the frames together at the top and bottom. Using a drill door in and out, up and down, or right to left. If you own the cabinet up and down vertically. Retighten the screws hinges for these doors simply attach to the back of with a No.10 counterbore bit, drill two pilot holes through the face-frame cabinets, the hinges may be more compact when you have the hinge aligned as desired. The third the door and to the side or face of the cabinet face- sides of the frame into the adjoining frame. Attach the frames adjustment screw (B) attaches the hinge to the mounting than frameless cabinet hinges. Some of the most compact plate. If this screw is loose, the door will move in and frame with screws. They are called “overlay wrap” with cabinet screws or 21⁄2” No. 10 screws. hinges have unique adjustment systems, so you may have out and seem floppy. This screw should be in the same or “partial wrap” hinges if they attach to the side of more trial and error in installing them. relative position in its slot as the B screw on the other the face frame, and they are called “semi-concealed” hinge, and they should both always be tight. The fourth if they attach to the front of the face-frame. Cup or Before making any adjustments, try tightening the screw (C) adjusts the door left and right horizontally. Euro-style hinges are available for face-frame cabinets, anchoring screw or the vertical adjustment screws. Often Adjust one hinge at a time in small increments by turning the screw. Check the adjustment results frequently by but are somewhat more difficult to install if the doors these screws have worked loose over time and are closing the door. have not been predrilled for this hinge style. The best affecting the door alignment and function. way to attach the door hardware uniformly is to use a drilling template. You can usually purchase one where you purchase the cabinets or hardware.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     B      C
    Tools & Materials ▸                                              Start at the corner when installing a bank of cabinets that
                                                                     includes a blind corner cabinet. Attach the cabinet adjoining
    Drill                         Filler strip (if needed)           the corner by driving screws through the face frame (see
    No. 10 counterbore bit        3
                                   ⁄4" finish-grade plywood          photo at the top of this page). If a filler strip is necessary to
    ⁄64" self-centering vix bit
    5
                                  Finish materials                   fill a gap between the two cabinets, attach the filler strip to
    Cabinet screws (or 21⁄2"      Drilling template                  the base cabinet first and then run screws through the corner
                                                                                                                                                                                 A
        No. 10 screws)                                               cabinet face frame and into the filler strip only after the
                                                                     adjoining cabinet is positioned and shimmed.                                         B

                                                                                                                                                                                                          Compact European hinges. The compact European
                                                                                                                                                                            C                             hinge for overlay doors on face-frame cabinets has three
                                                                                                                                                                                                          adjustment screws. The first pair (A) attach the mounting

To install partial wrap overlay hinges, use a template to clip to the side or front of the face frame. Screws B and C mark the hinge locations on the back of the door. Drill 5⁄64”-dia. European hinges. Cabinet doors with European hinges attach the hinge to the mounting plate and serve as the pilot holes no more than 3⁄8” deep using a self-centering vix bit. can be adjusted in three dimensions: vertical (up and left and right adjustment. Loosen all the A screws slightly Screw the hinge to the door back. Place the hinge against the down) (A); depth (in and out) (B); and horizontal (right to adjust the door up or down, then tighten. Loosen or face frame and mark the screw holes. Drill 5⁄64” pilot holes. Drive and left) (C). If your cabinets are slightly out of alignment, tighten one B or C screw in small increments to move the all the screws for both hinges partially, then tighten all. begin door installation with the center cabinet and work door left or right. Check the adjustment results frequently your way out to one side and then the other. by closing the door.

54 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 55

Freestanding Cabinets

R ecently, some large retailers and catalog sellers have introduced another kitchen cabinetry option that’s fairly new to North America but has been cabinet. That way, you can get the knack of the process without wrestling with large pieces. Installing a freestanding kitchen cabinet system is similar to around for a long time in Europe: the freestanding most other wall cabinet installations. You need to cabinet. Boasting a contemporary appearance and ease begin with level wall surfaces. The cabinets are hung of installation, these cabinets have the added benefits on a suspension rail and then bolted to this bar. The of portability and interchangeability (sink base bolts, in the upper inside corners of the cabinets, cabinets being a notable exception). Most freestanding are then covered with plastic caps. If you install bases come in an assortment of materials, colors, the suspension rail properly, this type of installation and sizes with matching upper cabinets. The upper ensures that your cabinets will be level. If you add cabinets are hung nontraditionally, usually mounting toe-kick panels to your base cabinets, they will be directly onto a rail that is attached to the wall and can virtually indistinguishable from fully installed base also support shelves and organizer bins. cabinets. Or, you can create a European look by Freestanding cabinets, like their permanently installing attractive legs and leaving the toe-kick covers installed counterparts, are usually shipped and sold in off. When opting for this look, cut the ledger board 5” flat packs. Because they are ready to assemble (RTA), to 6” short, and install a third leg on the exposed end you won’t get out of work completely by choosing cabinets so the ledger board will not be visible. When freestanding cabinets. You will have the additional step creating an island with base cabinets, you must attach of assembling the cabinets before installing them. the legs to the floor to prevent movement. A sink base Nontraditional materials make visual sense with European-style freestanding base cabinets. Metals and colorful laminates are It is best to start your assembly with a basic, small cabinet also must be secured to prevent movement. two options you can find fairly easily.

                                                                                                                                  Tips for Installing Freestanding Cabinets ▸
                                                                                                                                                                                               •    Carefully unpack each carton and double-check
                                                                                                                                                                                                    hardware contents with instruction sheets.
                                                                                                                                                                                               •    Use blue painters’ tape to tape hardware packets and
                                                                                                                                                                                                    instructions to their respective parts.
                                                                                                                                                                                               •    Check nooks and crannies of packing materials.
                                                                                                                                                                                                    Hardware bags are often encased in packing
                                                                                                                                                                                                    materials.
                                                                                                                                                                                               •    Parts may be grouped—for example, the ledger
                                                                                                                                                                                                    boards are packed with the toe kicks.
                                                                                                                                                                                               •    If you are assembling large cabinets in another room,
                                                                                                                                                                                                    make sure you have the space to move them to the
                                                                                                                                                                                                    kitchen when fully assembled.
                                                                                                                                                                                               •    Make sure you have the proper side of the cabinet
                                                                                                                                                                                                    back facing the inside of the cabinet.
                                                                                                                                                                                               •    Check that drawers are right side up before drilling
                                                                                                                                                                                                    handle holes.
                                                                                                                                                                                               •    Fiberboard material is very heavy. You should have at
                                                                                                                                                                                                    least one helper when installing.

                                                                                                                                                                                               Freestanding base cabinets share design
                                                                                                                                                                                               similarities within a family of options so they can

Freestanding base cabinets really have more in common with furniture—including ease of installation—than cabinetry, but they retain a cohesive, uniform appearance. serve the same important function as fully installed cabinets.

56 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 57

                                                                                                             Mantesh

Cabinet Upgrades ■ How to Install Swing-Up Shelves 1 2 C ustomize your kitchen storage with swing-up, glide-out, and pull-down shelves. Incorporate heavy-duty, swing-up shelves to bring base-cabinet items like stand mixers to the countertop. Build your own full-extension, glide-out shelves to divide larger spaces into two or more shelves and reduce bending and reaching for wheelchair users and people with back problems. Choose pull-down shelf accessories to bring upper-cabinet items like spices within reach. When purchasing specialized hardware accessories, check load ratings, locking mechanisms, arc swings, and clearance heights to be sure they can support the items you want to store, and they will fit in the intended location.

■ Installing Swing-up Shelves Carefully trigger the locking mechanism on each swing arm, and set the Mark the locations of the swing arm Swing-up shelves are perfect for storing heavy arm in its fully extended position. Hold each arm against the inside face of the mounting plates onto the inside cabinet appliances beneath the counter. Most swing arms are cabinet side and make sure the arm will clear the door hinge and/or the cabinet faces. Mount a swing arm on each side of sold without the shelf surface, which must face frame. If the arms do not clear, you’ll need to use wood spacers to allow the the cabinet opening, using screws. Unlock arms to clear the hinges or frames by at least 1⁄2”. In most cases, one 1 × 3 spacer and rotate both swing arms so they are be purchased separately and cut to fit. for each arm will provide enough clearance. Cut the spacers so they match the fully extended. Take accurate measurements of your cabinet’s length of the mounting plate on the swing arms. interior dimensions, noting any objects that protrude into the interior. Purchase a swing-up unit that is compatible with your cabinetry. Frameless cabinets often have fully concealed hinges that can interfere 3 4 with swing mechanisms. Framed cabinets have a front perimeter face frame and may have hinges that interfere with lifting hardware. Refer to the manufacturer’s recommendations for the proper length of the shelf to ensure it will fit into the cabinet when the assembly is locked down and the door is closed. Cut the shelf from 3⁄4”-thick plywood, MDF, or melamine-coated particleboard. If the shelf is bare wood, finish all sides with a washable paint or varnish. For melamine-coated board, cover the cut edges with melamine tape to prevent water from damaging the wood core.

   Tools & Materials ▸
   Circular saw              Shelving                                                                                  Determine the width of the shelf by                Fasten each locking bar to the bottom shelf face with the provided screws
   Tape measure              1 × 3 lumber                 Swing-up shelves are used most often to store                measuring between the outer edges of the           and plastic spacers to ensure the bars will slide smoothly. Test the locking bars’
   Screwdriver               #8 machine screws            stand mixers and other heavy small appliances so             shelf-mounting flanges.                            operation with the shelf in the extended and retracted positions, and make any
                                                          they’re always at the ready.                                                                                    necessary adjustments.

58 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 59

Slide-out Storage ■ Drawer Slides A base cabinet with slide-out trays or shelves is one of those great modern conveniences that has become standard in new kitchen design. Not only do and finish nails. If you prefer a more finished look (not that there’s anything wrong with the look of nice plywood), you can use 1 × 4 hardwood stock for the Drawer slides suitable for pullout shelves are commonly available in both standard (left) and full extension (right) slide-out trays make reaching stored items easier than tray sides and set a 3⁄8”-thick plywood bottom panel styles. Standard slides are less with standard cabinet spaces—no more crouching into dadoes milled into the side pieces. Another option expensive and good enough for and diving into the deep recesses of cavernous is to assemble plywood tray pieces using pocket screws most applications. They allow low shelves—they also store more items far more so the screw heads don’t show on the front pieces of the tray to be pulled out most efficiently. With a few shallow trays, a standard base the trays. of the way. Full extension slides are a little pricier than standard cabinet can hold dozens of food cans and still leave slides but they allow the tray to room for tall items like cereal boxes and bags of flour be pulled completely out of the or even deep pots and countertop appliances. To get the most from your new slide-out system, Tools & Materials ▸ cabinet box for easy access to items in the back. think carefully about how you will use each tray. Circular saw with straightedge Wood glue Measure the items you’re most likely to store together, guide or table saw 6d finish nails and let the items dictate the spacing of the trays. Most Drill Finish materials standard base cabinets are suitable for trays. Wide Wood screws Tape measure cabinets (24” or wider) without a center partition Drawer slides (1 set per tray) Varnish or (middle stile) are best in terms of space usage, but 1 × 2 hardwood stock polyurethane trays in narrow (18”-wide) cabinets are just as handy. 3 ⁄4” finish-grade plywood If you have a wide cabinet with a middle stile, you can add trays along one or both sides of the stile. For economy and simplicity, the trays in this project are made with ¾”-thick plywood parts joined with glue

                                                                                               Slide-out trays eliminate
                                                                                               the everyday problem of
                                                                                               hard-to-reach and hard-
                                                                                               to-see spaces in standard
                                                                                               base cabinets. Better still,
                                                                                               you can install your trays to
                                                                                               accommodate the stuff you
                                                                                               use most often.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   Spacer strip

                                                                                                                                                                                                         Glide-out rail

                                                                                                                               Spacers must be mounted to the wall cabinets before you can install drawer slides for your slide-out shelves. They are necessary
                                                                                                                               for the drawers to clear the cabinet face frame and the door. For a 3⁄4" spacer, a 1 × 3 or 1 × 4 works well. Paint or finish it to match
                                                                                                                               the cabinet interior.

60 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 61

■ How to Install Slide-out Cabinet Trays Lay out the tray positions, starting with Cut the bottom piece for each tray from 1 the bottom tray. Check the drawer slides to see how much clearance you need for the 3 ⁄4” plywood 11⁄2” smaller than the planned width and depth of the finished tray. Rip 4 bottom tray. Draw lines on the side panels three 3⁄4” -wide pieces for the sides, front, of the cabinet to represent the bottom and back of each tray. Cut the side pieces to edges of the slide supports. Make sure the length, equal to the depth dimension of the lines are level and are perpendicular to the bottom piece. Cut the front and back pieces cabinet front. Cut the slide supports to 11⁄2” longer than the width of the bottom. length from 1 × 2 hardwood stock (or any hardwood ripped to 11⁄2” wide).

                                          Mount the supports to the side panels           Build the trays with glue and 6d
 2                                        of the cabinet with glue and screws driven
                                          through countersunk pilot holes. Note:
                                                                                          finish nails or pneumatic brads. Fasten the
                                                                                          sides flush with the bottom face and front
                                                                                                                                          5
                                          Depending on the overhang of the cabinet        and back edges of the bottom piece, and
                                          face frames, you may need thicker support       then add the front and back pieces. Sand
                                          stock to provide sufficient clearance for the   any rough surfaces, and finish the trays
                                          trays and slide rails.                          with two or three coats of polyurethane or
                                                                                          other durable varnish. If desired, you can
                                                                                          stain the trays prior to finishing so they
                                                                                          match your cabinets.

                                          Install the drawer slides flush with the        Partially mount the drawer slide

 3                                        bottom edges of the slide supports using
                                          the provided screws. Assemble the two
                                                                                          rails to one of the trays, following the
                                                                                          manufacturer’s directions. Test-fit the tray
                                                                                                                                          6
                                          halves of each slide, and then measure          in the cabinet and make any necessary
                                          between the drawer side pieces (rails) to       adjustments before completely fastening
                                          find the exact width of each tray. 		           the rails. Mount the slide rails on the
                                          Plan the depth of the trays based on the        remaining trays and install the trays to
                                          cabinet depth.                                  finish the job.

62 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 63

Pull-down Shelves ■ How to Install a Pull-down Shelf 1 2 A pull-down shelf makes wall cabinets more user-friendly by bringing all the contents down to eye level. Because of the space taken up by the Tools & Materials ▸ Tape measure ⁄2” MDF 1 mechanism and the shelf boxes, this is not a good Pencil Fasteners & finishing project for a narrow cabinet. Circular saw materials for shelf boxes Before you begin this project, hold each swing arm Drill #8 panhead screws assembly against the inside face of the cabinet side Awl Coarse-thread drywall and make sure both arms will clear the door hinge and Hacksaw screws the cabinet face frame. If the arms do not clear, add Allen wrench Lumber for custom spacers custom wood spacers of plywood or solid lumber that Swing-up shelf kit & Wallboard screws are at least as large as the swing arm mounting plates. hardware Follow the manufacturer’s specifications for the box dimensions, which will be based on the size of your cabinet. If the boxes are bare wood, lightly sand the edges and finish all sides with a highly washable paint or a clear varnish, such as polyurethane. For Shopping Tips ▸ melamine-coated board, cover the cut edges with melamine tape to keep water from damaging the • Specialty hardware catalogs carry pull-down Use the shelf manufacturer’s paper template to determine Use the template as a reference for marking the location wood core. shelf hardware. the general positions of the swing arms, then fasten the wood of the swing arm mounting plates with a scratch awl. Drill a Note: The springs that help raise the arms are strong spacers to the inside faces of the cabinets with coarse-thread pilot hole at each mark. Fasten the swing arms to the custom and may make it difficult to lower empty shelves. When • Make sure the capacity of the mechanism you are wallboard screws. The screws should not go completely spacers or cabinet sides with #8 panhead screws (inset). The the shelves are loaded, the weight of the items makes it purchasing matches the weight of the items you will through the cabinet side. screws should not go completely through the cabinet side. easier to move the shelf. be storing on the shelf.

                                                                                                                            3                                                                     4
                                                                                       A pull-down shelf is essentially
                                                                                       the opposite of a swing-up
                                                                                       shelf. Mounted in an upper wall
                                                                                       cabinet, a pull-down shelf can
                                                                                       be drawn out of the cabinet and
                                                                                       lowered so the user can reach
                                                                                       the contents more easily.

                                                                                                                          Build two shelf boxes from 1⁄2" MDF. Paint and install the            Position the box unit in front of the cabinet, rotate the lower
                                                                                                                          boxes between the sides of the shelf unit using the predrilled        arms downward, and secure them to the side pieces using the
                                                                                                                          holes in the side pieces. Secure the boxes with #8 panhead            bolts, washers, and nuts provided. Insert the top handle. Lower
                                                                                                                          screws. Because the lower box can be installed in only one            the upper arms one at a time, and insert the handle end into
                                                                                                                          position, install it first. Then, find the desired position for the   the arm. Secure the handle with the two setscrews in each
                                                                                                                          upper box, and secure it in place. Slide the lower handle             arm using an Allen wrench.
                                                                                                                          through the holes in the side pieces.

64 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 65

Customizing Cabinets Attach crown molding. This project is for face-frame cabinets, since frameless cabinets do not have the traditional look that crown molding complements. If your cabinets have exposed sides with a lip or

                                                                      E   ven if you don’t have the time or need to pursue
                                                                          a complete kitchen remodel, there are some ways
                                                                      to easily freshen the look of your cabinets. You can
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  edge trim, you will need to remove a portion
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  of the lip or add a 3⁄4" wide x 1⁄8" trim strip
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  to build up the side to match the lip. To
                                                                      raise a single wall cabinet within a bank of cabinets to                                                                                                    remove the lip, measure down 3⁄4" from the
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  top of the cabinets and mark a line on the
                                                                      create more space for countertop appliances or simply
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  lip. Use a fine-tooth backsaw to carefully
                                                                      to change the look. This tactic works especially well                                                                                                       cut down to the side of the cabinet. Use a
                                                                      on corner cabinets. Or, you can convert a cabinet to                                                                                                        chisel to remove the upper part of the lip.
                                                                      open shelving and create a new display area. Adding                                                                                                         Cut the longest piece of crown molding first.
                                                                      crown molding to stock cabinets will give your whole                                                                                                        Measure the cabinet run from end to end.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Using a compound miter saw, cut each end
                                                                      kitchen a more finished look. Another idea is to
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  at 221⁄2°. Install the molding 3⁄4" down from
                                                                      remove a cabinet door panel, replace it with a                                                                                                              the top of the cabinets. Nail the molding in
                                                                      glass door, and form an enclosed display space.                                                                                                             place with a finish nailer (photo). Cut the end
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  piece to fit and nail in place.
                                                                      Create a display cabinet. If your cabinets have removable
                                                                      shelves, you can transform one or more of them into a display
                                                                      cabinet. Begin by removing the door and hinges and removing
                                                                      the existing shelves and shelf supports. Fill the screw holes
                                                                      and finish to match the cabinet exterior. Paint the inside of
                                                                      the cabinet with gloss enamel. Create a template with guide
                                                                      holes for pin-style shelf supports. Drill the holes for the shelf
                                                                      supports. Measure the space and order tempered glass
                                                                      shelves to fit.                                                      ■ How to Install a Glass Panel Door
                                                                                                                                             1                                                                    2

                                                                                                                                           Cut a recess for a glass panel in the frame. Use a router            Install the glass. Measure the cutout and order a piece
                                                                                                                                           with a straight bit to cut away the lip on the rails and stiles of   of tempered glass to fit. Consider the many types of glass,
                                                                                                                                           the door that holds the panel in place. Set the router to the        including frosted and pebbled glass to coordinate with the
                                                                                                                                           depth of the lip. Clamp the door to the worksurface. Clamp           rest of the kitchen. Use glass clips (See Resources, page 282)

Raise a cabinet. To raise a cabinet, remove the contents of the cabinet and the adjoining cabinets. Remove any trim or crown guides to the worksurface. Rout out the lip. Remove the panel. to install the glass panel. Reattach the hardware and rehang molding. Remove the screws holding the face frames together or the binder bolts holding the cabinet cases together in a frameless Square the corners of the cutout with a chisel. the door. cabinet. Remove the screws holding the cabinet to the wall. Move the cabinet up 4 to 6”. It is likely it will stick from paint or age. If so, use a hammer against a padded piece of 2 × 4 to persuade it to move (you’ll want a helper to steady the cabinet). Reinstall the cabinet at its new height. Refinish the cabinet sides to match.

66 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 67

Vertical Dividers ■ How to Install Vertical Dividers 1 2 M ost kitchen cabinets are based on a one-box-fits- all design, and this works fine for much of the stuff we need to store there. But some things just can’t The following steps show two simple methods for adding vertical dividers. One version is adjustable and allows you to move dividers as needed to be conveniently stored on a horizontal shelf; namely accommodate new storage items. The second method large, flat items like platters, party trays, cutting includes fixed dividers but retains a little more boards, and baking sheets. These common kitchen headroom in the cabinet than with the adjustable products end up getting loaded onto shelves in heavy system. If necessary, a fixed divider can be moved by stacks, and when you need an item it’s inevitably near unscrewing and refastening its slotted cleats. the bottom of the stack. Vertical cabinet dividers solve this common problem by letting you stow the big, flat stuff on-edge, making for easy retrieval of items. You can custom- Tools & Materials ▸ fit the dividers for any wall or base cabinet. One of Circular saw ⁄8” MDF 3

the best places to use dividers is in over-the-fridge Straightedge guide ⁄4” plywood 1

cabinets, which are short and wide and tend to be a Router and 5⁄16” straight bit Wood screws or coarse- good fit for sheet pans and platters without wasting Drill thread drywall screws space. If this space is too high or too cumbersome to reach up and over the fridge, consider using the space Cut two MDF panels to fit the inside dimensions of the top Clamp the MDF pieces to a bench with their faces up and above or below a fixed shelf in a full-height cabinet. and bottom of the cabinet. On one of the pieces, mark the their edges aligned. Using a router and a straightedge guide, locations of the divider slots using any spacing you like. Note: mill a 5⁄16”-wide × 3⁄16”-deep groove into both pieces at each slot With traditional face-frame cabinets, you may need extra MDF location. If the cabinet has a center partition (middle stile), cut pieces or lumber spacers behind the slotted piece so that the the pieces in half so you’ll be able to fit them into the cabinet. slots extend below the face-frame overhang.

                                                                                                                               3                                                                    4

                                                                                                                             Install the top and bottom pieces into the cabinet so the            Variation: For a cabinet with a deep overhanging face-frame,
                                                                                                                             slots are aligned. Fasten the top piece in place with screws.        you can save headroom by using slotted 1 × 2 or 2 × 2 cleats

Vertical storage of flat pieces means less wasted cabinet space and no more sorting through stacks when Measure vertically between the slot bottoms, then cut the to hold the panels instead of solid top and bottom pieces. retrieving or replacing an item. divider panels 1⁄16” shorter than this dimension. Slide the panels Mill the cleats with a router and fasten them to the cabinet into place at the desired spacing. with screws.

68 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 69

Custom Cabinets

                                  T   he simple base cabinet and hanging wall cabinet
                                      shown here use the same basic construction as
                                  professionally built kitchen cabinets, but because
                                                                                                       Cutting Sheet Goods ▸
                                  they are custom-designed, trimmed, and finished to                   A full-sized table-saw and a helper, you’ll find no better
                                  blend into the room, they become permanent built-in                  combination for cutting full-sheet panels, with the possible
                                  features of your home.                                               exception of a panel saw. But if you are working alone, it is
                                       These basic cabinets are built with maple                       still possible to cut full panels down to size accurately and
                                  plywood, which gives them the look of fine custom-                   safely using a circular saw. The main difficulty beginners
                                  made cabinets, but at a much reduced cost. The base                  encounter when cutting panels with a circular saw is that
                                  cabinet has extra-large drawers that are well suited for             they do not adequately support the waste so it falls away
                                  storing table linens.                                                prematurely and ruins the cut (or causes an accident).
                                       You can use the methods shown here to build a                   Another common mistake is to support both ends so the
                                  single based cabinet with a wall cabinet above it or                 area being cut binds on the saw blade as the cut is made.
                                  several cabinets side by side (for a full wall of storage            The solution is simply to support the entire panel along
                                  or display).                                                         both edges with sacrificial scraps of 2 × 4. Set your saw
                                                                                                       blade to cut just slightly deeper than the thickness of the
                                                                                                       panel. The blade will score the 2 × 4s as it cuts, but they
                                      Tools & Materials ▸                                              will continue to support the workpiece all the way through
                                                                                                       the cut. Be sure to use a straightedge guide for your saw,
                                      Electronic stud finder           Pocket screw jig                and always cut with the good face down when using a
                                      Cordless screwdriver             Wood glue                       circular saw.
                                      Hammer                           Biscuits, splines, or dowels
                                      Tape measure                     Finish nails (1", 2", 3", 4")
                                      Utility knife                    Shims
                                      Router with bits                 Pin-style shelf supports
                                        (3⁄4" straight, 1⁄4" rabbet)   ⁄4" plywood
                                                                       3                               Overlay Doors ▸
                                      Drill and bits                   1 × 3, 1 × 6, 2 × 4 lumber
                                      Right-angle drill guide          1 × 3 maple                     Easy-to-build overlay doors, made with 1⁄2" finish-grade
                                      Pegboard scraps                  Finishing materials             plywood panels framed with door-edge moldings, are
                                      Pipe clamps                      Drawer and door hardware        designed to overhang the face frame by about 3⁄8" on
                                                                                                                                                                                              ⁄ 2" finish-
                                                                                                                                                                                              1

                                      Level                            Trim or base shoe molding       each side. Semi-concealed overlay hinges, which require                                grade plywood
                                      Sander                           Wood putty                      no mortising, are attached to the back of the door and
                                      Circular saw                     Countertop hardwood (see        to the edge of the face frame. This door style also can be      Face frame
                                      Power-driver screws                  page 80)                    adapted to make folding doors.
                                        (3⁄4", 21⁄2", 31⁄2")

                                  Building your own custom cabinets from scratch
                                  isn’t necessarily a cost-savings venture, but it allows
                                  you to populate your kitchen with sturdy cabinets
                                  made of high-quality materials with the exact tone 		                                                                                                                 Door-edge
                                  and appearance you want.                                                                                                                                              molding

                                                                                                                                                                             Semi-concealed
                                                                                                                                                                             hinge

70 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 71

Exploded View of Hanging Wall Cabinet Exploded View of Base Cabinet

                                                                                                                 Detail 1:
                                                                                                                 Cutaway view                                                   E
                                                        C                                                        of assembly

                                    B                                                                                                        I

                                                            D                               A
                                                                                                                                                       A                        D            B

                                                                                  E                                                                                                 D                   F
                                                                                                                                                 Detail
                                                                                                        E         P/U BIPFTH 94                       1                                 F        F
                                                    F                                                                                                                                                   F        F
                                                                                                                  Detail 1: Cutaway view of assembly
                                                                                                                  Exploded view of base cabinet
                                                                                            E                                                                                           F
                                                                                                                  Parts List: Base Cabinet
                      A                                                                                     G
                                                                                                                  Project as Shown           B                                                                                   H
                                                                   E                                              Key            Part		                    Material			    F         F Pieces            Size
                                                                                                                  A              Back panel 1/2" maple plywood          1   34 1/2 x 35 1/4"
                                                            D                                                     B
                                                                                                                  C
                                                                                                                                 Side panels 3/4" maple plywoodC
                                                                                                                                 Bottom panel 3/4" maple plywood
                                                                                                                                                                        2
                                                                                                                                                                        1
                                                                                                                                                                            34 1/2 x 17 14"
                                                                                                                                                                            16 3/4 x 35 1/4"
                                                                                                    E             D              Supports		                1 x 3 maple		    2             34 1/2"
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 E
                                                                                                                  E              Countertop 3/4" plywood		              2   36 1/4 x 18"
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     Trim
                                                                                                                  F              Face Frame 1 x 3 maple			                  15 linear ft. G
                                                                                                                  G              Bottom Rail 1 x 6 maple		              1   31 1/4"
                                                                                                                  H              Overlay drawers
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 D
                                                                                                                  I              Trim molding					                                        12 linear ft.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                             B           F
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     F

                                                                                  Exploded view of
                                                                                  hanging wall cabinet

      Parts List: Wall Cabinet                                                                                            Parts List: Base Cabinet
      Project as Shown                                                                                                    Project as Shown

      Key   Part                           Material                Pieces          Size                                   Key        Part               Material                        Pieces              Size

      A     Side panels                    3
                                               ⁄4" maple plywood   2               111⁄4" × 30"                           A          Back panel         1
                                                                                                                                                            ⁄2" maple plywood           1                   341⁄2 × 351⁄4"
      B     Back panel                     1
                                               ⁄4" maple plywood   1               30" × 351⁄4"                           B          Side panels        3
                                                                                                                                                            ⁄4" maple plywood           2                   341⁄2 × 171⁄4"
      C     Nailing strip                  1 × 3 maple             1               341⁄4"                                 C          Bottom panel       3
                                                                                                                                                            ⁄4" maple plywood           1                   163⁄4 × 351⁄4"
      D     Top, bottom panels             3
                                               ⁄4" maple plywood   2               351⁄4 × 111⁄4"                         D          Supports           1 × 3 maple                     2                   341⁄2"
      E     Face frame                     1 × 3 maple             12 linear ft                                           E          Countertop         3
                                                                                                                                                            ⁄4" plywood                 2                   361⁄4 × 18"
      F     Shelves                        3
                                               ⁄4" maple plywood   2               93⁄4 × 341⁄4"                          F          Face-frame         1 × 3 maple                     15 linear ft.
      G     Glass panel or overlay doors                                                                                  G          Bottom rail        1 × 6 maple                     1                   311⁄4"
                                                                                                                          H          Overlay drawers
                                                                                                                          I          Trim molding       12 linear ft.

72 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 73

■ Wall Cabinet Project Details 3 4

Side panels are made from 3⁄4” plywood and have 3⁄4”-wide, A back panel made from 1⁄4” plywood has a 1 × 3 nailing strip Measure and cut 3⁄4” plywood top and bottom panels, then Attach the back panel (see page 72 and 73) using glue and 3 ⁄8”-deep dadoes where bottom and top panels fit and 1⁄4”-wide mounted 11⁄2” below the top edge of the back panel and set in glue and clamp the side panels to the top and bottom panels 3 ⁄4” screws. Set the back panel into the rabbets at the back rabbets where the back panel fits. Rows of parallel peg holes, 3 ⁄8” on each side. It is fastened with glue and 3⁄4” screws driven to form dado joints. Reinforce the joints with 2” finish nails edges of the cabinet. Secure the back with 11⁄2” finish nails 11⁄2” in from edges, hold pin-style shelf supports. through the back panel. driven every 3”. driven into the cabinet edges.

■ How to Build & Install a Wall Cabinet 5 6 1 2

                                                                                                                                       Attach a 1 × 3 nailing strip on the inside of the cabinet,        Make the face frame. Measure the height and width of the
                                                                                                                                       about 11⁄2" down from the top. Drive three 3⁄4" wood screws       cabinet interior and then cut 1 × 3 face-frame rails that are
                                                                                                                                       through the back panel and into the nailing strip, and then       43⁄4" shorter than the cabinet width. Cut face-frame stiles 4"

Measure and cut 3⁄4” plywood side panels, then cut rabbets Drill two parallel rows of 1⁄4”-dia. holes for pin-style shelf drive a pair of 2” finish nails through the side panel and into longer than the height. Glue, square, and then clamp the rails and dadoes using a router and a straightedge guide, following supports on the inside face of each side panel. Use a right- the ends of the nailing strip. between the stiles. You could use biscuits, splines, or dowels the dimensions in the project details (see page 72 and 73). angle drill guide and a scrap of pegboard as a template to to reinforce the joints (these need to be installed before ensure that holes line up correctly. Holes should be no deeper clamping). Here, pocket screws are being driven at the joints of than 3⁄8”—most right-angle drill guides include a depth stop. the face frame using a pocket screw jig. (continued)

74 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 75

 7                                                                 8                                                                11                                                                     12

Center the face frame on the cabinet so the slight overhang Finish the cabinet. Sand all wood surfaces, and then Install the cabinet by setting it onto the temporary ledge, Use a level to make sure the cabinet is plumb. If not, loosen on each side is equal and the top edge of the bottom rail is apply wood stain (if desired) and two or three thin coats of and then brace it in position with a 2 × 4 wedged between the the screws slightly and insert shims behind the cabinet to flush with the bottom shelf surface. Attach the face frame with polyurethane or other topcoat material. Use tinted wood putty cabinet and the floor below (or the base cabinet, if present). adjust it to plumb. Tighten the screws completely, score shims glue and 2” finish nails driven through pilot holes. that matches the color of the stained wood to fill nail holes. Drill countersunk pilot holes in the nailing strip at the top of the with a utility knife, and break off excess. cabinet, and drive 3” screws into the wall studs.

 9                                                                 10                                                               13                                                                     14

Mark a level reference line on the wall where the bottom Attach a temporary ledger strip to the wall studs so the Build or buy cabinet doors. A simple overlay door can be Build and install shelves. Here, shelves are made from 3⁄4”- edge of the cabinet will be located—54” above the floor is a top edge is flush with the reference line using screws. made from 1⁄2” plywood that matches the cabinet and door- thick plywood with a 1⁄4 × 3⁄4” hardwood strip nosing on the front standard height. Locate the wall studs and mark their locations edge molding that is mitered at the corners to frame the edge. Set the finished shelves on shelf pins inserted in the beneath the reference line. plywood panel. Hang the cabinet doors with hinges. pin-holes drilled in the cabinet side.

76 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 77

■ Base Cabinet Project Details 3 4

                                                                                      5 3⁄4"                   16 1⁄2"
             Rabbet
                                                                                       14 3⁄8"

                   Dado                                                               10"                                34 1⁄2"

                                                                                                     31 1⁄4"

Side panels made from 3⁄4” plywood have 3⁄4”-wide, 3⁄8”-deep The face frame includes 1 × 6 bottom rails and 1 × 3s for dadoes to hold the bottom panel and 1⁄2”-wide, 3⁄8”-deep rabbets the stiles and other rails. Cut and assemble the face frame, where the back panel will fit. The bottom dado is raised so the following the dimensions shown in the photo above. Use Build the face-frame from 1 × 3 maple (actual sizes 3⁄4 × 21⁄2” Attach the face frame to the cabinet with glue and 2” finish bottom drawer will be at a comfortable height. biscuits, splines, or dowels to reinforce the joints. Alternately, and 3⁄4 × 51⁄4”). The glued joints can be reinforced with biscuits, nails driven through pilot holes. The face-frame should be flush drive pocket screws after the parts are glued and clamped. splines, or dowels prior to assembly, or they can be glued, with the cabinet tops, slightly above the cabinet bottoms, and clamped, and reinforced with pocket screws, as seen here. overhanging the sides equally by a small amount. Sand and finish the cabinet as desired.

■ How to Build & Install a Base Cabinet 1 2 5 6

Assemble cabinet panels. Cut the side and bottom panels Install two 1 × 3 spreaders between the side panels at from 3⁄4” plywood (cabinet-grade maple is seen here), and cut the top of the cabinet. Clamp the spreaders in position and the 1⁄2” plywood back panel. Use a router and piloted rabbet bit attach them with glue and 2” finish nails driven through the to create 3⁄8 × 1⁄2” rabbets in the side panels for the back panel. side panels. Cut dadoes for the bottom panel into the side panels using a Install the cabinet. Mark the locations of the wall studs in Anchor the cabinet by driving 31⁄2” screws through router, straight bit, and straightedge guide. Install the bottom the project area, and then set the cabinet in place. Check with the back panel and into wall studs just below the top of panel between the side panels. Glue, clamp, and then drive a level and shim under the cabinet, if necessary, to level it. the cabinet. finish nails through the side panels and into the ends of the Toenail the side panels to the floor at shim locations using 2” bottom panel. finish nails. Score shims, and break off excess. (continued)

78 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 79

                                                                                                                                Building Overlay Drawers ▸
 7                                                           8
                                                                                                                                       Back panel: 1⁄ 2"
                                                                                                                                        finish grade
                                                                                                                                          plywood
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             ⁄ 4" dadoes

                                                                                                                                                                                     Side panels: 1⁄ 2"
                                                                                                                                                                                  finish-grade plywood

                                                                                                                                                                                    Bottom panels: 1⁄ 4"
                                                                                                                                                                                  finish-grade plywood

Build or purchase drawers. Simple overlay drawers Install drawer slide hardware on the drawer. Slides may be are easy to make from 1⁄2” plywood and a false front made center-mounted, as seen here, or side-mounted in of hardwood. Refer to the information on page 81 for pairs. Typically, side-mounted slides are rated for higher Front panel: Face: 3⁄ 4” hardwood construction details and guidance on sizing drawers. weight capacity. 1 ⁄ 2” finish-grade plywood

 9                                                           10
                                                                                                                                 Anatomy of an overlay drawer: The basic drawer box is made using 1⁄2" plywood for the front, back, and side panels
                                                                                                                                with a 1⁄4" plywood bottom panel. The bottom panel fits into 1⁄4" dadoes cut near the bottom of the front and side panels
                                                                                                                                and is nailed to the bottom edge of the back panel. The hardwood drawer face is screwed to the drawer front from the
                                                                                                                                inside, and it is sized to overhang the face frame by 1⁄2" on all sides. Note: This drawer is designed to be mounted with
                                                                                                                                a center-mounted drawer slide attached to the bottom of the drawer. If you use different hardware, like side-mounted
                                                                                                                                drawer slides, you will need to alter this design according to slide manufacturer’s directions.

                                                                                                                                                                                                 Part                  Measurement

                                                                                                                                                                                                 Sides      Length     Depth of opening, minus 3"
                                                                                                                                                                                                 Sides      Height     Height of opening, minus 1⁄2"
                                                                                                                                                                                                 Front      Length     Width of opening, minus 11⁄2"
                                                                                                                                                                          Depth
                                                                                                                                                                                                 Front      Height     Height of opening, minus 1⁄2"
                                                                                                                                                                                                 Back       Length     Width of opening, minus 11⁄2"
                                                                                                                                                                                                 Back       Height     Height of opening, minus 1"
                                                                                                                                                                                                 Bottom     Width      Width of opening, minus 1"

Mount drawer slide hardware in the cabinet interior Add the countertop of your choice. See pages 86 to 89 for Width Bottom Depth Depth of opening, minus 23⁄4” according to the manufacturer’s instructions. Install the Height information on choosing a countertop type and building it drawers and test the fit. Add drawer pull hardware. Face Length Width of opening, plus 1” yourself. If you are building just a single base cabinet, consider a higher end material such as solid surfacing or granite. The Face Height Height of opening, plus 1” small scale will let you introduce an expensive material without spending a fortune.

80 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Cabinets ■ 81

Kitchen Cabinet Paint ■ How to Paint Cabinets 1 2 P ainting the cabinets can brighten any drab and dreary kitchen. Doing the job properly does require a substantial amount of work, however, but the A

                                                                                      B
                                                                                                                   C

payoff is large. As with most painting jobs, preparation is crucial to success. Kitchen cabinets have been exposed to years of grease and water damage, so D thorough cleaning and sanding is necessary. Before H E sanding previously painted kitchen cabinets, test the F G existing paint for lead. Do not sand lead-based paint. I It is toxic. If veneer layers have bubbled from water damage, slice away the loose veneer, fill the area with wood L

filler, and then sand smooth when dry. Note: Nonwood M N cabinets, such as melamine-coated, are difficult to K repaint due to the impenetrable nature of the surface. There are specialty paints available, however, that O

bond reasonably well to these slick, nonwood surfaces. J Begin painting by labeling each door and its cabinet bay with a number printed on Sand all surfaces with 100-grit Many of them are oil-based, which creates more painters’ tape. This will help you replace the doors and drawers. Remove all the doors, sandpaper. Fill all screw holes and fumes and makes cleanup more difficult. The steps for drawers, and hardware. Clean all surfaces—front, back, top, bottom, inside, outside, nicks and dents with wood filler, and Tools and materials for painting wood cabinets include: painting melamine are the same as for painting wood. edges—with a grease-cutting cleaner such as synthetic trisodium phosphate (TSP). then sand smooth when dry. If you are (A) Semigloss or gloss enamel paint; (B) wash bucket; (C) Metal cabinets can also be repainted. The best results Follow the directions carefully. reusing the same hardware, you do not primer; (D) roller tray; (E) roller sleeve (3”); (F) paintbrushes; for metal are obtained using spray paint. need to fill the screw holes. (G) rags; (H) TSP cleaner and rubber gloves; (I) palm sander; (J) new cabinet hardware (optional); (K) screwdriver; (L) putty knife; (M) wood filler; (N) sandpaper (100- and 150-grit) and (O)

                                                                                                                                 3                                                                    4
                                                          sanding block.

                                                                                              Painting cabinets is an
                                                                                              easy and inexpensive way
                                                                                              to brighten up your kitchen.
                                                                                              Painted cabinets also
                                                                                              happen to be popular in
                                                                                              current design trends.

                                                                                                                               Prime the surfaces. Use a synthetic brush to paint all              Apply a coat of latex enamel paint using 3"-wide short nap
                                                                                                                               surfaces with a coat of high-quality, sandable acrylic primer.      rollers. Make sure to smooth out any drips. Allow the paint to
                                                                                                                               Allow the primer to dry. Sand with 150-grit sandpaper to            dry completely. Apply a second coat. Allow to dry thoroughly.
                                                                                                                               remove brush marks and drips.                                       Install the hardware and rehang the doors.

82 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Kitchen Cabinets ■ 83

Countertops Y our countertops play an important role in your kitchen. They must be sturdy and durable enough to withstand the daily pounding and chopping that goes on in most kitchens. They should resist staining and heat and be easy to clean. And because they command so much visible area, they have a great impact on the appearance of the kitchen. In short, if you don’t like the look of your countertops, you won’t like your kitchen. While you will find a wide range of countertop types in the marketplace, just a handful of them are truly well suited for DIY installation. Among these are postform (probably the easiest to work with) and plastic laminate countertops. Installing tiled countertops remains a very popular DIY project, with traditional ceramic floor tiles still the leading product. Newer variations are increasing in popularity, however, including tiles that are made from natural stone such as granite. Poured concrete countertops are another option that has seen strong growth in popularity and is a manageable DIY project if you have some concrete experience and plenty of patience. Although it is possible to get around the restrictions if you’re a creative type, manufacturers of solid surfacing and quartz countertop materials generally insist that only licensed technicians do the installations. Natural stone countertops are simply too heavy for most homeowners to install. Stainless steel countertops are popular now, too, but they require a lot of skill and some expensive fabricating equipment to be installed correctly.

This chapter shows: • Countertop Selection • Post-form Countertop • Butcher Block Countertop • Laminate Countertop • Tile Countertop • Granite Countertop • Tile Backsplash ■ 85

Countertop Selection ■ Laminate & Post-form M ore than simply a worksurface, a kitchen countertop can dazzle with the look-at-me drama of mottled granite or bring together a country through ceramic and stone tile, to concrete and wood, to high-end granite and marble. Countertop options for your kitchen depend Laminate countertops are formed from layers of resin-saturated paper and plastic that are bonded under pressure, then given a protective coating. theme with honed soapstone and butcher block. But on how much you are willing to spend, whether The laminate is bonded to a substrate to create the durability and maintenance (and cost of course) are you will be doing it yourself or contracting it out, countertop. Also available is through-color laminate, generally the primary concerns when it comes to and what look you want to achieve. When choosing in which the surface color runs all the way through. countertops. countertops, remember that you do not need to have This product doesn’t have the dark edge of standard Some materials, like granite, can withstand a uniform countertop. Many people choose to use laminate and does not show surface damage as easily, the heat of pots and pans, so they are better suited more expensive countertop materials as accents or for but it is two to three times more expensive. for heavy-duty cooks. Others, including laminate, islands rather than for the entire kitchen. And last, but The cheapest laminate countertop is are affordable options that come in a wide variety not least, if you are inclined toward green remodeling ready-made post-form. A post-form countertop of modern colors. There are many choices in practices, you may find some surprises when you comprises a backsplash, counter, and bullnose front countertops, from the less-expensive laminate, compare countertop materials (see page 87). apron formed into one seamless piece. Home centers Plastic laminate is bonded to a particleboard subbase with carry post-form countertop options in various lengths contact cement. and in a few stock colors. You can also have a custom post-form countertop made, which will be slightly more expensive. One limitation of laminate countertops is that sinks must be drop-in, not undermounted. Though the laminate itself is waterproof, the particleboard or plywood it is attached to will swell if it gets wet. Laminate is also not as heat-proof or scratch-proof as other countertop materials.

                                                                                                                                 ■ Tile
                                                                                                                                 Whether they are ceramic or natural stone, tile             Post-form countertops have a laminate surface that is
                                                                                                                                 countertops are popular, mid-priced options. If you         applied at the factory.
                                                                                                                                 like the look of granite but don’t want to pay the price,
                                                                                                                                 granite tile can create a similar look for substantially
                                                                                                                                 less, especially if you do the installation yourself.
                                                                                                                                 When selecting tiles for countertops, make sure they
                                                                                                                                 are floor tiles—wall tiles will not stand up to the wear
                                                                                                                                 and tear of countertop use.
                                                                                                                                      Two major drawbacks of ceramic or stone tile
                                                                                                                                 are hardness and grout lines. Glassware and pottery
                                                                                                                                 will break and chip readily when knocked or dropped
                                                                                                                                 against this surface. Grout lines make the surface
                                                                                                                                 uneven and difficult to keep clean, so choose
                                                                                                                                 larger tiles to minimize grout lines. Using tiles for a
                                                                                                                                 backsplash is an excellent way to get the look of tile
                                                                                                                                 near the countertop.

Fabricated countertop material like quartz and solid-surface is virtually impenetrable to water. If it becomes scratched, minor Tiles are set into a bed of thinset mortar troweled onto a damage can easily be buffed out. cementboard or tilebacker subbase.

86 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 87

■ Solid Surface ■ Stainless Steel Solid-surface countertops, commonly described by Although it is slightly more expensive than solid the common brand name Corian™, are popular but surface or quartz on a per-square-foot basis, stainless more expensive options. With solid color throughout, steel is a popular countertop material in home the pieces are joined with a bonding compound that kitchens as well as in commercial kitchens. That’s leaves no visible seam line. Solid-surface countertops because it is an impervious material that doesn’t can be shaped and inlaid, it comes in many colors and stain, can handle hot pots, and can be fabricated patterns, it is durable, and light damage like scratches into seamless countertops and sinks. Stainless steel can be repaired easily. Solid-surface should not be countertops for residential use are usually bonded used as a cutting board, however, and hot pans cannot to plywood or particleboard to quiet the noise and be placed directly on the surface. Most spills are easily prevent denting. Sinks can either be fabricated as cleaned with soap and water. part of the countertop, or, more likely, welded in. Though solid-surface materials are easily worked Either way, it is a seamless application. The biggest with standard hand tools, do-it-yourselfers may have downside is that stainless steel shows fingerprints and difficulty purchasing the materials and bonding watermarks, especially on a polished surface, so it’s agents. If a non-licensed installer installs one of those best to get a matte or satin surface. Stainless steel countertops normally are bonded to a countertops, the manufacturer will not honor any plywood subbase in residential applications. product warranties.

                                                           Solid-surface countertops can be installed on islands or as
                                                                                                                         ■ Butcher Block & Wood
                                                           accents if you don’t have the budget to put them everywhere   Advancing technology in wood finishes and sealants
                                                           in your kitchen.
                                                                                                                         have made wood countertops a viable option for
                                                                                                                         kitchen applications. Historically, the amount of water

■ Quartz Surfaces splashed around a sink would ruin a wood surface. The best of the wood options is butcher block, which Quartz countertops resemble solid-surface can be ordered and installed as a relatively easy DIY countertops in many ways, but they have a higher project. Butcher block is made up of small pieces percentage of mineral material versus plastic resins of wood glued together into a slab. It’s generally and binders. Quartz surfaces are manufactured from categorized as either end grain, which is composed 93 percent quartz and 7 percent pigments, resins, and of vertical pieces of wood, or edge grain, made of binders. Because all quartz surfaces are manufactured long strips of wood. The thickness of stock slabs can using essentially the same equipment and formulas, vary, from 11⁄2” for the standard countertop to 4” for any difference in appearance among products is due to an island or small-section installation. Many people the type of quartz used. assume that butcher block is convenient because you The quartz surface is unscratchable, non-porous, no longer need cutting boards, but it’s a poor idea to Butcher block material is sold in standard countertop width non-staining, does not need to be sealed, and will not use them as direct cutting surfaces. Every nick and and thickness and in varying lengths. scorch or mar from high heat. Although it is as hard as cut will collect dirt and will darken differently when granite, quartz has more inherent flexibility, so surface the surface is reoiled. Wood, no matter how well it is cracking does not occur. The surface is cool to the sealed, expands and contracts in relation to humidity touch, like granite and marble. levels, so installation of a wood countertop requires special considerations (see pages 96 to 101).

                                                           Quartz countertops are almost solid granulated and
                                                           reconstituted quartz (the most common mineral on earth).

88 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 89

                                                                                                                             Comparing Countertop Materials ▸

■ Concrete Countertops Material Description Making it Greener Concrete has become a very popular, exceptionally cast in and ornamental objects can be embedded in dramatic countertop choice. It is a custom option, the concrete for added functionality or just to make Plastic Laminate Paper and resin laminate glued to particle board (or MDF) substrate. Use formaldehyde-free, recycled-wood substrate and but is not as expensive as granite. It can be cast in it more unique. Concrete needs to be resealed low-VOC adhesive; laminate should be made with Resistant to stains, scratches, and moisture; easy to clean; inexpensive. place under certain conditions, but as a moderate regularly, or it will permanently stain. recycled paper and water-based resins, if possible. to difficult DIY project, it should be created off- Acidic foods will etch the surface. Like ceramic Surface susceptible to chipping and burning; damage cannot be repaired. site where the dust and chemicals can be easily tile and stone surfaces, it has no give, so expect Paper-resin Solid slab of paper and resin. Choose product with high recycled content; purchase managed. Concrete can be dyed or stained in a greater number of broken glasses and plates. from local or regional supplier/fabricator to Highly workable for custom applications; solid color and same durability many different colors and will accept a virtually Custom concrete sinks as part of the counter are minimize shipping. throughout slab; resistant to stains and heat. unlimited number of finishes. Drainboards can be also possible. May need periodic cleaning and finishing treatments.

                                                                                                                             Tile                 Ceramic, porcelain, or glass tiles glued to cementboard and wood substrate.       Use tiles with recycled content or locally produced tiles.

                                                                                                                                                 Durable and highly heat-resistant; tiles are highly washable; versatile material   Use marine plywood and/or seal plywood to reduce
                                                                                                                                                 for custom applications.					                                                      formaldehyde offgassing; set tiles with low-VOC adhesive.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Seal grout and tiles (if necessary) with
                                                                                                                                                  Grout between tiles is prone to staining and must be sealed periodically.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            formaldehyde-free, low-VOC sealer.

                                                                                                                             Glass Composite     Solid slab of glass and resin binder.				                                          Choose product with high recycled content.
                                                                                                                                                                                                           Purchase from local or regional fabricator to
                                                                                                                                                 Durable; unique appearance; heat- and scratch-resistant.
                                                                                                                                                                                                           minimize shipping.
                                                                                                                                                 May require periodic cleaning and/or sealing treatments.

                                                                                                                             Butcher Block       Solid-wood strips laminated to form a slab.			                                     Choose only FSC-certified wood.

                                                                                                                                                 Natural, renewable material; good surface for cutting; can be refinished.          Treat surface with food-safe finishes and sealers.

Concrete countertops are cast in forms in a well-ventilated work area and then transported to the cabinets after they are Must be oiled and sealed periodically to maintain appearance. machined and polished. Stainless Steel Alloy of steel, nickel, and chromium; often glued to wood substrate. Recycle the metal if you replace the countertops.

                                                                                                                                                 Highly durable, rustproof, and easy to clean.			                                   Use formaldehyde-free substrate.

■ Stone Can be scratched and dented. Soapstone, slate, marble, and granite are all types comes in an ever-increasing array of colors—ranging Natural Stone Solid quarried stone slabs or tiles glued to substrate. Look for salvaged slabs or buy stone from local quarry. of natural stone that are used for countertops. from whites and blacks to pinks, reds, yellows, and Although they are all quarried stone and are all greens—as more countries begin exporting their local Durable; heatproof and waterproof. fairly expensive, they have numerous differences. granites. The main drawback is that it must be sealed Can chip and crack; some varieties will stain; dark colors Soapstone has been used for kitchen countertops and to prevent staining. make cleaning problematic. sinks for hundreds of years. Though the stone itself is Engineered Stone Composite of quartz or other stone, pigments, and polyester resin. Purchase from a manufacturer in your region and use a easily workable with nonspecialized tools, its surface local fabricator. is nonabsorbent and unaffected by either acids Same color and durability throughout slab; doesn’t require sealing. or alkalis. The surface will age to a glossy patina, Solid-surface Composite of petrochemical-based resins (polyester, acrylic) and bauxite Green options are limited; perhaps minimize quantity or it can be oiled to achieve this finish. Slate for of countertop. countertops is durable, hard, and dense. Scratches can be rubbed out, its surface is nonabsorbing and Color and durability consistent throughout material; highly workable it does not require sealing. Slate comes in shades and customizable. of green, purple, gray, and black, with a rare red Concrete Available in various forms, including poured-in-place concrete, cast concrete, Look for products with high recycled content, such as available at a higher cost. and fiber cement composite materials. fly ash (to replace high-embodied energy and The beauty of marble comes from its veining aggregates cement). patterns—unfortunately these are mini fault lines Versatile material is highly customizable; durable and heat-resistant. Color material with natural, nontoxic pigments added along which the stone will easily break, especially to concrete mix instead of stains applied to surface. if improperly installed. Some marble is as hard as Can be very heavy; prone to cracking, chipping, and staining; must be granite, but most is fairly soft and scratches easily. sealed regularly. A big slab of beautiful, natural stone makes an Granite is the hardest of the stone countertops. It incomparable countertop that is normally at the top of the cost range.

90 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 91

Post-form Countertop ■ How to Install a Post-form Countertop OPTION: Use a jigsaw fitted 1 with a downstroke blade to cut

P post-form. If you are unable ost-form laminate countertops are available in to locate a downstroke blade, stock and custom colors. Pre-mitered sections you can try applying tape over are available for two- or three-piece countertops that the cutting lines, but you are continue around corners. If the countertop has an still likely to get tear-out from a exposed end, you will need an endcap kit that contains normal upstroke jigsaw blade. a pre-shaped strip of matching laminate. Post-form countertops have either a waterfall edge or a no-drip edge. Stock colors are typically available in 4-, 6-, 8-, 10-, and 12-foot straight lengths and 6- and 8-foot mitered lengths.

   Tools & Materials ▸
   Tape measure             Belt sander
   Framing square           Drill and spade bit
   Pencil                   Cordless screwdriver
   Straightedge             Post-form countertop
   C-clamps                 Wood shims
   Hammer                   Take-up bolts
   Level                    Drywall screws                     Post-form countertops are among the easiest and cheapest
   Caulking gun             Wire brads                         to install. They are a good choice for beginning DIYers, but the
   Jigsaw
   Compass
                            Endcap laminate
                            Silicone caulk
                                                               design and color options are fairly limited.
                                                                                                                                     2                                                                 3
   Adjustable wrench        Wood glue

                                                                                              The following tools and
                                                                     C                        materials will be used in this
                                                                                   D          project: wood for shimming (A);
                                         B                                                    take-up bolts for drawing miters
                                                                                              together (B); household iron
                                                                                              (C); endcap laminate to match
                    A
                                                                                              countertop (D); endcap battens
                                                                                              (E); file (F); adjustable wrench
                                                                                              (G); buildup blocks (H); compass
                                                                                              (I); fasteners (J); silicone caulk
                        K                                                      E              and sealer (K).

                                                           E
    J

                                                                           F

              I

                                                                                                                                   Use a framing square to mark a cutting line on the bottom         Attach the battens from the endcap kit to the edge of the
                                                                      G
                    H
                                                                                                                                   surface of the countertop. Cut off the countertop with a jigsaw   countertop using carpenter’s glue and small brads. Sand out
                                                                                                                                   using a clamped straightedge as a guide.                          any unevenness with a belt sander.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           (continued)

92 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 93

 4                                                              5                                                                    8                                             9                                           10

                                                                                                                                   Mark cutout for self-rimming sink.           Drill a starter hole just inside the         Apply a bead of silicone caulk to

Hold the endcap laminate against the end, slightly Position the countertop on the base cabinets. Make sure Position the sink upside down on cutting line. Make sink cutouts with a the edges of the mitered countertop overlapping the edges. Activate adhesive by pressing an the front edge of the countertop is parallel to the cabinet faces. the countertop and trace its outline. jigsaw. Support the cutout area from sections. Force the countertop pieces iron set at medium heat against the endcap. Cool with a Check the countertop for level. Make sure that drawers and Remove the sink and draw a cutting line below so that the falling cutout does tightly together. wet cloth, then file the endcap laminate flush with the doors open and close freely. If needed, adjust the countertop 5 ⁄ 8” inside the sink outline. not damage the cabinet. edges of the countertop. with shims.

 6                                                              7                                                                    11                                                                   12

Because walls are usually uneven, use a compass to Remove the countertop. Use a belt sander to grind the From underneath the countertop, install and tighten miter Seal the seam between the backsplash and the wall with trace the wall outline onto the backsplash. Set the compass backsplash to the scribe line. take-up bolts. Position the countertop tightly against the wall silicone caulk. Smooth the bead with a wet fingertip. Wipe arms to match the widest gap, then move the compass along and fasten it to the cabinets by driving wallboard screws up away excess caulk. the length of the wall to transfer the outline to the top of through the corner brackets and into the countertop (inset). the backsplash. Apply painter’s tape to the top edge of the Screws should be long enough to provide maximum holding backsplash, following the scribe line (inset). power, but not long enough to puncture the laminate surface.

94 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 95

Butcher Block Countertop Tip ▸ Butcher block sold by the foot for countertop surface. For economy, many of today’s butcher ranges from 11⁄2” to 3” thick, although some end block sections are edge-glued with exposed edge B utcher block slabs come in a variety of woods or— since they are made up of small pieces of wood glued together—a combination of different woods. Tools & Materials ▸ grain products, used mostly for chopping blocks, can be up to 5” thick. For residential kitchens, grain or face grain.

                                                         Circular saw with 		     Router with piloted              the 11⁄2"-thick material is the most available and

They’re available most commonly in maple or oak in cutting guide roundover bit most affordable choice. Stock length varies but end grain, which is composed of vertical pieces of Carpenter’s square Wood screws with 6-foot and 12-foot slabs are common. You can also wood, or edge grain and face grain, made up long strips Drill and bits fender washers order the material with sink cutouts completed. of wood. Making butcher block can be accomplished Bolt connector Jigsaw with downstroke bit Premade countertop is sold in the standard 25” as an advanced DIY project, but it’s often more cost- hardware Brush and finish material depth, but wider versions (30” and 36”) for islands effective (and always faster) to purchase pieces in Caulk gun and silicone Tape are not difficult to find. stock sizes and cut it down to fit your kitchen. Since adhesive Connector fittings Butcher block countertop material comes butcher block is ideal for food prep areas but can be Clamps Forstner bit pre-sealed, but a finish of varnish or oil, such as impractical near a sink or stove, another option is to Sander Silicone adhesive mineral or tung oil, is recommended. Seal cut install a small section of butcher block in combination Varnish Faucet and sink wood around sink cutouts and on trimmed edges with other countertop materials. to keep it watertight. A self-rimming sink is the easiest type Butcher block to mount in a butcher block countertop, but countertops are undermount types can look stunning (just make enjoying a resurgence in sure to get a perfect seal on the end grain around popularity because of their the sink cutout. natural beauty and warm End grain vs. face grain: Traditionally, butcher 25” wood tones. block countertop surfaces were made with square 1 1⁄ 2” sections of wood (often maple) oriented with their end grain facing upward. This orientation creates Typical countertop material is 1½” wide and 25” deep, a better, more durable, knife-friendly cutting available in a number of lengths from 4 ft. to 12 ft. long.

                                                                                                                     End grain

                                                                                                                                                                   Face grain

                                                                                                                                                                                Butcher block that’s constructed with the end grain
                                                                                                                                                                                oriented up is the most desirable, but it is relatively
                                                                                                                                                                                hard to find and fairly expensive. Material with the
                                                                                                                                                                                face grain or edge grain facing up is more common
                                                                                                                                                                                and more affordable (prefinished, it still runs around
                                                                                                                                                                                $30 a linear foot).

                                                                                                                    Edge grain

96 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 97

                                                                                                                                                     Mantesh

■ How to Build a Butcher Block Countertop 1 2 6 35mm Forstner bit 7 Bolt connectors

                                Sink
                                location

                                               Dishwasher

                                                                                                                                                                                        Bolt driver bit

Before beginning installation, allow the butcher block to Measure your countertop area, adding 1” to the base acclimate to your home’s moisture level for a couple of days. cabinet depth to allow for overhang. Using a circular saw, cut Wood contracts and expands with moisture and humidity, so it the piece to size if needed. Butcher block with precut miter may have warped or expanded during transport. Place it level corners and cutouts for kitchens is available, but if you’re TIP: In most cases butcher block countertops are not Make butt joints between countertop sections. Lay the two on the cabinet tops and let it sit until it’s settled. cutting the piece yourself, be sure to apply finish to each new mitered at the corners as some other countertop types are. sections of countertop to be joined upside down on a flat raw edge. Instead, they are butted at the corners. You also may need to worksurface in their correct orientation. Mark drilling points for join two in-line pieces with a butt joint. In both instances, use the connector holes. Drill the holes with a Forstner bit. connector fittings.

 3                                                4                                              5
                                                                                                                                               8                                                                   9

                            Point 3

                  Point 2

     Point 1

Butcher block should be attached Drill pilot holes for screws at drilling Drill corresponding holes in the using wood screws that allow for some points. Stick tape to the bit 1” from the cabinet base that are slotted or at least movement. Mark three points in a line on point to create a depth stop. 3 ⁄ 8” larger than the screws you are using. With the countertop sections roughly in position on the From below, insert the connector bolt so the two heads the underside of the countertop, spacing When driven with a washer under the cabinets and flipped right-side up, apply a bead of silicone are flat in the holes and then tighten the bolt with the driver rows of drilling points at 12-inch intervals. screw head, screws will be able to move adhesive near the top of one mating edge. bit (supplied with bolt hardware) to draw the two sections of slightly with the wood. countertop together. Do not overtighten. (continued)

98 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 99

  10                                                                11                                                                                                                                     14

Clamp a piece of scrap wood to the end of the countertop          Pull the countertop section away from the wall a few                  Option: If you’re installing an undermount sink, mark a          Seal the edges of the sink opening with a varnish as
so the tops are flush. The scrap wood prevents the router         inches, and make a roundover cut along the front edges with a         centerpoint for drilling a hole to accommodate the faucet body   instructed by the butcher block manufacturer or by coating it
bit from rounding over the corner when the edge of the            piloted roundover bit.                                                following the recommendations of the faucet manufacturer.        generously with pure mineral oil or tung oil for a natural finish.
countertop is profiled.                                                                                                                 A 13⁄8"-dia. hole is fairly standard.                            Let sit for 15 minutes then wipe off the excess with a clean,
                                                                                                                                                                                                         lint-free cloth. Let it dry for 48 hours. Repeat six times, letting it
                                                                                                                                                                                                         dry thoroughly between coats.

  12                                                                13
                                                                                                                                          15                                                               16

Attach the countertop to the cabinet mounting strips by           If installing a sink in your countertop, start by outlining the
driving screws up through the cabinet strips and into the         sink in the correct position as recommended in the installation       Add backsplash of your choice and caulk between the new          Install the faucet and sink and make the water supply and
countertop. The screws should be 1⁄4" shorter than the distance   material from the sink manufacturer. Mount a downstroke               countertop and the backsplash area with silicone caulk.          drain hookups (see pages 196 to 199).
from the bottom of the mounting strips to the top of the          blade into the jigsaw (inset), and drill a starter hole just inside
countertop. Use 1" fender washers with the screws and snug        the sink outline. Make the cutout, taking care to stay just
them up, but do not overtighten. Because of the counterbores      inside the cutting line. If you are installing an undermount sink,
and the washers, the countertop will be able to move slightly     smooth the cuts up to the line with a power sander.
as it expands and contracts.

100 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 101

Laminate Countertop                                                                                                       Tips for Working with Laminate ▸

B   uilding your own custom laminate countertop
    using sheets of plastic laminate and
particleboard offers two advantages: the countertop
                                                          based contact cement, which requires a respirator and
                                                          is highly flammable, creates a much stronger, more
                                                          durable bond.
                                                                                                                                                                        A                                     B

you get will be less expensive than a custom-ordered
countertop, and it will allow you more options in terms                                                                                    E                                          R
of colors and edge treatments. A countertop made              Tools & Materials ▸
with laminates also can be tailored to fit any space,
                                                              Tape measure             Router ( with bevel cutting bit)                        C                                                              D
unlike premade countertop material that is a standard
                                                              Framing square           ⁄2" scrap wood
                                                                                       1
width (usually 25").
                                                              Straightedge             ⁄4" plywood
                                                                                       1
     Laminate is commonly sold in 8-ft. or 12-ft.
                                                              Scoring tool             1 × 4 lumber
lengths that are about 1⁄20" thick. In width, they
                                                              Paint roller             ⁄4" particleboard
                                                                                       3
range from 30" strips to 48" sheets. The 30" strips are                                                                     Add 1-inch overhang
                                                              Bar clamps               Sheet laminate
sized specifically for countertops, allowing for a 25"-
                                                              Caulk gun                Contact cement
wide countertop, a 1½" wide front edge strip, and a
                                                              J-roller                 Wood glue
short backsplash.
                                                              Miter saw ( as needed)   ⁄4" drywall screws
                                                                                       1
     The plastic laminate is bonded to the particle-
                                                              Compass                  2" wallboard screws
board or MDF substrate with contact cement, though
                                                              Utility knife            Mineral spirits
most professional installers use products that are
                                                              Aviator snips            Wood filler
available only to the trades. Water-based contact                                                                         Measure along the tops of the base cabinets to determine the size of the countertop. If the wall corners are not square,
                                                              Circular saw             Finishing materials
cement is nonflammable and nontoxic, but solvent-                                                                         use a framing square to establish a reference line (R) near the middle of the base cabinets, perpendicular to the front
                                                              Belt sander              Laminate                           of the cabinets. Take four measurements (A, B, C, D) from the reference line to the cabinet ends. Allow for overhangs by
                                                                                       Silicone caulk                     adding 1" to the length for each exposed end and 1" to the width (E).

                                                                                           Fabricating your own
                                                                                           custom countertop from
                                                                                           particleboard and plastic
                                                                                           laminate is not exactly an                                                       Backsplash substrate
                                                                                           easy DIY project, but it
                                                                                           gives you unlimited
                                                                                           options, and the results
                                                                                           can be very satisfying.

                                                                                                                                                                            Countertop substrate

                                                                                                                                                                            Buildup substrate

                                                                                                                          Lay out cutting lines on the particleboard so you can rip-cut the substrate and buildup strips to size using a framing
                                                                                                                          square to establish a reference line. Cut the core to size using a circular saw with a clamped straightedge as a guide. Cut
                                                                                                                          4" strips of particleboard for the backsplash and for joint support where sections of countertop core are butted together.
                                                                                                                          Cut 3" strips for the edge buildups.

102 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 103

■ How to Build a Laminate Countertop                                                                                                 5
  1                                                                2

Join the countertop substrate pieces on the bottom side.         Attach 3"-wide edge build up strips to the bottom of the          Bend laminate toward the scored line until the sheet              Option: Some laminate installers prefer to cut laminate with
Attach a 4" particleboard joint support across the seam using    countertop, using 11⁄4" wallboard screws. Fill any gaps on the    breaks cleanly. For better control on narrow pieces, clamp a      special snips that resemble aviator snips. Available from
carpenter’s glue and 11⁄4" wallboard screws.                     outside edges with latex wood patch, and then sand the edges      straightedge along the scored line before bending the laminate.   laminate suppliers, the snips are faster than scoring and
                                                                 with a belt sander.                                               Wear gloves to avoid being cut by the sharp edges.                snapping, and they are less likely to cause cracks or tears in
                                                                                                                                                                                                     the material. You’ll still need to square the cut edges with a
                                                                                                                                                                                                     trimmer or router.

  3                                                                4
                                                                                                                                     6                                                                 7

To determine the size of the laminate top, measure the           Cut laminate by scoring and then breaking it. Draw a              Create tight-piloted seams with plastic laminate by using         Apply laminate to the sides of the countertop first. Using a
countertop substrate. Laminate seams should not overlap          cutting line, and then etch along the line with a utility knife   a router and a straight bit to trim the edges that will butt      paint roller, apply two coats of contact cement to the edge of
the substrate. Add 1⁄2" trimming margin to both the length and   or other sharp cutting tool. Use a straightedge as a guide.       together. Measure from the cutting edge of the bit to the edge    the countertop and one coat to the back of the laminate. Let
width of each piece. Measure the laminate needed for face        Making two passes with the scoring tool will help the laminate    of the router baseplate (A). Place the laminate on scrap wood     cement dry according to manufacturer’s directions. Position
and edges of backsplash and for exposed edges of countertop      to break cleanly.                                                 and align edges. To guide the router, clamp a straightedge on     the laminate carefully, and then press against the edge of the
substrate. Add 1⁄2" to each measurement.                                                                                           the laminate at distance A plus 1⁄4", parallel to the laminate    countertop. Bond the laminate to the countertop with a J-roller.
                                                                                                                                   edge. Trim the laminate.

104 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 105

  8                                                                  9                                                                 12                                                                 13

Use a router and a flush-cutting bit to trim the edge strip        Test-fit the laminate top on the countertop substrate. Check
flush with top and bottom surfaces of the countertop               that the laminate overhangs all the edges. At seam locations,
substrate. At edges where the router cannot reach, trim the        draw a reference line on the core where the laminate edges
excess laminate with a file. Apply the laminate to the remaining   will butt together. Remove the laminate. Make sure all the
edges, and trim with the router.                                   surfaces are free of dust, and then apply one coat of contact
                                                                   cement to the back of the laminate and two coats to the
                                                                   substrate. Place spacers made of 1⁄2"-thick scrap wood at 6"
                                                                   intervals across the countertop core. Because contact cement      Remove the excess laminate with a router and a flush-              Finish-trim the edges with a router and a 15° bevel-cutting
                                                                   bonds instantly, spacers allow the laminate to be positioned      cutting bit. At edges where the router cannot reach, trim the      bit. Set the bit depth so that the bevel edge is cut only on the
                                                                   accurately over the core without bonding. Align the laminate      excess laminate with a file. The countertop is now ready for the   top laminate layer. The bit should not cut into the vertical edge
                                                                   with the seam reference line. Beginning at one end, remove        final trimming with a bevel-cutting bit.                           surface.
                                                                   the spacers and press the laminate to the countertop core.

  10                                                                 11                                                                  Tip ▸                                                            14
                                                                                                                                         HI0578-10-13A

Apply contact cement to the remaining substrate and the            Roll the entire surface with a J-roller to bond the laminate to                                                                      Cut 11⁄4"-wide strips of 1⁄4" plywood to form an overhanging
next piece of laminate. Let the cement dry, and then position      the substrate. Clean off any excess contact cement with a soft                                                                       scribing strip for the backsplash. Attach it to the top and sides
the laminate on the spacers and carefully align the butt seam.     cloth and mineral spirits.                                            File all the edges smooth. Use downward file                   of the backsplash substrate with glue and wallboard screws.
Beginning at the seam edge, remove the spacers and press the                                                                             strokes to avoid chipping the laminate.                        Cut laminate pieces and apply to the exposed sides, top, and
laminate to the countertop substrate.                                                                                                                                                                   front of the backsplash. Trim each piece as it is applied.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               (continued)

106 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 107

                                                                                                                                    Repairing & Maintaining Laminate ▸
  15                                                               16
                                                                                                                                    Laminate countertops can be found in more kitchens
                                                                                                                                    than any other type of countertop material. The main
                                                                                                                                    reason is that laminate is versatile and inexpensive.
                                                                                                                                    It’s stain resistant, durable, sanitary, and it’s the only
                                                                                                                                    material that requires no maintenance aside from
                                                                                                                                    regular cleaning (you can’t say that about even the
                                                                                                                                    most expensive marble or stainless steel surfaces). If
                                                                                                                                    you like the look of laminate, its only real drawbacks
                                                                                                                                    are that it’s susceptible to damage.

                                                                                                                                    Topping the list of common laminate damage
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        A vinyl and leather
                                                                                                                                    problems are knife marks, burns, delamination,
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    repair kit (See Resources, p.
                                                                                                                                    and misaligned or curling seams. While damaged                                           282) can be used to make touch up
                                                                                                                                    laminate cannot be easily repaired and scars cannot                                repairs on laminate countertops. To use this
                                                                                                                                    be removed, there are some simple repairs you can                          kit, prepare the repair area with an abrasive pad,
                                                                                                                                    make to spruce up your laminate.                                      blend paints to achieve similar color, apply the paint to
                                                                                                                                                                                                          the repair area, cover with a clear coat, and then heat-
                                                                                                                                                                                                          set with a household iron after the paint dries.
Test-fit the countertop and backsplash. Because your             Apply a bead of silicone caulk to the bottom edge 		               Did someone forget to use a cutting board? You can
walls may be uneven, use a compass to trace the wall outline     of the backsplash.                                                 help hide scratches and light gouges in laminate with
onto the backsplash-scribing strip. Use a belt sander to grind                                                                      a commercial seam filler, available from laminate
backsplash to the scribe line (see page 94).                                                                                        manufacturers. For chips or small holes, you can
                                                                                                                                    purchase a repair kit from home and hardware
                                                                                                                                    stores. Seam filler and repair kits consist of a plastic

  17                                                               18                                                               compound that you mix to match the color of your
                                                                                                                                    surface. Follow the product directions for mixing
                                                                                                                                    and applying the patch. Again, the repair won’t be
                                                                                                                                    invisible, but it’s better than doing nothing.
                                                                                                                                                                                                 Seam-filling compound is purchased pre-tinted to match
                                                                                                                                    Burn marks are next on the list, as many a laminate          common plastic laminate colors. It can be used to repair
                                                                                                                                    countertop has been marred by a hot pan, a fallen            minor chips and scratches or to fill separated seams between
                                                                                                                                                                                                 laminate sheets.
                                                                                                                                    cigarette, or a potholder left too close to a stovetop
                                                                                                                                    burner. If the burn is near a cooking area, you’re in
                                                                                                                                    luck: you can cut out the damage and set a large tile
                                                                                                                                    into the surface to create a built-in trivet.

Position the backsplash on the countertop, and clamp it          Screw 2" wallboard screws through the countertop and
into place with bar clamps. Wipe away the excess caulk, and      into the backsplash core. Make sure the screw heads are
let it dry completely.                                           countersunk completely for a tight fit against the base cabinet.
                                                                 Install the countertops.
                                                                                                                                                                                                 Use a J-roller to re-bond loose or bubbled laminate to its
                                                                                                                                                                                                 substrate. Heat the repair area with an iron first.

108 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 109

Tile Countertop
                                                                                                                                                                             Backsplash

C     eramic and porcelain tile remain popular choices
      for countertops and backsplashes for a number
of reasons: it’s available in a vast range of sizes, styles,
                                                               countertop, you can fasten an additional layer of
                                                               plywood (of any thickness) beneath the substrate. Two
                                                               layers of 3⁄4" exterior-grade plywood without cementboard
                                                                                                                                                           Bullnose
                                                                                                                                                           tiles
                                                                                                                                                                                                       Field tiles
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Grout

and colors; it’s durable and repairable; and some tile—        is also an acceptable substrate. You can purchase tiles
not all—is reasonably priced. With careful planning,           made specifically to serve as backsplashes and front
tile is also easy to install, making a custom countertop       edging. While the color and texture may match, these
                                                                                                                                                                                                                           Thinset
a good do-it-yourself project.                                 tiles usually come in only one length, making it difficult                                                                                                  adhesive layer
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Fiberglass
      The best tile for most countertops is glazed             to get your grout lines to align with the field tiles. You                                                                                                                           wallboard
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 Cementboard        tape
ceramic or porcelain floor tile. Glazed tile is better than    can solve this problem by cutting your own edging and                                                                                    Cementboard
unglazed because of its stain resistance, and floor tile       backsplash tiles from field tiles.                                                                                                       edge strip
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     Plastic
is better than wall tile because it’s thicker and more                                                                                                                                                                               sheeting
                                                                                                                                                  Thinset                                                            Plywood core
durable. While glaze protects tile from stains, the grout                                                                                         fill layer
between tiles is still vulnerable because it’s so porous.
To minimize staining, use a grout that contains a latex            Tools & Materials ▸                                                                                 Plywood
additive or mix the grout using a liquid latex additive.                                                                                                               buildup strip
                                                                   Tape measure       Ceramic tile                                          Cutaway view               (optional)
After the grout cures fully, apply a quality grout sealer,         Circular saw       Tile spacers
and reapply the sealer once a year thereafter. Choosing            Drill               ⁄4" exterior-grade (CDX) plywood
                                                                                      3
                                                                                                                               A ceramic tile countertop made with wall tile starts with a core of 3⁄4" exterior-grade plywood that’s covered with a moisture
larger tiles reduces the number of grout lines. Although           Utility knife      4-mil polyethylene sheeting              barrier of 4-mil polyethylene sheeting. Half-inch cementboard is screwed to the plywood, and the edges are capped with
the selection is a bit limited, if you choose 13" × 13"            Straightedge       Packing tape                             cementboard and finished with fiberglass mesh tape and thinset mortar. Tiles for edging and backsplashes may be bullnose or
floor tile, you can span from the front to the back edge           Stapler            1
                                                                                       ⁄2" cementboard
                                                                                                                               trimmed from the factory edges of field tiles.
of the countertop with a single seam.                              Drywall knife      11⁄4" galvanized deck screws
      The countertop in this project has a substrate of            Framing square     Fiberglass mesh tape
 ⁄4" exterior-grade plywood that’s cut to fit and fasten
                                                                                                                               ■ Options for Backsplashes & Countertop Edges
3
                                                                   Notched trowel     Thinset mortar
to the cabinets. The plywood is covered with a layer of            Tile cutter        Grout
plastic (for a moisture barrier) and a layer of 1⁄2"-thick         Grout float        Silicone caulk
cementboard. Cementboard is an effective backer for                Sponge             Silicone grout sealer
tile because it won’t break down if water gets through             Corner bracket     Cement board screws
the tile layer. The tile is adhered to the cementboard                                                                                                                                                                           Hardwood
                                                                   Moisture barrier   Metal rule                                                                                                                                 edging
with thinset adhesive. The overall thickness of the                Caulk gun
finished countertop is about 11⁄2". If you want a thicker
                                                                                                                                                    Standard              Cove tile
                                                                                                                                                    tile (cut)
                                                                                          Ceramic or porcelain tile makes
                                                                                          a durable countertop that is heat-
                                                                                          resistant and relatively easy for                        Cove tile
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     V-cap
                                                                                          a DIYer to create. By using larger                                                                                                         edge tile
                                                                                          tiles, you minimize the grout
                                                                                          lines (and the cleaning that goes                    Cementboard
                                                                                          with them).
                                                                                                                                              Plywood

                                                                                                                               Backsplashes can be made from cove tile attached to the            Edge options include V-cap edge tile and hardwood strip
                                                                                                                               wall at the back of the countertop. You can use the tile alone     edging. V-cap tiles have raised and rounded corners that create
                                                                                                                               or build a shelf-type backsplash using the same construction       a ridge around the countertop perimeter—good for containing
                                                                                                                               as for the countertop. Attach the plywood backsplash to the        spills and water. V-cap tiles must be cut with a tile saw.
                                                                                                                               plywood core of the countertop. Wrap the front face and all        Hardwood strips should be prefinished with at least three coats
                                                                                                                               edges of the plywood backsplash with cementboard before            of polyurethane finish. Attach the strips to the plywood core so
                                                                                                                               laying tile.                                                       the top of the wood will be flush with the faces of the tiles.

110 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 111

   Tips for Laying Out Tile ▸                                                                                                             ■ How to Build a Tile Countertop
   •   You can lay tile over a laminate countertop that’s                  tiles, fasten a batten that’s the same thickness as the
   square, level, and structurally sound. Use a belt
   sander with 60- or 80-grit sandpaper to rough up the
                                                                           edging tile, plus 1⁄ 8" for mortar thickness, to the face of
                                                                           the countertop so the top is flush with the top of the
                                                                                                                                            1                                                                                                            Overhang here
                                                                                                                                            Overhang here
   surface before setting the tiles. The laminate cannot                   counter. The bullnose tiles are aligned with the outside
   have a no-drip edge. If you’re using a new substrate                    edge of the batten. For wood edge trim, fasten a 1 × 2
   and need to remove your existing countertop, make                       batten to the face of the countertop so the top edge
   sure the base cabinets are level front to back, side to                 is above the top of the counter. The tiles are installed
   side, and with adjoining cabinets. Unscrew a cabinet                    against the batten.
   from the wall and use shims on the floor or against
   the wall to level it, if necessary.                                     •   Before installing any tile, lay out the tiles
                                                                           in a dry run using spacers. If your counter is
   •   Installing battens along the front edge of the                      L-shaped, start at the corner and work outward.
   countertop helps ensure the first row of tile is                        Otherwise, start the layout at a sink to ensure equal-
   perfectly straight. For V-cap tiles, fasten a 1 × 2 batten              sized cuts on both sides of the sink. If necessary,
   along the reference line using screws. The first row                    shift your starting point so you don’t end up cutting
   of field tile is placed against this batten. For bullnose               very narrow tile segments.
                                                                                                                                                                 Overhang
                                                                                                                                                                 here

           13 × 13" tile                        12 × 12" tile               6 × 6" tile       5 × 5" tile    Mosaic tile

                                                                                                                                          Determine the size of the plywood substrate by measuring across the top of the cabinets. The finished top should overhang
                                                                                                                                          the drawer fronts by at least 1⁄4". Be sure to account for the thickness of the cementboard, adhesive, and tile when deciding
                                                                                                                                          how large to make the overhang. Cut the substrate to size from ¾" plywood using a circular saw. Also make any cutouts for
                                                                                                                                          sinks and other fixtures.

                                                                                                                                            2                                                                    3

                                                                                                                                                                                              Corner
                                                                                                                                                                                              bracket

   The bigger the tile the fewer, the grout lines. If you want a standard 25"-deep countertop, the only way to get there
   without cutting tiles is to use mosaic strips or 1" tile. With 13 × 13" tile, you need to trim 1" off the back tile but have only
   one grout line front to back. As you decrease tiles, the number of grout lines increases.
                                                                                                                                          Set the plywood substrate on top of the cabinets, and               Cut pieces of cementboard to size, then mark and
                                                                                                                                          attach it with screws driven through the cabinet corner             make the cutout for the sink. Dry-fit them on the plywood
                                                                                                                                          brackets. The screws should not be long enough to go                core with the rough sides of the panels facing up. Leave a 1⁄8"
                                                                                                                                          through the top of the substrate.                                   gap between the cementboard sheets and a 1⁄4" gap along
                                                                                                                                                                                                              the perimeter.                                    (continued)

112 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 113

                                                                     4                                                                   7                                                                  8

                                                                                                                                       Fill all the gaps and cover all of the tape with a layer of        Determine the required width of the edge tiles. Lay a field
                                                                                                                                       thinset mortar. Feather out the mortar with a drywall knife to     tile onto the tile base so it overhangs the front edge by 1⁄2".
                                                                                                                                       create a smooth, flat surface.                                     Hold a metal rule up to the underside of the tile and
Option: Cut cementboard using a straightedge and utility           Lay the 4-mil plastic moisture barrier over the plywood
                                                                                                                                                                                                          measure the distance from it to the bottom of the subbase.
knife or a cementboard cutter with a carbide tip. Hold the         substrate, draping it over the edges. Tack it in place with a few
                                                                                                                                                                                                          The edge tiles should be cut to this width (the gap for the
straightedge along the cutting line, and score the board several   staples. Overlap seams in the plastic by 6", and seal them with
                                                                                                                                                                                                          grout line causes the edge tile to extend the subbase that
times with the knife. Bend the piece backward to break it along    packing tape.
                                                                                                                                                                                                          conceals it completely).
the scored line. Back-cut to finish.

  5                                                                  6                                                                   9                                                                  10
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Top edge
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               3 1⁄ 2”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                   Backsplash

                                                                                                                                                                                                                   Edge tile                   1 1⁄ 2”

                                                                                                                                                                                                                   Edge tile                   1 1⁄ 2”

                                                                                                                                                                                                                   Edge tile                   1 1⁄ 2”

                                                                                                                                                                                                                   Edge tile                   1 1⁄ 2”

                                                                                                                                                                                                                   Backsplash                  3 1⁄ 2”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         Top edge

Lay the cementboard pieces rough-side up on the plywood            Tape all cementboard joints with fiberglass mesh tape.              Cut your edge tiles to the determined width using a tile saw.      Cut tiles for the backsplash. The backsplash tiles (31⁄2" wide in
and attach them with cementboard screws driven every 6".           Apply three layers of tape along the front edge where the           It’s worth renting a quality wet saw for tile if you don’t own     our project) should be cut with a factory edge on each tile that
Drill pilot holes using a masonry bit, and make sure all screw     horizontal cementboard sheets meet the cementboard edging.          one. Floor tile is thick and difficult to cut with a hand cutter   will be oriented upward when they’re installed. You can make
heads are flush with the surface. Wrap the countertop edges                                                                            (especially porcelain tiles).                                      efficient use of your tiles by cutting edge tiles from the center
with 11⁄4"-wide cementboard strips, and attach them to the                                                                                                                                                area of the tiles you cut to make the backsplash.
core with cementboard screws.                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       (continued)

114 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 115

                                                                                                                                         11                                                                    12

                                          Sink cutout area

                                                                                                                                       Use a 3⁄8" square notched trowel to apply a layer of thin set         Set the first tile into the adhesive. Hold a piece of the edge
                                                                                                                                       adhesive to the cementboard. Apply enough for two or three            against the countertop edge as a guide to show you exactly
                                                                                                                                       tiles, starting at one end. Hold the trowel at roughly a 30° angle    how much the tile should overhang the edge.
                                                                                                                                       and try not to overwork the adhesive or remove too much.
Dry-fit tiles on the countertop to find the layout that works best. Once the layout is established, make marks along the vertical
and horizontal rows. Draw reference lines through the marks and use a framing square to make sure the lines are perpendicular.

                                                                                                                                         13
    Variation: Small Floor Tiles & Bullnose Edging ▸

    Lay out tiles and spacers in a dry run. Adjust the starting       Place the first row of field tile against the edge tile,
                                                                                                                                       Cut all the back tiles for the layout to fit ( you’ll need to         Option: To maintain even grout lines, some beginning
    lines, if necessary. If using battens, lay the field tile flush   separating the tile with spacers. Lay out the remaining
                                                                                                                                       remove about 1" of a 13 × 13" tile) before you begin the actual       tilers insert plus-sign-shaped plastic spacers at the joints. This
    with the battens, then apply the edge tile. Otherwise,            rows of tile. Adjust the starting lines if necessary to create
                                                                                                                                       installation. Set the back tiles into the thin set, maintaining the   is less likely to be useful with large tiles like those shown here,
    install the edging first. If the countertop has an inside         a layout using the smallest number of cut tiles.
                                                                                                                                       gap for grout lines created by the small spacer nubs cast into        but it is effective. Many tiles today feature built-in spacing lugs,
    corner, start there by installing a ready-made inside
                                                                                                                                       the tiles. If your tiles have no spacer nubs, see the option.         so the spacers are of no use. Make sure to remove the spacers
    corner or by cutting a 45° miter in the edge tile to make
                                                                                                                                                                                                             before the thin set sets. If you leave them in place they will
    your own inside corner.
                                                                                                                                                                                                             corrupt your grout lines.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     (continued)

116 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 117

                                                                         14                                                           17                                                                    18

                                                B

                                  A

Variation: To mark border tiles for cutting, allow space for the       To create a support ledge for the edge tiles, prop
backsplash tiles, grout, and mortar by placing a tile against the      pieces of 2 × 4 underneath the front edge of the substrate
                                                                                                                                    Mix a batch of grout to complement the tile ( keeping in              Let the grout dry until a light film is created on the
back wall. Set another tile (A) on top of the last full tile in the    overhang using wood scraps to prop the ledge tightly up
                                                                                                                                    mind that darker grout won’t look dirty as soon as lighter            countertop surface, then wipe the excess grout off with a
field, then place a third tile (B) over tile (A) and hold it against   against the substrate.
                                                                                                                                    grout). Apply the grout to the grout line areas with a grout float.   sponge and warm, clean water. See grout manufacturer's
the upright tile. Mark and cut tile (A) and install it with the cut
                                                                                                                                                                                                          instructions on drying tiles and polishing.
edge toward the wall. Finish filling in your field tiles.

  15                                                                     16                                                           19                                                                    20

Apply a thick layer of thin set to the backside of the edge            Butter each backsplash tile and press it into place, doing   Run a bead of clear silicone caulk along the joint between            Wait at least one week and then seal the grout lines with
tile with your trowel. This is called “buttering” and it is easier     your best to keep all of the grout lines aligned.            the backsplash and the wall. Install your sink and faucet after       a penetrating grout sealer. This is important to do. Sealing
and neater than attempting to trowel adhesive onto the                                                                              the grout has dried ( and before you use the sink, if possible).      the tiles themselves is not a good idea unless you are using
countertop edge. Press the tiles into position so they are flush                                                                                                                                          unglazed tiles ( a poor choice for countertops, however).
with the leading edges of the field tiles.

118 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 119

Granite Countertop                                                                                                             ■ How to Install Granite Tile Countertops
                                                                                                                                 1                                                                    2
S    olid granite countertops are hugely popular in
     kitchen fashion today, and for good reason: they
are beautiful and sturdy and natural. However, they
                                                             the tiles at the center of the installation or the sets
                                                             of tiles at both ends. This creates a more uniform
                                                             look. Granite tile can be installed over laminate
are also expensive and virtually impossible for a do-it-     countertop (not post-form) if you remove the nosing
yourselfer to install. There is a way for an enterprising    and backsplash first. The laminate substrate must be
DIYer to achieve the look and feel of natural granite,       in good condition with no peeling or water damage.
but at a fraction of the price: granite tile countertops.
      You have two basic product options with granite
tile. You can use the standard granite tiles, which              Tools & Materials ▸
consist of field tiles and edge tiles with square edges
that are installed just like normal ceramic or porcelain
                                                                 5
                                                                  ⁄8" exterior grade plywood          Straightedge
tiles and finished with thin edge tiles to create the
                                                                 1
                                                                  ⁄4" tile backer or cementboard      1
                                                                                                       ⁄4" notched trowel
nosing; or you can use granite tiles that are installed          Cementboard screws                   Modified thinset
with front tiles that feature an integral bullnose that          Tiles                                Unsanded grout
better imitates the look of solid granite. Typically,            Tile wet saw with diamond blade      Grout sealer
                                                                                                                               Remove the countertops. From inside the base cabinets,               Prepare and install the subbase. Measure the cabinet
granite tiles fit together more snugly than ceramic              Honing stone                         Stone sealer
                                                                                                                               unscrew the screws holding the countertops to the cabinets.          bank from outside edges to outside edges on all sides and
tiles to give you the option of grouting with grout              Cordless drill                       Sponge                   Unscrew take-up bolts on mitered sections of the countertop.         cut a piece of 5⁄8"-thick exterior grade plywood to fit. The
that’s the same color as the tiles for a near-seamless           Circular saw                         Bucket                   Use a utility knife to cut through the caulk, if present.            edges of the plywood should be flush with the outside edges
finished appearance.                                             Jigsaw                               Rubber gloves            Countertops should lift off easily, but if they don’t, you can use   of the cabinet tops. Screw the plywood to the cabinet braces
                                                                 Compass                              Prybar                   a prybar to carefully pry them away from the base cabinets.          from underneath.
      Layout is the most important step on any tile                                                                            Note: In some cases you can install these tiles over old
project. If tiles need to be cut to fit, it is best to cut       Utility knife                        Carpeted mallet
                                                                                                                               laminate countertops (see previous page).

                                                                                               Granite tiles are installed
                                                                                               in much the same way as
                                                                                               ceramic tiles, but the ultra-     3                                                                    4
                                                                                               narrow gaps and matching
                                                                                               grout mimic the appearance
                                                                                               of solid polished granite.

                                                                                                                               Make the sink cutout. To create cutting lines, place the sink        Install the tile underlayment. Granite tile, like ceramic tile,
                                                                                                                               upside down in the desired location. Trace the edges of the sink     requires a cementboard or denseboard underlayment layer.
                                                                                                                               and remove it. To create support for the drop-in sink flange, use    Cut the material (see page 114) to the same dimension as the
                                                                                                                               a compass to trace new cutting lines inside the traced lines         plywood subbase and lay the cementboard over the plywood
                                                                                                                               (usually 5⁄8"). See the manufacturer’s instructions to confirm       with the edges flush. From inside the sink base, trace around the
                                                                                                                               dimensions (some sinks come with a template for making the           sink cutout with a marker. Remove the underlayment and make
                                                                                                                               cutout. Use a jigsaw to cut out the sink opening.                    the cutout with a jigsaw.

120 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 121

  5                                                                      6                                                                    7                                                                   8

Attach the cementboard underlayment to the subbase.                    Cut ( as needed) and lay out the tiles, beginning with an            Round the inside corner cuts. Even though the flange of             Start laying tiles. Use modified thinset and a 1⁄4" trowel. If you
First, apply a ⁄8"-thick layer of modified thinset to the top of the
              1                                                        inside corner if you have one. Arrange tiles for the best color      the sink shown here will cover the inside corners in the sink       have an inside corner in your countertop, begin there. Apply
plywood using a 1⁄4" notched trowel. Screw the cementboard to          match. Tiles abut directly, with no space for grout. Cut the tiles   cutout, take care to make a gentle rounded corner cut by            thin set at the inside corner, enough to place four or five tiles.
the plywood with cementboard screws. Space the screws 4" to            as necessary to fit. Cut self-edged tiles edge side first. Cut       drilling at the corner with a 1⁄2" masonry bit. Perpendicular       Set the left and right inside corner pieces and the first 12 × 12
5" apart across the entire surface.                                    the tiles with the polished side up. Use a fine honing stone to      corner cuts can lead to cracking. Finish the straight legs of the   field tile.
                                                                       relieve the cut edge to match the manufactured edges.                cutout with a tile saw or a jigsaw with a masonry blade.

■ Variations for Corners & Angles                                                                                                             9                                                                   10

Mitered inside corners are a bit tricky to cut because the             Kitchen islands often have corners that do not form a right
mitered point needs to align with the starting point of the            angle. In such cases, you can avoid a sharp angle on the             Continue setting tiles ( for edge tile and backlash                 Apply grout and seal. After the thin set has dried for at least
bullnose edge. This has the effect of making the corner set            countertop by cutting a triangular bullnose piece to fill in.        installation, see page 118). Apply the thin set mortar to an area   24 hours, grout with an unsanded grout. When the grout has
back roughly an inch.                                                                                                                       big enough for two to four tiles and place the tiles. Use a 2 × 4   dried, seal with natural stone sealer.
                                                                                                                                            covered with carpeting to set the tiles. Push down on tiles to
                                                                                                                                            set, and also across the edges to ensure an even face.

122 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 123

Tile Backsplash                                                                                                        ■ How to Install a Tile Backsplash
                                                                                                                         1                                                                   2
T   here are few spaces in your home with as much
    potential for creativity and visual impact as the
space between your kitchen countertop and your
                                                           Tip ▸
cupboards. A well-designed backsplash can transform
the ordinary into the extraordinary. Tiles for the back-
splash can be attached directly to wallboard or plaster
and do not require backerboard. When purchasing
the tile, order 10 percent extra to cover breakage and
cutting. Remove the switch and receptacle coverplates
and install the box extenders to make up for the extra
thickness of the tile. Protect the countertop from
scratches by covering it with a drop cloth.

    Tools & Materials ▸
    Level                  Story stick                                                                                 Make a story stick by marking a board at least half as long         Starting at the midpoint of the installation area, use the
    Tape measure           Straight 1 × 2                                                                              as the backsplash area to match the tile spacing.                   story stick to make layout marks along the wall. If an end piece
                                                                                                                                                                                           is too small (less than half a tile), adjust the midpoint to give
    Pencil                 Wall tile
                                                           Break tiles into fragments and make a mosaic                                                                                    you larger, more attractive end pieces. Use a level to mark this
    Tile cutter            Tile spacers (if needed)        backsplash. Always use a sanded grout for joints                                                                                point with a vertical reference line.
    Rod saw                Mastic adhesive                 wider than 1⁄8”.
    Notched trowel         Masking tape
    Rubber grout float     Grout
    Beating block          Caulk
    Rubber mallet          Drop cloth                                                                                    3
    Sponge                 Sanded grout
    Bucket

                                                                                       Contemporary glass
                                                                                       mosaic sheets create
                                                                                       a counter-to-cabinet
                                                                                       backsplash for a water-
                                                                                       proof, splash-proof wall
                                                                                       with very high visual impact.

                                                                                                                       While it may appear straight, your countertop may not be            Variation: Diagonal Layout. Mark vertical and horizontal
                                                                                                                       level and therefore is not a reliable reference line. Run a level   reference lines, making sure the angle is 90°. To establish
                                                                                                                       along the counter to find the lowest point on the countertop.       diagonal layout lines, measure out equal distances from the
                                                                                                                       Mark a point two tiles up from the low point and extend a level     crosspoint, and then connect the points with a line. Additional
                                                                                                                       line across the entire work area.                                   layout lines can be extended from these as needed.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 (continued)

124 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 125

  4                                                                    5                                                                   8                                                                  9

Apply mastic adhesive evenly to the area beneath the                 Press tiles into the adhesive with a slight twisting motion. If     When the tiles are in place, make sure they are flat 		            Mix the grout and apply it with a rubber grout float. Spread it
horizontal reference line using a notched trowel. Comb the           the tiles are not self-spacing, use plastic spacers to maintain     and firmly embedded by laying a beating block against the          over the tiles, keeping the float at a low 30° angle, pressing the
adhesive horizontally with the notched edge.                         even grout lines. If the tiles do not hang in place, use masking    tile and rapping it lightly with a mallet. Remove the spacers.     grout deep into the joints. Note: For grout joints 1⁄8” and smaller,
                                                                     tape to hold them in place until the adhesive sets.                 Allow the mastic to dry for at least 24 hours, or as directed by   be sure to use a non-sanded grout.
                                                                                                                                         the manufacturer.

  6                                                                    7                                                                   10                                                                 11

Install a whole row along the reference line, checking               Install an edge border if it is needed in your layout. Mosaic       Wipe off excess grout, holding the float at a right angle to       Clean excess grout with a damp sponge. When the grout
occasionally to make sure the tiles are level. Continue installing   sheets normally do not have bullnose tiles on the edges, so if      the tile, working diagonally so as not to remove grout from        has dried to a haze, buff the tile clean with a soft cloth. Apply a
tiles below the first row, trimming tiles that butt against the      you don’t wish to see the cut edges of the outer tiles, install a   the joints. Clean any remaining grout from the tiles with a        bead of caulk between the countertop and the tiles.
countertop as needed.                                                vertical column of edge tiles at the end of the backsplash area.    damp sponge, working in a circular motion. Rinse the sponge
                                                                                                                                         thoroughly and often.

126 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Countertops ■ 127

Islands C ontemporary kitchen design strives to enhance function while putting a premium on form, and the island is no exception. The kitchen island not only adds countertop space, extra cabinet storage, and sometimes an extra sink or cooktop, but it also acts as extra seating and a place for guests to relax and still converse with you while you’re cooking. In this chapter we discuss the different styles of islands being used by kitchen designers today and then we show you how to make those islands and install the necessary amenities, such as an island vent hood, to help them function at their best.

This chapter shows: • Kitchen Island Selection • Stock-Cabinet Island • Two-Level Tile Island • Concrete Countertop Island • Island Vent Hood

                                                  ■ 129

Kitchen Island Selection

                                                                                                                               Natural stone countertops are heat resistant and highly        Portable islands like this one are readily available at home
                                                                                                                               durable but they can be quite expensive and they are           centers and home furnishing stores. They often match other
                                                                                                                               susceptible to staining. The natural, rustic appearance is     freestanding cabinets and amenities, such as the rolling cart
                                                                                                                               unmatched by any other countertop material.                    shown here (inset).

                                                                                                                               Quartz countertops are similar to solid surface countertops    A tiled countertop is a heat-resistant surface that is
                                                                                                                               in appearance but because they do not contain plastic resins   good for islands because this space is often used to hold
                                                                                                                               or binders, they are much more heat resistant. Manufacturers   hot pans during meal preparation. On the down side, the grout
                                                                                                                               also claim the material is completely impervious to water 		   lines stain easily and can crack over time. Regular maintenance
                                                                                                                               and moisture.                                                  is required.

A traditional hardwood floor with genuine Oriental rugs makes a beautiful design statement in any room. High-quality carpets
resist staining, and a well-applied finish will offer more than adequate protection for hardwood in a kitchen situation.

130 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Islands ■ 131

Stock-Cabinet Island                                                                                                           ■ How to Create a Stock-Cabinet Island
                                                                                                                                 1                                                                 2
K    itchen islands can be created using a whole range
     of methods, from repurposing an old table to
fine, custom woodworking. But perhaps the easiest
                                                                     Tools & Materials ▸
                                                                     Marker                     2 base cabinets (approx. 36"
(and most fail-safe) way to add the conveniences and
                                                                     Drill/driver                wide × 24" deep)
conviviality of a kitchen island is to make one from
                                                                     2 × 4 cleats               Countertop
stock base cabinets. The cabinets and countertops
                                                                     Pneumatic nailer           Wallboard screws
don’t have to match your kitchen cabinetry, but that
                                                                       and 2" finish nails or
is certainly an option you should consider. When
                                                                       hammer and 6d
designing and positioning your new island, be sure
                                                                       finish nails
to maintain a minimum distance of 3 ft. between the
island and other cabinets (4 ft. or more is better).

                                                                                                                               Set two base cabinets back-to-back in position on the 		          Cut 2 × 4 cleats to fit inside the inner outline to provide
                                                                                                                               floor and outline the cabinet corners onto the flooring.          nailing surfaces for the cabinets. Attach the cleats to the floor
                                                                                                                               Remove the cabinets and draw a new outline inside of the          with screws or nails. Tip: Create an L-shaped cleat for each
                                                                                                                               one you just created to allow for the thickness of the cabinet    inside corner.
                                                                                                                               sides (usually 3⁄4").

                                                                                                                                 3                                                                 4

                                                                                                                               Join the two base cabinets together by driving 11⁄4"              Attach the cabinets to the floor cleats using 6d finish nails.
                                                                                                                               wallboard screws through the nailing strips on the backs of       Drill pilot holes for nails, and recess the nail heads with a nail
                                                                                                                               the cabinets from each direction. Make sure the cabinet sides     set. Make a countertop (see pages 86 to 123) and install it on
                                                                                                                               are flush and aligned. Lower the base cabinets over the cleats.   top of the cabinets.
                                                                                                                               Check the cabinets for level, and shim underneath the edges
Two base cabinets arranged back-to-back make a sturdy kitchen island base that’s easy to install. When made with the same
                                                                                                                               of the base if necessary.
style cabinets and countertops as the rest of the kitchen, the island is a perfect match.

132 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Islands ■ 133

Two-level Tile Island                                                                                                               ■ How to Build a Tiled Bi-Level Island
                                                                                                                                      1                                                                    2
I slands are one of the most requested kitchen
  features. People love them for many reasons,
including their value as bi-level counter space. In most
                                                                         Tools & Materials ▸
                                                                      Tape measure              Adhesive
cases, the lower level is used as work space and the
                                                                      Circular saw              Paint
upper as casual dining space. The upper level provides
                                                                      Drill                     Tile spacers
a little camouflage for the work space, something
                                                                      Utility knife             3
                                                                                                 ⁄4" exterior-grade (CDX) plywood
that’s especially welcome in open-plan kitchens where
                                                                      Straightedge              4-mil polyethylene sheeting
meal preparation areas can be seen from other areas.
                                                                      Stapler                   Packing tape
      When planning casual dining space, remember
                                                                      Drywall knife             1
                                                                                                    ⁄2" cementboard
that designers suggest at least 24" per person. For the
                                                                      Framing square            3" deck screws
work space, remember that standard design guidelines
                                                                      Notched trowel            Fiberglass mesh tape
recommend at least 36" of uninterrupted work space
                                                                      Tile cutter               Thinset mortar
to the side of a sink or cooktop.
                                                                      Carpeted 2 × 4 mallet     Grout with latex additive
      On work surfaces, mosaic and other small tile is
                                                                      Grout float               Silicone caulk
rarely the best choice. Larger tile requires fewer grout
                                                                      Sponge                    Grout sealer
lines, always a good idea when it comes to cleaning
                                                                      Foam brush                L-brackets
and maintenance. But there is no rule that all three
                                                                      Caulk gun                 6d finish nails                     Build a 2 × 4 base for the island cabinet by cutting the             Cut the bottom panels the same dimensions as the base
elements of a bi-level island have to use the same                                                                                  2 × 4s to length and joining them in a square frame that lays        frame from 3⁄4" birch plywood. Attach it to the frame with finish
                                                                      1 × 2 hardwood            Drywall screws
material. In fact, projects like this offer wonderful                                                                               flat (wide sides down) on the floor. Use metal L-brackets to         nails. Then, cut the side panels to size and shape and fasten
                                                                      2 × 4 lumber              Glue
opportunities to mix materials or colors or textures.                                                                               reinforce the joints. If you don’t wish to move the island, fasten   them to the edges with 6d finish nails and adhesive. Slip 3⁄4"
                                                                      Ceramic tile
Choose floor tile or tile made especially for counters                                                                              the frame to the floor in position with construction adhesive        shims (scrap plywood works well) beneath the side panels
and then branch out when it comes to the backsplash.                                                                                and/or deck screws.                                                  before fastening them.
Wall tile and mosaics work beautifully.

                                                                                                                                      3                                                                    4

                                                                                                                                    Cut the 2 × 4 cross supports to length and install them              Prime and paint the cabinet interior and exterior.
                                                                                                                                    between the side panels at every corner, including the
                                                                                                                                    corners created by the L-shape cutout. Use 3" deck screws
                                                                                                                                    driven through the side panels and into the ends of the
                                                                                                                                    cross supports.
This island adds storage, countertop space, and seating to a kitchen, revealing the truly astonishing transformation this simple
yet functional piece can achieve.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               (continued)

134 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Islands ■ 135

  5                                                                   6                                                                9                                                              10

Build a face frame from 1 × 2 hardwood to fit the cabinet           Cut strips of 3⁄4" exterior plywood to make the subbases for     Cut mosaic sheets to fit the backsplash area and attach        Cut the edge tiles and fasten them around the perimeter of
front. Attach it to the cabinet with 6d finish nails and hang the   the countertops and a backer for the backsplash. The lower       them with thinset adhesive (see Tile Backsplash, page 124).    the subbase with thinset adhesive. The tiles should be flush
cabinet doors (we installed three 13"-wide overlay doors).          counter subbase should overhang by 2" on the front and sides.                                                                   or slightly below the bottoms of the buildup strips and project
                                                                    The upper should overhang 2" on the sides and be centered on                                                                    past the top surfaces so they will be level with the field tiles. If
                                                                    the cabinet front to back. Attach the backer and subbases with                                                                  you are not using edge tiles with a bullnose top, install the tiles
                                                                    drywall screws driven down into the 2 × 4 cross supports.                                                                       so they are level with the subbase surface and overhang them
                                                                                                                                                                                                    with the field tiles.

  7                                                                   8                                                                11                                                             12

Cut 2" wide strips of plywood for buildup strips and attach         Attach the tile backerboard to the counter subbases,             Install the field tiles for the countertops last (see How to   Choose a suitable grout color and apply it to the tile with
to the undersides of the subbases with glue and screws.             the backsplash, and tape seams; cover screw heads with           Build a Tile Countertop, pages 113 to 119).                    a grout float. Buff off excess once it has dried. Seal the grout
                                                                    compound (see page 114).                                                                                                        with grout sealer.

136 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Islands ■ 137

Concrete Countertop Island
                                                                                                                          consult a building professional, your local building       concrete outlets also offer a virtual rainbow of dry-
                                                                                                                          inspector’s office or a structural engineer.               mix color pigments that are formulated with a water
                                                                                                                               The weight of the concrete is also a factor when      reducer admixture. Water reducers limit the amounts
                                                                                                                          it comes to cabinetry. Typical base cabinets should be     of water the concrete mix uses to help produce a

O     nce used exclusively for outdoor building proj-
      ects, concrete has expanded its range to become
a premier material for indoor construction as well.
                                                         (roughly 25 pounds per square foot for a 2" thick
                                                         countertop). Most floors should be able to support a
                                                         heavy countertop, but be sure to inspect floor joists
                                                                                                                          reinforced at the back and across the top with 1⁄2" or
                                                                                                                          ¾" plywood. Reinforcing cabinetry may increase the
                                                                                                                          overall dimensions, which can cause problems with
                                                                                                                                                                                     stronger mix and a smoother finished produce.
                                                                                                                                                                                          As you mix the concrete materials, blend all dry
                                                                                                                                                                                     ingredients thoroughly in a motorized mixer for five
Still utilized mostly to cast countertops and vanity     and framing, especially in older homes, to determine             modular units or in areas with limited space.              minutes prior to adding liquid ingredients. Do not mix
tops, concrete is continually finding new applications   if any reinforcement is needed. If you are unsure,                    After you design your project and determine the       the concrete until the form is completely built, with
inside the home, including fireplace hearths, floors,                                                                     actual dimensions, you’ll need to estimate the amount      any sink or faucet knockouts and the reinforcement
and even furnishings. Along with remarkable strength                                                                      of concrete you’ll need. Concrete is measured by           in place. For best results, mix the concrete in a
and extreme durability, concrete has charm and appeal                                                                     volume in cubic feet; multiply the length by the wide      single batch with a power mixer. Because the mixing
unlike any other building material.                          Tools & Materials ▸                                          and then by the thickness of the finished countertop       container on power mixtures should never be more
     A concrete countertop may be cast in place                                                                           for volume in cubic inches, then divide the sum by         than half full (one-third full on some models), you’ll
or formed offsite and installed like a natural stone         Tape measure             Variable speed angle grinder        1728 for cubic feet. For example, a countertop that        need a relatively large mixer for all but the smallest
countertop. For a number of reasons, casting offsite         Table or circular saw        with grinding pads              will be 48-in.-long × 24-in.-wide × 31⁄2-in.-thick will    countertops. For the island countertop projects shown
makes more sense for most of us. In addition to              Jigsaw                   No. 3 rebar                         require 21⁄3-cu.-ft. of mixed concrete (48 × 24 × 3.5 /    here, a tow-behind nine cubic foot mixer was rented
keeping the mess and dust out of your living spaces,         Drill and right angle    31⁄2" deck screws                   1728 = 21⁄3). The best way to achieve consistent results   (yet another good reason for casting your countertop
working in a garage or even outdoors lets you cast the        drill guide             Poultry netting                     when mixing concrete is to use premixed materials.         offsite). Once your casting is done, let the concrete
countertops with the finished surface face-down in           Level                        (or welded wire)                One 60-lb. bag of premixed high-strength concrete          cure for at least a week before you strip off the forms.
the form. This way, if you do a careful job building         Carpenter’s square       Concrete sealer                     equals 1⁄2-cu.-ft. of mixed concrete. A number of online
the form, you can keep the grinding and polishing to a       Rebar bender             Concrete mix
bare minimum. In some cases, you may even be able            Reciprocating saw with   Coloring agent
                                                                                                                                                                                                         The basic supplies needed to build
to simply remove the countertop from the form, flip it        metal cutting blade     Paste wax
                                                                                                                                                                                                         your countertop form and cast the
over, and install it essentially as is.                      Clamps                   Fiber reinforcement (nylon)
                                                                                                                                                                                                         countertop include: (A) Melamine-
     Thorough planning and careful form construction         Belt sander              Acrylic fortifier                                                                                                  coated particleboard for constructing
                                                                                                                                                            C
are the keys to a successful concrete countertop             Pad sander               Latex bonding agent                                                                                                the form; (B) poultry netting or welded
project. One of the first issues to tackle is weight:        Concrete mixer           Silicone caulk                                                                                                     wire for reinforcement; (C) concrete
concrete weighs about 140 pounds per cubic foot              5-gal. buckets           ⁄4" melamine
                                                                                      3                                                                                                                  sealer (product shown is adequate,
                                                                                                                                                                                                         but for better protection look for a
                                                                                                                                                   B                                                     sealer that has both penetrating and
                                                                                                                                                                                                         film-forming properties); (D) high/
                                                                                                                                                                                                         early bagged concrete mix rated for
                                                                                          Concrete countertops                     A                            E                                        5,000 p.s.i.; (E) coloring agent (liquid or
                                                                                          have many pluses and                                                                                           powder); (F) grinding pads (shown are
                                                                                                                                                    D
                                                                                          few minuses. They are                                                                             G            5" diamond pads ranging from 50 grit
                                                                                          durable, heat resistant,                                                                                       to 1,500 grit for grinding and polishing);
                                                                                                                                                                F
                                                                                          and relatively inexpensive.                                                                                    (G) paste wax; (H) buffing bonnet for
                                                                                          But most of all, they are                                                                                      polisher; (I) fiber reinforcement (nylon);
                                                                                                                                                                          I            H                 (J) acrylic fortifier, latex bonding agent
                                                                                          highly attractive and a great
                                                                                          fit with contemporary styles.                                                                                  (or water reducing admixture if you can
                                                                                                                                                                                                         locate it); (K) black or colored silicone
                                                                                                                                                        K                                                caulk; (L) faucet set if installing sink;
                                                                                                                                                                     J
                                                                                                                                                                                                         (M) sink (self rimming shown); (N) No. 3
                                                                                                                                                                                                    N    rebar (3⁄8”).

                                                                                                                                                                L
                                                                                                                                                                                      M

138 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Islands ■ 139

■ How to Cast a Concrete Countertop                                                                                                     5                                                                 6
  1                                                                2

                                                                                                                                      Use the rounded knockout blank as a template for                  Install the sink knockout. Because gluing the faces
                                                                                                                                      marking and cutting the other two blanks to match. Clamp the      together can add height to the knockout (and cause the
                                                                                                                                      three blanks together and sand the edges smooth and even.         concrete finishing tools to bang into it when they ride on the
Cut 3⁄4" melamine-coated particleboard into 21⁄4"-wide           Mount a power drill in a right-angle drill guide (or use a           A belt sander on a stationary sanding station or an oscillating   form tops), attach each blank directly to the layer below it
strips to make the form sides. Cut the sides to length (331⁄2    drill press) and drill 1⁄4"-dia. pilot holes for 3" deck screws at   spindle sander works great for this. If you are strong and        using countersunk screws. Keep the edges aligned perfectly,
and 411⁄2", as shown here) and drill two countersunk pilot       6" intervals all the way through the tops of the form sides.         steady-handed, you can freehand the corners with a portable       especially if you’re planning to install an undermount sink.
holes 3⁄8" in from the ends of the front and back form sides.    Countersink the holes so the screw heads are recessed slightly       belt sander. Don’t over-sand—this will cause the sink knockout
Assemble the strips into a frame by driving a 2" coarse          from the surface.                                                    to be too small.
wallboard screws at each pilot hole and into the mating
ends of the end form strips.

  3                                                                4
                                                                                                                                          Faucet Knockouts ▸                                              7

                                                                                                                                                Faucet knockout              Faucet knockout
                                                                                                                                                (purchased)                  (homemade)

                                                                                                                                          Option: If your sink faucet will not be mounted
                                                                                                                                          on the sink deck, you’ll need to add knockouts for the
                                                                                                                                          faucet hole or holes, according to the requirements
                                                                                                                                          of the faucet manufacturer. You can order knockouts
                                                                                                                                                                                                        Seal any exposed edges with fast-drying polyurethane
                                                                                                                                          from a concrete countertop supplies distributor or            varnish, and then caulk the form once the varnish is dry.
Center the form frame on the base, which should have the         Make the sink knockout (if you’re installing a sink). The sink           create them with PVC plumbing pipe that has an                Run a very thin bead of colored silicone caulk (the coloring
melamine side facing up. Test the corners with a carpenter’s     we used requires a 143⁄8" square cutout with corners that are            outside diameter equal to the required faucet hole            allows you to see where the caulk has been laid on the white
square to make sure they’re square. Drive one 31⁄2" deck screw   rounded at a 1⁄2" radius. Cut three pieces of 3⁄4”-thick MDF to          size. To anchor the PVC knockout, cover one end with          melamine) in all the seams and then smooth carefully with a
per form side, near the middle. The screw heads should be        143⁄8" square using a table saw if possible. With a compass,                                                                           fingertip. In addition to keeping the wet concrete from seeping
                                                                                                                                          a cap made for that size tubing. Drill a guide hole
slightly below the top edges of the forms. Check for square      mark 1½"-radius curves at each corner for trimming. Make                                                                               into gaps in the form, the caulk will create a slight roundover
again, and continue driving the 31⁄2" screws at 6" intervals     the trim cuts with a jigsaw (only if you stack and cut all three         through the center of the cap so you can secure it            on the edges of the concrete. The smoother the caulk, the
through the pilot holes. Check for square frequently––the        at once). Cut just outside the trim line and sand up to it with a        with a screw. Position the knockout next to a form            less grinding you’ll have to do later. If you will be installing an
stress easily can pull the frame out of joint.                   sander for a smooth curve.                                               side and compare heights. If the knockout is taller,          undermount sink, also caulk around the sink knockout.
                                                                                                                                          trim the uncapped tubing.

140 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Islands ■ 141

  8                                                                    9                                                                  11                                                                  12

          Temporary
          spacer

Add reinforcement to the form. For thicker castings, bend            Hang the rebar loop with wires to suspend it, keeping it at        Blend the wet ingredients (water plus any liquid concrete           Fill the countertop form, making sure to pack the concrete
#3 (3⁄8") rebar to fit around the perimeter of the form using a      least 1⁄2" away from the concrete surface. Drive a few screws      colorant and a water reducer or acrylic fortifier) in a bucket      into the corners and press it through the reinforcement.
rebar bender. The rebar needs to be at least 1" away from all        into the outside faces of the form sides near the top and use      and, with the mixer running, add them slowly to the dry             Overfill the form slightly.
edges (including knockouts) and 1" away from the top surface.        wire ties to hang the rebar. Once all of the ties are in place,    ingredients. Add more water as necessary until the concrete is
Metal reinforcement can telegraph through concrete if it is too      remove the temporary spacers. For extra insurance, add             thoroughly hydrated, but still stiff.
close to the visible surfaces. Tie the ends of the rebar with wire   another reinforcing material, such as wire poultry netting, over
and set it in the form on temporary 1" spacers.                      the rebar and tie the two together.

     Tip ▸                                                             10                                                                 13                                                                  14

     To keep the form from moving during the
     all-important pouring, finishing, and curing stages,
     attach or clamp the scrap plywood work top to the
     actual top. Check for level and insert shims between                                                                               Vibrate the form vigorously as you work to settle the               Strike off the excess concrete from the form using a
     the work top and the bench top if needed. When                                                                                     concrete into all the voids. You can rent a concrete vibrator for   2 × 4 drawn along the top of the form in a sawing motion. If
                                                                     Add all of the dry ingredients into a concrete mixer
     possible, drive screws up through the bench top                                                                                    this purpose, or simply strike the form repeatedly with a rubber    voids are created, pack them with fresh concrete and restrike.
                                                                     that’s large enough to do the whole pour. The dry ingredients
     and into the work top to hold it steady. Otherwise,                                                                                mallet. If you have a helper and a sturdy floor and worktable,      Do not overwork the concrete.
                                                                     include high/early concrete mix rated to 5,000 p.s.i. and
     use clamps and check them regularly to make sure                                                                                   lift up and down on the ends of the table, bouncing it on the
                                                                     synthetic fiber reinforcement. If you are using dry pigment,
     they’re tight. If you’re concerned about mess, put a                                                                               floor to cause vibrations (this is a very effective method if you
                                                                     also add this now. Run the mixer for several minutes to
     sheet of 3-mil plastic on the floor.                                                                                               can manage it safely). Make sure the table remains level when
                                                                     thoroughly blend the dry ingredients.
                                                                                                                                        you’re through.                                                                                                         (continued)

142 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Islands ■ 143

  15                                               16                                                                                                                                                                                    19

                                                                                                                                                                    Trough made from heavy
                                                                                                                                                                    plastic over a 2 × 4 curb

Once you are certain you won’t need             Smooth the surface of the concrete with a metal screeding tool, such as a length         Option: To expose the aggregate and create a very polished surface that 		                    Clean and seal the concrete with
to vibrate the form any further, snip the       of angle iron or square metal tubing. Work slowly with a sawing motion, allowing the     resembles natural stone, grind the surface. Use a series of increasingly fine diamond-        several coats of quality silicone-based
wire ties holding the rebar loop and            bleed water to fill in behind the screed. Since this surface will be the underside of    wheel grinding pads (50-grit, then 100, 200, and 400) mounted on a shock-protected            concrete sealer (one with penetrating
embed the cut ends attached to the rebar        the countertop, no further tooling is required. Cover with sheet plastic and allow the   5" angle grinder (variable speed). This is messy work and can go on for hours to get the      and film-forming agents). For extra
below the concrete surface.                     concrete to dry and cure undisturbed for a full week.                                    desired result. Rinse the surface regularly with clean water and make sure it stays wet       protection and a renewable finish,
                                                                                                                                         during grinding. For a gleaming surface, mount still finer pads (up to 1,500 grit) on the     apply a coat of paste wax after the
                                                                                                                                         grinder and wet-polish.                                                                       last coat of sealer dries.

  17                                                                    18
                                                                                                                                           20                                                      21

Remove the plastic covering and then unscrew and                     With a helper or two (or three), flip the countertop so the
remove the forms. Do not pry against the fresh concrete. In          finished surface is exposed. Be extremely careful. The best
most cases, you’ll need to cut apart the sink knockout to            technique is to roll the countertop onto an edge, position a
prevent damaging the countertop when removing it. Drill              couple of 2 × 4 sleepers beneath it (insulation board works
                                                                                                                                         Undermount or self-rimming, it is easier to             Make sure the island cabinet is adequately reinforced and that as much
a starter hole and then carefully cut up to the edge of the          very well), and then gently lower it onto the sleepers.
                                                                                                                                         install the sink before the countertop is mounted       plumbing as possible has been installed, then apply a thick bead of panel
knockout. Cut the knockout into chunks until you can remove
                                                                                                                                         on the cabinet. Attach the sink according to the        adhesive or silicone adhesive to the tops of the cabinets and stretchers.
it all (inset). The edges of the concrete will be fragile, so be
                                                                                                                                         manufacturer’s directions. Self-rimming sinks likely    With at least one helper, lower the countertop onto the base and position it
very careful.
                                                                                                                                         will require some modifications to the mounting         where you wish. Let the adhesive dry overnight before completing the
                                                                                                                                         hardware (or at least you’ll need to buy some           sink hookup.
                                                                                                                                         extra-long screws) to accommodate the thickness
                                                                                                                                         of the countertop.

144 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Islands ■ 145

Island Vent Hood                                                                                                                          ■ How to Install an Island Vent Hood
                                                                                                                                            1                                                                   2
A    n island vent hood installation is a bit complicated
     because the unit must be supported from above,
and because of the extra ductwork. Before installation,
                                                                       a maximum permissible length for duct runs. The
                                                                       installation instructions will contain a chart giving
                                                                       equivalent lengths for each type of duct fitting. For
read the manufacturer’s instructions carefully for rec-                example, a 90° elbow is the equivalent of 15 feet of
ommended heights for cooktop and hood installation.                    round straight duct. A round roof cap is the equivalent
     Most island vents weigh over 100 pounds, so you                   of 26 feet of round straight duct.
will need assistance during parts of the installation.
Install the vent hood prior to installing the cooktop,
if possible, to prevent damage to the cooktop. If not
possible, protect the cooktop and countertop with a                           Tools & Materials ▸
heavy moving pad. This installation is vented directly
through the roof through attic space above the                                Measuring tape              Roof vent
kitchen. You can also install the ductwork between                            Plumb bob                   2 × 4 lumber
ceiling joists and out to a side wall, or you can build                       Ladder                      3" #10 wood screws
a soffit around the ductwork. All vent hoods have                             Wallboard saw               Sheetmetal screws
                                                                              Drill                       NM cable                        Check manufacturer’s directions for the distance from               Cut two lengths of 2 × 4 to fit between the joists. Check the
                                                                              Reciprocating saw           Wire connectors                 the front of the vent to the duct centerline and the necessary      manufacturer’s instructions for the correct distance between
                                                                              Screwdriver                 Tape                            vent hood alignment over the cooktop. Use a plumb bob to            the braces. Place the braces flush against the ceiling top. Drill
     Shopping Tips ▸                                                          Wire stripper               Metallic duct tape              find the position of the duct centerline over the cooktop. Mark     pilot holes and install with a minimum of two 3" #10 wood
                                                                              6" round duct               Duct straps                     the location of the duct centerline on the ceiling by poking a      screws driven through the joist and into the brace. The cross
     Professional-style cooktops
                                                                                                                                          12" length of hanger wire through the ceiling. In the attic, pull   bracing and the ceiling surface must be level for proper
     require heavy-duty vent hoods.                                                                                                       back the insulation surrounding the wire and the adjoining          installation of the vent hood. Insert the 6" round duct through
     Check your cooktop manual for                                                                                                        joists. Center a section of 6" duct over the wire hole and trace    the ceiling so it extends down 3 or 4 inches. This must be a
     venting requirements.                                                                                                                around it to mark the cutout for the duct. Using a wallboard        female or external connection. Attach lengths of duct until you
                                                                                                                                          saw or a rotary saw, cut out the hole.                              reach the roof deck.

                                                                                                                                            3                                                                   4
                                                                                                                            Flooring



                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Vent
                                                                         2×                                                                                                                                                                       cover
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  flange

                                                                                                                               Ceiling

Variation: If you must install ductwork in the ceiling joists, turn one 2 × 4 brace flat to allow the duct to fit between the 2 × 4 and   Draw an outline of the duct on the roof deck. Drill a pilot         Remove a section of shingles from around the cutout,
the flooring above.                                                                                                                       hole, then saw through the sheathing and roofing material with      leaving the roofing paper intact. Remove enough shingles to
                                                                                                                                          a reciprocating saw to make the cutout for the vent tailpiece.      create an exposed area that is at least the size of the vent
                                                                                                                                                                                                              cover flange.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    (continued)

146 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Islands ■ 147

  5                                               6                                              7                                       10                                                                 11

                                                                                                                                       Measure from the bottom of the duct flange in the ceiling          Slide the top decorative duct cover over the support frame
If the hole for the vent does                   Apply roofing cement to the                    Complete installation of the            to the bottom of the support frame. Add 1" for insertion into      to the ceiling and attach it to the support frame using the
not abut a rafter, attach a 2 × 4 brace         bottom of the vent cover flange,               ductwork by securing each joint with    the ceiling duct and subtract 1¾" for the hood insertion. (This    supplied decorative screws. Slide the bottom decorative duct
between the roof rafters. Attach a              then slide the vent cover over the             self-tapping sheetmetal screws. Wrap    will vary; check the manufacturer’s dimensions.) Cut 6" round      cover over the support frame and the top duct cover. Secure
hose clamp to the brace or rafter               tailpiece. Nail the vent cover flange          each joint with metallic duct tape.     duct to this length. Install the duct and attach with sheetmetal   with the provided stop screw to hold it in place while the hood
about 1" below the roof sheathing               into place with self-sealing roofing           Support the duct as it passes through   screws and metallic duct tape.                                     is installed.
(top). Insert the vent tailpiece into           nails, then patch in shingles around           the ceiling with duct straps.
the cutout and through the hose                 the cover.
clamp, then tighten the clamp
screw (bottom).

  8                                                                     9                                                                12                                                                 13

Secure the upper support frame to the ceiling                         In the attic, run a branch circuit from a nearby junction        With a helper, lift the hood up to the support frame. Align the    Strip 8" of cable. Thread the cable through a cable clamp
joists or the cross bracing with the screws provided. The             box. (This may be a job for an electrician.) Route the cable     hood mounting studs with the support frame holes and guide         and through a knockout into the junction box. Connect the
screws must be driven into the center of the joists or cross          through the ceiling hole. Pull the cable to reach the junction   the hood duct connector into the house duct. Install the nuts      white supply wire to the white vent wire with a wire connector.
braces. Check to make sure the frame is level in all directions.      box, approximately 6" below the frame support. Tape the cable    and lock washers to the mounting studs and tighten. Check          Connect the black supply wire to the black vent wire. Connect
Insert the lower support frame and secure loosely. Adjust             to the frame support.                                            that the hood is level in all directions. Make sure the duct is    the green or bare supply wire to the green or yellow vent wire.
the lower support frame to the desired height above the                                                                                positioned over the hood connector. Seal the joint with metallic   Push the wires into the junction box and replace the cover
countertop and tighten the screws. Make sure the support                                                                               duct tape, not screws.                                             without pinching the wires. Remove the stop screw and slide
frame is level and plumb.                                                                                                                                                                                 down the decorative cover.

148 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Islands ■ 149

                             Fixtures &
                             Appliances
                             A    ppliances for kitchens include refrigerators,
                                  ranges, and dishwashers; fixtures include sinks,
                             faucets, garbage disposers, and icemakers. In many
                             ways, these items define our kitchens. Essentially,
                             they do most of the work––along with the cook, of
                             course. The conventional thinking on purchasing
                             appliances and fixtures is that you should buy the
                             best quality you can afford. Although some appliance
                             sellers may offer free installation, you can often save
                             a significant amount of money (and thereby upgrade
                             your purchase) by doing the installation yourself.

PU DIY Guide to Appliances 4-5 In general, installing appliances and fixtures in your kitchen is a manageable job. An exception may be made however, when it comes to hooking up a gas range. Only professionals and very experienced do-it- yourselfers should attempt to make gas connections.

                             In This Chapter
                             • Appliance & Fixture Selection
                             • Ranges, Ovens & Cooktops
                             • Refrigerator Icemaker
                             • Dishwasher
                             • Food Disposer
                             • Range Hood/Vent Fan
                             • Drop-in Sink
                             • Undermount Sink
                             • Apron Sink
                             • Kitchen Faucets
                             • Kitchen Drains & Traps
                             • Hot Water Dispenser
                             • Pot Filler
                             • Carbon Water Filter
                             • Reverse-Osmosis Filtration System
                                                                                       ■ 151

Appliance & Fixture Selection
                                                                                                                                  Electric ovens are conventional, convection, or multi-         side-by-side is the diminished width of the refrigerator
                                                                                                                             mode. A conventional oven is the standard oven with a               side. A platter of hors d’oeuvres, a cookie sheet or
                                                                                                                             heating element at the bottom for baking and an element             a large roasting pan often won’t fit in this narrow
                                                                                                                             at the top for broiling. A true convection oven has no ele-         compartment.

S   electing the right appliances and fixtures for your
    kitchen update or remodeling project requires a
balancing act, with cost, energy efficiency, performance,
                                                               any enclosed cabinet with countertop. Ovens can
                                                               be placed in islands, under counters, and at varying
                                                               heights on walls.
                                                                                                                             ments in the oven cavity. Instead, the baking element and
                                                                                                                             a fan are located outside the cavity. The fan circulates the
                                                                                                                             heated air to produce an absolutely balanced heat—you
                                                                                                                                                                                                      New freezer and refrigerator options include
                                                                                                                                                                                                 commercial-grade refrigerators, individual drawers that
                                                                                                                                                                                                 look like cabinet drawers and can be located any-
and style thrown into the mix. It’s fun to look through             The gas cooktop has the reputation of being dif-         can bake as many trays of cookies as you have oven racks.           where, dual-temperature wine coolers, and freestand-
magazines and covet the cutting-edge kitchens featured,        ficult to clean, although sealed burners make this less       A more expensive option is the multimode oven, which                ing vertical freezer and refrigerator components that
but be prepared for sticker shock when you are ready to        of an issue. All gas cooktops have grates to hold the         uses conventional, convection, and microwave cooking.               can be installed separately.
make your selections. Focus on the features you really         pots above the flames; make sure you can move these
need and want, and look for appliances and fixtures that
offer those options. For instance, a stainless steel kitchen
                                                               easily for cleaning. With electronic ignition, gas cook-
                                                               tops and ovens do not have pilot lights, so the risks of      ■ Refrigerators                                                     ■ Dishwashers
may be appealing—but if your main goal is easy cleanup,        extinguished pilot lights are no longer an issue.             Buying a new refrigerator can be expensive, but                     Dishwashers, like refrigerators, have become more
you will be disappointed to discover that most stainless            Gas ovens are often not as well insulated as self-       running an older, inefficient refrigerator can account              efficient and quieter. A dishwasher that doesn’t require
steel finishes prominently display fingerprints and water      cleaning electric ovens, so they may heat your kitchen        for as much as 20 percent of your household                         hand rinsing before loading will also save water—
marks. As you read this section, consider which options        space more. If you broil often, make sure the broiler         electrical costs. New energy and pollution standards                enough so that using a dishwasher actually conserves
you cannot live without, as well as those you just don’t       is located in the main oven compartment and not in a          created over the past twenty years have encouraged                  water. The key issues to consider when buying a
need. This will help you narrow your choices when you          separate, lower compartment. This eliminates bending          manufacturers to make refrigerators much more                       dishwasher are the operating costs, noise reduction,
begin looking at the costs of various options.                 and allows for greater broiling capacity.                     efficient. Refrigerators come in a number of styles and             cleaning power, and features. Operating costs can be
                                                                    Electric cooktops come in a variety of burner con-       configurations. Slide-in refrigerators are the traditional          determined by looking at the yellow Energy Guide

■ Ranges, Cooktops & Ovens                                     figurations. The traditional is the electric coil with drip
                                                               plate. Solid disks are made of cast iron sealed to the
                                                               cooktop. Halogen burners are underneath a glass cook-
                                                                                                                             style, usually 28" to 34" deep, though some may be 24"
                                                                                                                             deep. Built-in refrigerators are wider than slide-ins,
                                                                                                                             but only 24" deep so they are flush with base cabinets.
                                                                                                                                                                                                 tag. Noise reduction measures are often directly
                                                                                                                                                                                                 related to price. Look for sound-absorbent insulation
                                                                                                                                                                                                 around the tub (stainless steel tubs are regarded as the
A range, or stove, combines an oven and a cooktop
in one unit. Ranges often cost less than two separate          top and are heated by vacuum-sealed halogen lamps.            Built-ins need space above for venting. Refrigerator                best), behind the door, over the top, and behind the
units, and they consume less space. Choosing separate          Induction burners are also under a glass cooktop and          and freezer configurations include top freezer, bottom              access panel and toe kick. Because you won’t usually
units, however, gives you flexibility in placement and         have an electromagnetic coil that conducts electrical         freezer, and side-by-side. The top freezer is more                  be able to hear a dishwasher run through its cycles
may allow you access to features not available in a            energy directly to the pot, requiring ferrous cookware        efficient and easier to access, but the bottom freezer              in a showroom, refer to consumer ratings magazines
range. Plus, you can choose appliances with different          (stainless steel, aluminum, and ceramic cookware will         puts more of the refrigerator at a usable height.                   for sound-level comparisons. Avoid inexpensive
fuel sources: many cooks prefer gas cooktops and               not work). The flat ceramic tops are smooth, but may          Side-by-side configurations are popular because both                dishwashers that do not have internal heating elements
electric ovens. Cooktops can be placed in practically          require special cleaners.                                     are easily accessed, and in-door ice servers are only               and rely on ambient heat in the water for cleaning.
                                                                                                                             available in this style. The major drawback of the
                                                                                  A gas range is the preferred choice for
                                                                                  most serious cooks because the heat is
                                                                                  very controllable and achieves cooking
                                                                                  temperatures immediately.

                                                                                                                             A high-end stainless steel refrigerator/freezer can be an           Washing dishes in an efficient dishwashing appliance
                                                                                                                             impressive centerpiece in a fancy kitchen, but a more modest, en-   consumes considerably less water and energy than washing
                                                                                                                             ergy-efficient model is a better investment for most homeowners.    and rinsing by hand.

152 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 153

■ Vent Fans                                                                                                                 ■ Kitchen Sinks
                                                                 Vent fans and range hoods protect your kitchen             Kitchen sinks are available in numerous stock
                                                                 surfaces and your health by exhausting the heat,           configurations, sizes, and materials. The first choice
                                                                 steam, grease, and odors produced by cooking. Local        to consider is the material. Stainless steel, cast iron,
                                                                 codes may apply to venting systems, so check with a        enameled steel, solid surface, fireclay, acrylic, and
                                                                 building inspector or HVAC contractor. To truly be         resin are all widely available sink materials, each with
                                                                 effective, vent fans must vent to the outdoors, rather     its own advantages and disadvantages. Custom sinks
                                                                 than filtering and recirculating the air. Vent fans are    may be crafted from more unusual materials, such as
                                                                 rated for airflow in cubic feet per minute (cfm) and       copper, brass, soapstone, concrete, or granite.
                                                                 by noise level measured in sones. Look for a high-              Stainless steel sinks are easy to clean, long-lasting,
                                                                 flow rating with a low noise rating. Large cooktops,       and available in every possible bowl configuration (top
                                                                 specialty grills, and wok burners require heavy-duty       mounts, undermounts, and apron fronts) and in every
                                                                 ventilation systems. Vent hoods over islands need to       price range. Stainless steel may show water spots
                                                                 be more powerful because of the open, rather than          and the sinks can be noisy if they are not properly
                                                                 enclosed, setting. Down-draft and pop-up vents pull        undercoated with sound-deadening material.
                                                                 the air down to exhaust, so they also need to be more           Cast-iron sinks have a fired-on porcelain finish.
                                                                 powerful. Each vent will have specific limitations         These sinks are durable, attractive, and are available
                                                                 concerning size and length of ductwork; make sure          in a wide range of designs and colors including top
                                                                 your planned vent outlet is within these limits.           mount, undermount, and apron front. The only
                                                                                                                            drawback of this type of sink is its hardness—you may
                                                                                                                                                                                               Replacing an old sink is a quick and easy way to make a
                                                                                                                            break a few more glasses than with a stainless, solid-             significant improvement to your kitchen.
                                                                                                                            surface, or resin sink. The porcelain finishes can wear
A vent fan can be a highly visible element of the room or it
                                                                                                                            and chip over time.
can be installed in a wall cabinet above the range where it is
virtually invisible.
                                                                                                                                 Enameled steel is the inexpensive cousin to cast              shock-absorbent, stain-resistant, and repairable. If
                                                                                                                            iron. The metal is thinner, the enamel is less durable             you should happen to stain, gouge, or scorch the
                                                                                                                            than porcelain, and the designs available may be                   material, a seamless, invisible repair through sanding
                                                                                                                            limited. However, if you can find a steel sink with a
■ Food Disposal                                                                                                             porcelain finish and polyester-resin backing, you will
                                                                                                                            have a sink that costs and weighs less than cast iron
                                                                                                                                                                                               or patching can be made.
                                                                                                                                                                                                    Fireclay is a vitreous-china product with a strong,
                                                                                                                                                                                               smooth finish and a very hard, non-marking surface.
                                                                 The main consideration when looking at food                and absorbs shock better.                                          These sinks are heavy and can be expensive. They are
                                           Dedicated GFI-
                                                                 disposers is horsepower. Models come with 3⁄8- to               Solid-surface sinks are available in a number of              available in a number of apron-front designs. Acrylic
                                           protected power       1-horsepower motors. A 3⁄4 or 1 HP model is almost         styles, but a limited range of colors. They are most               and fiberglass sinks are inexpensive, shock-absorbing,
                                                                 always worth the extra cost when it comes to               frequently found in undermount styles rather than                  and easy to clean but might not have good longevity.
           Drain                                                 operation and durability. The larger, more expensive       drop-ins. This is because the majority of solid surface            Resin sinks are composites of resin, pigment, quartz,
           outlet                                                models are quieter, carry longer warranties, and have      sinks are integrated with a solid-surface counter,                 or other minerals. This material does not chip, scratch,
                                                                 more features. Most models are continuous feed,            where they will be attached under the countertop                   stain, crack or mark.
                                                                 which means that a switch (usually on the wall, but        in a seamless installation. Solid-surface sinks are
                                                                 occasionally sink or counter mounted) is flipped, the
          Y-fitting
                                                                 motor runs and items can be fed through the rubber
                                                                                                                                                                                                   Shopping Tips ▸
                                                                 gasket continuously. People with septic systems should         Universal Sink Design ▸                                            When purchasing a sink, also plan on buying a new
                                                                 be aware that a disposer adds to the overall load on the                                                                            strainer body or disposer sleeve, sink clips, and a
                                                                 septic tank. Even though disposer units say they are           Sink depths of 8", 9", or 10" are becoming popular,                  fresh drain trap kit.
                                                                 safe for septic tanks and some even come with enzyme           but very tall or short users will find it difficult to reach       Look for a sink with a basin divider that is lower than
                                                      Armored
                                                      cable      sprays to help promote the bacterial action, they still        the sink bottom comfortably. Raise or lower your sink                the sink rim—this reduces splashing.
  Sink P-trap                  Disposer P-trap                   add to the amount of sludge in the tank.                       countertop to enable the primary user to stand at the              Drain holes located near the back of the basin create
                                                                                                                                sink and easily reach the bottom without bending.                    more usable space in the sink base cabinet.
A quality food disposer stays out of sight and out of
mind. The more powerful the motor, the less likely it will 		                                                                   Single-handle faucets are much easier to use,                      Make sure your new sink has enough predrilled holes
bog down or clog.                                                                                                               allowing for continuous temperature adjustment and                   in the back deck and that they will work with your
                                                                                                                                easy on and off. Incorporating an anti-scald device                  faucet configuration (or, choose your sink first and
                                                                                                                                makes the faucet safer for children.                                 buy fittings to match).

154 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 155

                                                                                                                                   Energy Star & Energy Guide Labels ▸
■ Faucets
You’ll find many options when choosing a new kitchen             temperature easily with just one hand. Another                    If you’re in the market for a new appliance, it’s time         Energy Star is the Department of Energy’s wide-reaching
faucet. The best place to start the process is with your         difference is in the faucet body. Some faucets have               to start paying attention to those yellow-and-black            program that awards Energy Star status to the most
sink. In the past, most faucets were mounted directly            the taps and the spout mounted onto a faucet body,                ENERGYGUIDE labels you see pasted to the front of many         efficient products in a given class. The program applies
to the sink deck, which had three or four predrilled             so the spacing between the tailpieces is preset.                  new products. The labels, required by the Federal Trade        to major appliances, windows, doors, HVAC systems,
holes to accommodate the faucets, spout, sprayer,                Others, called widespread faucets, have independent               Commission, help consumers quickly compare models for          and other household items. In general, Energy Star
and perhaps a liquid soap dispenser or an air gap for            taps and spouts that can be configured any way you                their energy efficiency. The box in the middle of each label   products exceed the federal government’s energy-
the dishwasher. Modern kitchen faucets don’t always              please, as long as the tubes connecting the taps to               provides the “energy use” of all models in a given class,      efficiency standards and perform within the top 25
conform to this setup; many of them are designed to              the spouts reach. This type is best if you are installing         with an arrow showing where that particular model falls        percent of their categories.
be installed in a single hole in the sink deck or in the         the faucet in the countertop (a common way to go                  within the range. The label also gives you an estimated
countertop. If you plan to keep your old sink, look              about it with new countertops such as solid-surface,              annual operating cost for the appliance.
for a faucet that won’t leave empty holes in the deck.           quartz, or granite). In the past, kitchen faucets almost
Generally, it’s best to replace like for like, but unfilled      always had a remote pull‑out sprayer. The sprayer
stainless sink holes can be filled with snap-in plugs or         was attached to the faucet body with a hose directly
a soap dispenser.                                                below the mixing valve. While this type of sprayer is
     The two most basic kitchen faucet categories                still fairly common, many faucets today have integral
are single‑handle and two‑handle. Single-handled                 pull‑out spouts. These spouts are very convenient and
models are popular because you can adjust the water              less prone to failure than the old‑style sprayers.

A single‑handled, high-arc faucet with traditional remote        Single‑handled faucets may require four holes, as
sprayer. The mounting plate is decorative and optional.          does this model with its side sprayer and matching soap/
                                                                 lotion dispenser.

                                                                                                                                   Additional Resources ▸
                                                                                                                                   •    U.S. Department of Energy (DOE): www.energy.gov           •    Your state’s energy authority; some states offer
                                                                                                                                   •    Energy Star: www.energystar.gov                                rebates on high-efficiency appliances
                                                                                                                                   •    Consumer Reports, for unbiased analysis of                •    Association of Home Appliance Manufacturers:
                                                                                                                                        appliance performance and other shopping                       www.aham.org
                                                                                                                                        considerations, online at www.consumerreports.org         •    The Green Guide: www.thegreenguide.com
Two‑handled faucets are less common, but remain popular          A single‑handled faucet with pull‑out spray head requires         •    American Council for Energy-Efficient Economy:
choices for traditional kitchens. The gooseneck spout also has   only one hole in your sink deck or countertop—a real benefit           www.aceee.org
a certain elegance, but avoid this type if you have a shallow    if your sink is not predrilled or if it is an undermount model.   •    Your local utility provider
sink that’s less than 8" deep.

156 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 157

Ranges, Ovens & Cooktops                                                                                                             Tips for Installing Gas Ranges ▸

PU CGKitchens 2004 p. 134B plus inset. Run as
1/4 pg. in BTY position.                                          F    or the most part, installing a new range is
                                                                       simply a matter of positioning it, leveling it, and
                                                                  making sure it is hooked up to a receptacle and gas
                                                                  connection. If you are comfortable working with gas
                                                                  and plumbing, hooking up a gas range or cooktop
                                                                  is not difficult. But in many municipalities only
        PU CGKitchens 2004 p. 134B plus
                                                                  a licensed installer can make gas hook-ups. Ask
      inset. Run as 1/4 pg. in BTY position.
                                                                  your local building department if you are unsure
                                                                  (your appliance retailer is also a good source for
                                                                  information).
                                                                       When moving a range for painting or cleaning,
                                                                  removing it for replacement, or installing a new range,
                                                                  make sure you protect the flooring. Use an appliance
                                                                  dolly to lift a new range from the side only—not the
                                                                  front or the back. If the range will not fit through
                                                                  doors, remove the oven door handle. An electric range              Flexible appliance connectors are required for                Shut off gas at the nearest in-line shutoff or stopcock
                                                                  or cooktop must have its own dedicated 240-volt                    hooking a gas inlet port up to a gas supply valve. Flexible   valve, as well as the supply valve you will be hooking up
Protect your flooring when moving a range, whether it is                                                                             connectors are usually made of stainless steel, and some      to. When closed, a stopcock valve is perpendicular to the
an old one on the way out or a brand-new one being installed.
                                                                  circuit. Gas ranges and cooktops also need a grounded
                                                                                                                                     areas require that the steel be protected with a PVC          gas pipe as seen here.
Typically, ranges have adjustable feet that can gouge floor       3-hole electrical outlet to power the electronic
                                                                                                                                     coating. These are sold in a variety of lengths. Buy the
coverings. A piece of cardboard, tagboard, or a carpet scrap      ignition, clock, and timers.                                       shortest connector that will reach from the supply valve
can be slipped under the appliance.                                                                                                  to the inlet port.

■ Installing Electric Ranges

                                                                                                                                     Use two wrenches to securely attach the appliance             Attach the other end of the flexible appliance
                                                                                                                                     connector tube to the gas supply valve. One wrench            connector tube to the gas inlet port in your range
                                                                                                                                     should be used to hold the tube securely and the other        or cooktop. Also use yellow Teflon tape to lubricate
Receptacles for electric ranges should look like this. They       A dedicated circuit with a double pole 50-amp breaker              to tighten the male tube coupling onto the female supply      the threads at this union. Turn on the gas supply and
are 50-amp, combination 125/250 volt fittings with a three-slot   supplies power to the high-voltage receptacle for your electric    valve. Be sure to wrap a layer of gas-rated (yellow) Teflon   immediately test all connections with leak detector
configuration that will only work with electric range appliance   range. Most codes require 6-gauge copper service entrance          tape around the supply valve threads before attaching the     solution. If the connections pass, slide the appliance into
cords. They provide 125-volt power to run lights, clocks, and     round (SER) cable for the circuit. If your circuit does not meet   coupling. Do not overtighten the coupling.                    position, taking care not to cause stress on or kinks in the
timers and 250-volt service to the heating elements.              these standards, contact a qualified electrician to upgrade the                                                                  connector tube.
                                                                  circuit. Note: Always shut off power at the main service panel
                                                                  before removing a service panel cover.

158 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 159

Refrigerator Icemaker                                                                                                                    ■ How to Install a Refrigerator Icemaker
                                                                                                                                           1                                                                     2
T   here’s nothing really tricky about installing a
    refrigerator unless your new model has a built-in
icemaker. If your old refrigerator was equipped with
                                                                      case, all you need to do is take the make and model
                                                                      information to an appliance parts dealer, and they can
                                                                      sell you an aftermarket icemaker. Plan to spend $100
an icemaker, you should already have a water supply                   to $200.
line running to the refrigerator area. If there is no
supply line, contact a plumber to install one for you
if you do not know how. Most icemakers either come
preinstalled or are purchased as an accessory when
you buy your new refrigerator. But if you have an
older refrigerator with no icemaker and you’d like it to
have one, all is not lost. Inspect the back of the unit,
behind the freezer compartment. If your refrigerator
has the required plumbing to support an icemaker, you
will see a port that is covered with backing. In that

    Tools & Materials ▸                                                                                                                  Remove all the contents from the refrigerator and freezer             On the back of the refrigerator, remove the backing or
                                                                                                                                         compartments and store them in ice chests or in a neighbor’s          unscrew the icemaker access panel that covers the
                                                                                                                                         refrigerator. Unplug the unit and pull it out from the wall. Then     icemaker port.
    Screwdrivers                       Icemaker kit
                                                                                                                                         open the freezer door and remove the icemaker cover plate at
    Nut drivers                        Saddle valve or T‑fitting                                                                         the back of the compartment.
    Needle‑nose pliers                  (for supply tube)
    Duct or masking tape               Putty knife
    Electric drill and assorted bits   Tape
    Channel‑type pliers
                                                                      A built-in icemaker is easy to install as a retrofit appliance
                                                                      in most modern refrigerators. If you want to have an endless         3                                                4                                            5
    Open‑end or                                                       supply of ice for home use, you may wonder how you ever got                         Water port
     adjustable wrench                                                along without one.

    How Icemakers Work ▸
                                                                   An icemaker receives its supply of water for making cubes
                                                                   through a ¼" copper supply line that runs from the icemaker
                                                                   to a water pipe. The supply line runs through a valve in the           Wiring harness port
                                                                   refrigerator and is controlled by a solenoid that monitors the
                                                                   water supply and sends the water into the icemaker itself,
                                                                   where it is turned into ice cubes. The cubes drop down into a
                                                                   bin, and as the ice level rises, they also raise a bail wire that’s
                                                                   connected to a shutoff. When the bin is full, the bail wire will
                                                                   be high enough to trigger a mechanism that shuts off the
                                                                   water supply.

                                                                                                                                         Locate and clear the ports. One                 Install the water tube assembly               Hook up the harness. Icemaker kits
                                                                                                                                         opening is for the water line. The              (part of the icemaker kit) in its             usually come with a wiring harness
                                                                   Aftermarket automatic icemakers are simple to                         other is for a wiring harness. Usually,         access hole on the back of the                that joins the icemaker motor to
                                                                   install as long as your refrigerator is icemaker-ready. Buy the       these holes are filled with insulation          refrigerator. This assembly features          the power supply wires. Push this
                                                                   correct model for your appliance and do careful installation          plugs that keep the cold air inside             a plastic elbow attached to the               harness through the access hole and
                                                                   work—icemaker water supply lines are very common                      the freezer from leaking out into               plastic tube that reaches into the            into the freezer compartment. Seal
                                                                   sources for leaks.                                                    the room. Remove these plugs with               freezer compartment.                          the hole with the plastic grommet
                                                                                                                                         needle‑nose pliers.                                                                           supplied with the harness.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  (continued)

160 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 161

  6                                                                    7                                                                  10                                                                  11

                                                                                                                    Solenoid

                                                                         Tube to icemaker

Join the end of the icemaker wiring harness to the power             Attach the water tube at the top of the refrigerator to the        Install the water‑inlet copper tube once the solenoid              Join the water‑inlet tube to the water supply tubing
connector that was preinstalled on the back of the refrigerator.     solenoid that is mounted at the bottom with a plastic water        is mounted. Attach it by tightening the nut on one end with        (from the house plumbing system) with a brass compression
This connection should be flat against the back. If it isn’t, tape   line. Run the tube down the back of the refrigerator and attach    channel‑type pliers. The other end of the tube is held to the      coupling. Tighten the compression nuts with an open‑end or
it down with duct tape or masking tape.                              it to the solenoid valve with a compression fitting. This job is   refrigerator cabinet with a simple clamp. Make sure the end        adjustable wrench.
                                                                     easier to do before you attach the solenoid assembly to the        of this tubing is pointing straight up.
                                                                     refrigerator cabinet.

  8                                                                    9                                                                  12                                              13                                         14

                                                                                                                                        Make sure the water tube and                   Connect the wire harness to                 Install the icemaker. Remove
                                                                                                                                        the wiring harness (from the back              the plug on the icemaker unit. Also         any small rubber caps that may
                                                                                                                                        of the refrigerator) are free inside           connect the water supply tube to the        be installed in the mounting screw
Identify the two snap connectors on the wiring                       Attach the solenoid to a mounting bracket that should be
                                                                                                                                        the freezer compartment. If they are           back of the icemaker with a spring          holes with a narrow putty knife. Lift
harness. One goes to the preinstalled wires on the                   installed on the cabinet wall at the bottom of the refrigerator.
                                                                                                                                        caught on the cabinet, loosen them             clip or hose clamp.                         the unit and screw it to the freezer
refrigerator and the other is attached to the solenoid. 		           Mounting holes may be predrilled in the cabinet for this
                                                                                                                                        until they are easily accessible.                                                          wall. The mounting bracket holes are
Just push this second connector onto the brass tabs,                 purpose. But if not, drill holes to match the bracket and the
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   usually slotted to permit leveling the
usually at the top of the solenoid.                                  size of the screws. Then attach the bracket and make sure to
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   unit. Plug in the refrigerator and test
                                                                     attach the solenoid ground wire to one of these screws.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   the icemaker.

162 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 163

Dishwasher                                                                                                                      Efficient Loading ▸
                                                                                                                                To get the best circulation of water for effective wash action, follow these tips when loading dishes:

A    dishwasher that’s past its prime may be inefficient          standard sizes, most full-sized dishwashers will fit          • Make sure dishes are loaded so water can reach all of the soiled surfaces.
      in more ways than one. If it’s an old model, it             right in. Of course, you should always measure the            • Be sure that larger items are not blocking smaller items from the wash action.
probably wasn’t designed to be very efficient to begin            dimensions of the old unit before shopping for a new          • Place all items in both racks so that they are separated and face the center of the dishwasher. This will help to ensure
with. But more significantly, if it no longer cleans              one to avoid an unpleasant surprise at installation              that water reaches all soiled surfaces.
effectively, you’re probably spending a lot of time               time. Also be sure to review the manufacturer’s               • Place glasses with the open end facing downward to allow proper washing action.
and hot water prerinsing the dishes. This alone can               instructions before starting any work.                        • Do not place glasses over the tines, but between them. This will allow the glasses to lean toward the spray arm and
consume more energy and water than a complete                                                                                      will improve washing. It also promotes drying by reducing the amount of water remaining on the top of the glass after
wash cycle on a newer machine. So even if your old                                                                                 the wash cycle is complete.
dishwasher still runs, replacing it with an efficient                                                                           • Do not allow flatware to “nest.” This prevents proper water distribution between the surfaces.
                                                                       Tools & Materials ▸                                      • Load flatware, except knives, with some handles up and some down to prevent nesting. For safety, knives should
new model can be a good green upgrade.
     In terms of sizing and utility hookups, dishwashers                                                                           always be loaded handles up.
                                                                       Screwdrivers                        Cable connector
are generally quite standard. If your old machine                      Adjustable wrench                   Teflon tape
is a built-in and your countertops and cabinets are                    2-ft. level                         Hose clamps
                                                                       5
                                                                        ⁄8" automotive heater hose         Wire connectors
                                                                       Automotive heater hose              Carpet scrap
                                                                       4" of 1⁄2" copper tubing            Bowl

Replacing an old, inefficient dishwasher is a straightforward project that usually takes just a few hours. The energy savings
begin with the first load of dishes and continue with every load thereafter.

164 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 165

■ How to Replace a Dishwasher
  1                                                                   2                                                                    5                                                               6

Shut off the electrical power to the dishwasher circuit at          Disconnect the old plumbing connections. First unscrew
the service panel. Also, turn off the water supply at the shutoff   the front access panel. Once the access panel is removed,
valve, usually located directly under the floor.                    disconnect the water supply line from the L-fitting on the         Detach the unit from the surrounding cabinets. Remove             Prepare the new dishwasher. Tip it on its back and attach
                                                                    bottom of the unit. This is usually a brass compression fitting,   the screws that hold the brackets to the underside of the         the new L-fitting into the threaded port on the solenoid. Apply
                                                                    so just turning the compression nut counterclockwise with an       countertop. Then put a piece of cardboard or old carpet under     some Teflon tape or pipe sealant to the fitting threads before
                                                                    adjustable wrench should do the trick. Use a bowl to catch any     the front legs to protect the floor from getting scratched, and   tightening it in place to prevent possible leaks.
                                                                    water that might leak out when the nut is removed.                 pull the dishwasher out.

  3                                                                   4                                                                    7                                                               8

Disconnect the old wiring connections. The dishwasher               Disconnect the discharge hose, which is usually connected          Attach a length of new automotive heater hose, usually            Prepare for the wiring connections. Like the old
has an integral electrical box at the front of the unit where the   to the dishwasher port on the side of the garbage disposer. To     5
                                                                                                                                        ⁄8" diameter, to the end of the dishwasher’s discharge hose      dishwasher, the new one will have an integral electrical box
power cable is attached to the dishwasher’s fixture wires. Take     remove it, loosen the screw on the hose clamp and pull it off.     nipple with a hose clamp. The new hose you are adding should      for making the wiring connections. To gain access to the box,
off the box cover and remove the wire connectors that join the      You may need to push this hose back through a hole in the          be long enough to reach from the discharge nipple to the port     remove the box cover. Then install a cable connector on the
wires together.                                                     cabinet wall and into the dishwasher compartment so it won’t       on the side of the kitchen sink garbage disposer.                 back of the box and bring the power cable from the service
                                                                    get caught when you pull the dishwasher out.                                                                                         panel through this connector. Power should be shut off at the
                                                                                                                                                                                                         main service panel at all times.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              (continued)

166 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 167

  9                                                                  10                                                                    11                                                              12
                                                                                                                                             Discharge tube
                                                                                                                                             from dishwasher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Supply
                                                                                                                                                                                                               Fitting              tube
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Compression nut
                                                                                                                                            Drain

Install a leveling leg at each of the four corners while the       Once the dishwasher is level, attach the brackets to
new dishwasher is still on its back. Just turn the legs into the   the underside of the countertop to keep the appliance from            Push the adapter over the disposer’s discharge nipple           Adjust the L-fitting on the dishwasher’s water inlet valve
threaded holes designed for them. Leave about 1⁄2" of each leg     moving. Then pull the discharge hose into the sink cabinet and        and tighten it in place with a hose clamp. If you don’t have    until it points directly toward the water supply tubing. Lubricate
projecting from the bottom of the unit. These will have to be      install it so there’s a loop that is attached with a bracket to the   a disposer, this discharge hose can be clamped directly to      the threads slightly with a drop of dishwashing liquid and
adjusted later to level the appliance. Tip the appliance up onto   underside of the countertop. This loop prevents waste water           a modified sink tailpiece that’s installed below a standard     tighten the tubing’s compression nut onto the fitting. Use an
the feet and slide it into the opening. Check for level in both    from flowing from the disposer back into the dishwasher.              sink strainer.                                                  adjustable wrench and turn the nut clockwise.
directions and adjust the feet as required.

     Lengthening a Discharge Hose ▸                                                                                                        13                                                              14
       1                                                             2

     If the discharge hose has to be modified to fit onto the      Clamp the rubber disposer adapter to the end
     disposer port, first insert a 4"-long piece of ½" copper      of the copper tubing nipple. Then tighten the hose
     tubing into the hose and hold it in place with a hose         clamp securely.                                                       Complete the electrical connections by tightening the           Install the access panel, usually by hooking it on a
     clamp. This provides a nipple for the rubber adapter that                                                                           connector’s clamp on the cable and then joining the power       couple of prongs just below the dishwasher’s door. Install the
     fits onto the disposer.                                                                                                             wires to the fixture wires with wire connectors. Attach the     screws (if any) that hold it in place, and turn on the water and
                                                                                                                                         ground wire (or wires) to the grounding screw on the box, and   power supplies. Replace the toe-kick panel at the bottom of
                                                                                                                                         replace the cover.                                              the dishwasher.

168 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 169

■ Variation: Installing a Raised Dishwasher
R    aising the dishwasher 6 to 9" makes it much
     easier to load and unload. You’ll eliminate a lot
of stooping, which is especially important for people
                                                                         Tools & Materials ▸                                                       3                                                                  4
with sore backs. A raised dishwasher is also much
                                                                         Circular saw                     ⁄2" plywood
                                                                                                          1

                                                                         Drill                            Screws (2”, 1 1⁄4”, & 3⁄4”)
easier for wheelchair users to operate.
      These directions are for raising an existing
                                                                         Framing square                   ⁄2" × 2" angle irons
                                                                                                          1

dishwasher 81⁄4"—the height of a 2 × 8 and a sheet
                                                                         Jigsaw                           ⁄2" × 4" mending plates
                                                                                                          1

                                                                         2 × 8 lumber                     Masking tape
of 1⁄2" plywood. These directions cover the new extra
                                                                         1 × 3 lumber                     Edge banding
space above the toe kick with a piece of matching
cabinetry. Because the platform will cover the
previous access holes, you will need to cut new access            Part      Name                 Measurements               Material       No.
holes in the side cabinets. A raised dishwasher ideally             A       Platform sides       24"*                       2×8             2
should have 12" of countertop available on one side as
                                                                    B       Platform cross braces 21"*                      2×8             2
a “landing” area for dish unloading.
      If your dishwasher currently abuts the sink, you              C       Platform top         24" × 24"                  1
                                                                                                                             ⁄2" plywood    1
will need to move it, since the sink needs to have
                                                                    D       Floor panel          24" × 8 ⁄4"* 1             1
                                                                                                                             ⁄2" plywood
clearance of 12" on one side and 21" on the other.
Because dishwashers are meant to be built in, the                   E       Cleat                21"		                      1×3             1
directions include the creation of side panels to                 *approximate measurement, cut to fit.
house the portion of the dishwasher that extends                                                                                                 Cut the plywood side panels to size. For frameless cabinets,       For framed cabinets, cut the length to match the cabinet
above the countertop.                                                                                                                            cut the length to match the front edge of the cabinet sides. Use   front edge minus the face frame. Use a compass to scribe
                                                                                                                                                 a compass to scribe the backsplash cutouts for the side panels     the backsplash cutouts for the side panels, cut using a jigsaw.
                                                                                                                                                 and cut using a jigsaw. Apply edge banding to the exposed          Install a matching face frame filler strip. Use scrap lumber and
                                                                                                                                                 edge and install with the mending plates.                          mending plates to set the panels back from the edge.
■ How to Make a Raised Platform for a Dishwasher
                                                                                                                                                   5                                                                  6
  1      Platform
         top
                                                                        2

   Platform
   sides

                       Crossbraces              Toe-kick

Remove the dishwasher completely. Cut a 4 × 4" notch              Put masking tape on top of the counter and use a framing
in each platform side piece. (Make sure this matches your         square to mark cutting lines flush with the cabinet edges on
existing toe-kick space. Most toe-kick cutouts are 4 × 4" and     each side of the opening. Use a jigsaw to cut the countertop.                  Cut the new countertop to size and apply the edge trim to          Make the necessary connections and slide the
covered with molding.) Place the cross brace to align with the    To cut the backsplash, use a jamb saw or a reciprocating saw.                  match. Attach a 1 × 3 cleat to the wall using 2" screws. Install   dishwasher into the new space. Make the final connections
back of the toe-kick cutout. Place the other cross brace at the   The masking tape prevents the laminate from chipping.                          the countertop using two angle irons per side and 3⁄4" screws.     (see page 169). Reattach the access panel cover (if present),
back. Drill pilot holes and attach with 2" screws. Cut the 1⁄2"                                                                                                                                                     but leave off the toe-kick plate. Purchase or make a floor panel
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    to match your cabinets and install it across the front of the
plywood to fit the platform and attach with 11⁄4" screws. Place
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    platform and the dishwasher toe-kick space. Install the toe-kick
the platform into the dishwasher opening.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    molding to match.

170 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 171

Food Disposer

F   ood disposers are standard equipment in modern
    homes, and most of us have come to depend
on them to macerate our plate leavings and crumbs
                                                                       Disposers are hardwired to a switch mounted in
                                                                  an electrical box in the wall above the countertop. If
                                                                  your kitchen is not equipped for this, consult a wiring
                                                                                                                                             Upper
                                                                                                                                             mounting
                                                                                                                                             ring
                                                                                                                                                                 Sink
                                                                                                                                                                 sleeve

                                                                                                                                                                                                              Flange
so they can exit the house along with waste water                 guide or hire an electrician. The actual electrical
from the sink drain. If your existing disposer needs              hookup of the appliance is quite simple (you only have                                                              Mounting                Sleeve
                                                                                                                                                                                      screw
replacing, you’ll find that the job is relatively simple,         to join two wires) but hire an electrician if you are not        Backup
                                                                                                                                   ring
especially if you select a replacement appliance that is          comfortable with the job.                                                                                                                   Fiber
the same model as the old one. In that case, you can                                                                                                                                    Lower                 gasket
                                                                                                                                                                                        mounting
probably reuse the existing mounting assembly, drain                                                                                                                                    ring
sleeve, and drain plumbing.                                            Tools & Materials ▸                                         Dishwasher
                                                                                                                                   nipple
     Most food disposers are classified as “continuous                                                                                                                                                        Backup
                                                                                                                                                                                                              ring
feed” because they can only operate when an ON/                        Screwdriver                     Putty knife
OFF switch on the wall is being actively held down.                    Channel‑type pliers             Mineral spirits
Let go of the switch, and the disposer stops. Each                     Spud wrench (optional)          Plumber’s putty
appliance has a power rating between one-third and                     Hammer                          Wire caps                                                                                              Upper
                                                                                                                                                                                                              mounting
                                                                                                                                                                                         Grinding
one HP (horsepower). More powerful models bog                          Hacksaw or tubing cutter        Hose clamps                 Sound
                                                                                                                                                                                         ring
                                                                                                                                                                                                              ring
                                                                                                                                   insulation
down less under load and the motors last longer                        Kitchen drain supplies          Threaded Y-fitting
                                                                                                                                                                                                              Snap ring
because they don’t have to work as hard. They are 		                   Drain auger                     Electrical tape
also costlier.
                                                                                                                                                                                                      The disposer is attached directly to the sink sleeve, which
                                                                                                                                                                                                      comes with the disposer and replaces the standard sink
                                                                                                                                                                                                      strainer. A snap ring fits into a groove around the sleeve of
                                                                                                                                                                                                      the strainer body to prevent the upper mounting ring and
                                                                                                                                                                                                      backup ring from sliding down while the upper mounting ring
                                                                                                                                                                                                      is tightened against the backup ring with mounting screws. A
                                                                                                                                                                                                      fiber gasket seals the connection from beneath the sink.
                                                                                                                                   Discharge
                                                                                                                                   opening
                                                                                                  Dedicated GFI-                                                                         Impellers
                                                                                                  protected power

                                                                                                                                    Drain
                                                                                                                                    chamber
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Baffle

         Drain outlet

                                                                                                                                         Shown cutaway                    Motor

                                        Y-fitting                                               Armored
                                                                                                cable                              A food disposer grinds food waste so it can be flushed
                                                                                                                                   away through the sink drain system. A quality disposer has
                                                                                                                                   a 1⁄2 –horsepower, self‑reversing motor that will not jam.
                                                                                                                                   Other features to look for include foam sound insulation, a                     Waste-T            Waste-T with baffle
                                                                                                                                   grinding ring, and overload protection that allows the motor
                                                                                                                                   to be reset if it overheats. Better food disposers have a 5‑year   Kitchen and drain tees are required to have a baffle if the
                                                                                                                                   manufacturer's warranty.                                           tee is connected to a dishwasher or disposer. The baffle is
          Sink P-trap
                                                                                                                                                                                                      intended to prevent discharge from finding its way up the
                                                                                                                                                                                                      drain and into the sink. However, the baffle also reduces the
                                    Disposer P-trap
                                                                                                                                                                                                      drain flow capacity by half, which can cause the dishwasher
                                                                                                                                                                                                      or disposer to back up. You cannot, by most codes, simply
A properly functioning food disposer that’s used correctly can actually help reduce clogs by ensuring that large bits of organic
                                                                                                                                                                                                      replace the tee with another that has no baffle. The safest way
matter don’t get into the drain system by accident. Many plumbers suggest using separate P-traps for the disposer and the drain
                                                                                                                                                                                                      to get around the problem is to run separate drains and traps
outlet tube as shown here.
                                                                                                                                                                                                      to a Y-fitting at the trap arm (as shown on previous page).

172 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 173

■ How to Install a Food Disposer
                                                                      Tip ▸
  1                                                                                                                                                   4                                                                 5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Fiber gasket

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   Sink
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   sleeve
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 Backup ring

                                                                                                                                                                                   Sink sleeve

                                                                                                                         Provision to make
                                                                                                                        putty look old, flattened

Remove the old disposer if you have one. You’ll need to
disconnect the drainpipes and traps first. If your old disposer                                                                                     Press the flange of the sink sleeve for your new disposer         Slip the fiber gasket and then the backup ring onto the sink
has a special wrench for the mounting lugs, use it to loosen                                                                                        into a thin coil of plumber’s putty that you have laid around     sleeve, working from inside the sink base cabinet. Make sure
                                                                       Alternate: If you are installing a disposer in a sink
the lugs. Otherwise, use a screwdriver. If you do not have a                                                                                        the perimeter of the drain opening. The sleeve should be          the backup ring is oriented the same way it was before you
                                                                       that did not previously have one, remove the old
helper, place a solid object directly beneath the disposer to                                                                                       well‑seated in the coil.                                          disassembled the mounting assembly.
support it before you begin removal. Important: Shut off the           sink strainer and drain tailpiece. Scrape up any old
electrical power at the main service panel before you begin            plumber’s putty and clean the sink thoroughly around
removal. Disconnect the wire leads, cap them, and stuff them           the drain opening with mineral spirits.
into the electrical box.
                                                                                                                                                      6                                                                 7
  2                                                                 3

                                                                                             Upper
                                                                                             mounting ring

                                                                                             Lower mounting ring                                    Insert the upper mounting ring onto the sleeve with the           Make electrical connections before you mount the
                                                                                                                                                    slotted ends of the screws facing away from the backup ring       disposer unit on the mounting assembly. Shut off the power
                                                                                                                   Snap ring                        so you can access them. Then, holding all three parts at the      at the service panel if you have turned it back on. Remove the
                                                                                                                                                    top of the sleeve, slide the snap ring onto the sleeve until it   access plate from the disposer. Attach the white and black
                                                                                                                                                    snaps into the groove. Tighten the three mounting screws on       feeder wires from the electrical box to the white and black
Clear the drain lines all the way to the branch drain before      Disassemble the mounting assembly and then                                        the upper mounting ring until the tips press firmly against the   wires (respectively) inside the disposer. Twist a small wire cap
you begin the new installation. Remove the trap and the trap      separate the upper and lower mounting rings and the                               backup ring (inset photo). It is the tension created by these     onto each connection and wrap it with electrical tape for good
arm first.                                                        backup ring. Also remove the snap ring from the sink sleeve.                      screws that keeps the disposer steady and minimizes vibrating.    measure. Also attach the green ground wire from the box to
                                                                  See photo, page 173.                                                                                                                                the grounding terminal on your disposer.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (continued)

174 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 175

  8                                                                 9                                                                     12                                         13
                                                                                                                                           Outlet from sink

                                                                                                                                              Y-fitting

                                                                                                                                                    Trap arm

                                                                                                                                                                                                      P-trap

                                                                                                                                                           P-trap

                                                                                                                                        Install a trap arm for the disposer        Spin the disposer so the end of the discharge tube is lined up over the open end of
                                                                                                                                        in the open port of the Y-fitting at the   the P‑trap, and confirm that they will fit together correctly. If the discharge tube extends
Knock out the plug in the disposer port if you will be            Hang the disposer from the mounting ring attached to the              wall stubout. Then, attach a P‑trap or     down too far, mark a line on it at the top of the P‑trap and cut through the line with a
connecting your dishwasher to the disposer. If you have           sink sleeve. To hang it, simply lift it up and position the unit so   a combination of a tube extension          hacksaw. If the tube is too short, attach an extension with a slip joint. You may need to
no dishwasher, leave the plug in. Insert a large flathead         the three mounting ears are underneath the three mounting             and a P‑trap so the low end of the         further shorten the discharge tube first to create enough room for the slip joint on the
screwdriver into the port opening and rap it with a mallet.       screws and then spin the unit so all three ears fit into the          trap will align with the bottom of the     extension. Slide a slip nut and beveled compression washer onto the discharge tube
Retrieve the knock plug from inside the disposer canister.        mounting assembly. Wait until after the plumbing hookups              disposer discharge tube.                   and attach the tube to the P‑trap.
                                                                  have been made to lock the unit in place.

  10                                                                11                                                                    14                Dishwasher
                                                                                                                                                                                                                15
                                                                                                                                                            discharge tube

                                                                         Drain stubout

                                                                               Y-fitting

                                                                                                                                        Connect the dishwasher discharge tube to the inlet port              Lock the disposer into position on the mounting ring
Attach the discharge tube to the disposer according to the        Attach a Y-fitting at the drain stubout. The Y‑fitting should         located at the top of the disposer unit. This may require a          assembly once you have tested it to make sure it is functioning
manufacturer’s instructions. It is important to get a very good   be sized to accept a drain line from the disposer and another         dishwasher hookup kit (see page 168).                                correctly and without leaks. Lock it by turning one of the
seal here, or the disposer will leak. Go ahead and spin the       from the sink. Adjust the sink drain plumbing as needed to get                                                                             mounting lugs with a screwdriver until it makes contact with
disposer if it helps you access the discharge port.               from the sink P‑trap to one opening of the Y.                                                                                              the locking notch.

176 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 177

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       38w
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        38wx x16d
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               16d

Range Hood/Vent Fan                                                                                                              Three Types of Kitchen Ventilation ▸

                                                                                                                                               PUCG Green Home p. 27
                                                                                                                                               Author                          ISBN #                         Author's review
                                                                                                                                                Green Living                   0781760607                       (if needed)
                                                                                                                                                                                                               PUCG Green Home p. 27
                                                                                                                                               Fig. #                Document name                                              OK     Correx
                                                                                                                                                 F09                  F09.eps
                                                                                                                                               Artist                       Date                                  Initials      Date
                                                                                                                                                                                        12/05/2007
                                                                                                                                                Accurate Art, Inc.
                                                                                                                                                                            Check if revision                  CE's review
                                                                                                                                               BxW             2/C         4/C                                                  OK     Correx

                                                                                                                                               Final Size (Width x Depth in Picas)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Initials      Date
                                                                                                                                                38w x 16d
                                                                                                                                 Overhead vent hoods are the best all-	                      Downdraft systems have no hood to capture rising
                                                                                                                                 around performers.                                          exhaust and must pull the hot air down in order to
                                                                                                                                                                                             evacuate it.

Range hoods are vent fans that are mounted directly over a slide-in range or a cooktop. Some are meant to be seen while others
are designed to be hidden in a cabinet or soffit.

E   ffective ventilation is important for ridding your
    kitchen of cooking odors, excess moisture (think:
mold), smoke, and exhaust fumes from gas burners.
                                                                 in reversing the natural flow of air and vapor. Also,
                                                                 many downdraft systems tend to draw heat away from
                                                                 burners (especially gas burners), so your pans don’t
If you don’t already have a good vent system in place,           heat as evenly when the fan is on.
you should consider installing one to improve your                    Sizing is important with hood systems. The hood
indoor air quality. Recirculating vent fans—those                should be at least as wide as, but preferably up to
without a duct running outside—also should be                    6" wider than, the cooktop and at least 20" deep.                                                          PUCG Green Home p. 27
replaced, since all they really do is pretend to filter the      The power, or capacity, of the fan is another critical
air before blowing it right back into the kitchen.               factor. Expert recommendations vary. Some say a
     The two main types of mechanical ventilation                standard hood fan should move 40 cfm (cubic feet per
are overhead hoods and downdraft (or cooktop)                    minute) for every 12" of cooktop width; for example,
fans. Overhead systems include the basic under-                  a 30"-wide cooktop gets a 100 cfm fan, which is the
cabinet types and the higher-end suspended styles                minimum required under many building codes. The
with exposed ducting extending from the ceiling.                 National Kitchen & Bath Association recommends
Overheads are more effective and require less suction            150 cfm as a minimum for hood fans.
than downdraft vents, primarily because they work                     The manufacturer of your range or cooktop may
with nature rather than against it: Hot air rises,               have its own recommendations. Undersizing a fan
so all that steam, grease, and fragrant cooking air              results in inadequate ventilation, but oversizing it                                         Windows are a low-tech option. They can introduce
is easy to capture inside a hood for transfer to the             could potentially lead to a dangerous backdrafting into                                      cross breezes but are less effective than fan systems at
outdoors. Downdraft fans have to work much harder                the home.                                                                                    eliminating cooking exhaust.

178 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 179

■ How to Install a Range Hood
  1                                                                 2                                                                 5                                                                  6

Install the vent duct in the wall first, then cut a hole in the   Make sure the circuit power is turned off at the service          Downdraft cooktop: With a built-in blower unit that vents          Wall vent: If the duct comes out through the sidewall of the
back of the range hood cabinet and mount the cabinet over         panel, then join the power cable wires to the lead wires inside   through the back or bottom of a base cabinet. A downdraft          house, install a vertical duct cap. Make sure to seal around the
the duct. Cut a vent hole in the bottom of the cabinet to match   the range hood. Use wire connectors for this job.                 cooktop is a good choice for a kitchen island or peninsula.        perimeter of the cap with exterior caulk.
the opening on the top of the hood.

  3                                                                 4                                                                 7                                                                  8

Get someone to help lift the range hood into place and hold       Run ductwork from the cabinet to the exhaust exit point. Use      Ceiling vent: If the duct goes through an overhang soffit,         Roof vent: For ducts that pass through the roof, cut an
it there while you attach it. Drive two screws through both       two 45° adjustable elbows to join the duct in the wall to the     you’ll need a transition fitting to connect the round duct to a    access hole through the roofing and sheathing, then install a
sides and into the adjacent cabinets. If the hood is slightly     top of the range hood. Use sheet metal screws and duct tape       short piece of rectangular duct. Once these parts are installed,   weatherproof cap on top of the duct and under the roofing
small for the opening, slip a shim between the hood and the       to hold all parts together and keep them from moving.             add a protective grille to keep animals and insects from getting   shingles. Make a waterproof seal by caulking the cap with
walls, trying to keep the gaps even.                                                                                                into the duct.                                                     plastic roof cement.

180 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 181

Drop-in Sink                                                                                                                     ■ How to Install a Self-rimming Sink
                                                                                                                                   1                                          2                                         3
M      ost drop-in, self-rimming kitchen sinks are
       easy to install. Drop-in sinks for do-it-yourself
installation are made from cast iron coated with
                                                                       Tools & Materials ▸
                                                                       Caulk gun          Plumber’s putty or silicone caulk
enamel, stainless steel, enameled steel, acrylic,
                                                                       Spud wrench        Mounting clips
fiberglass, or resin composites. Because cast-iron sinks
                                                                       Screwdriver        Jigsaw
are heavy, their weight holds them in place, and they
                                                                       Sink               Pen or pencil
require no mounting hardware.
                                                                       Sink frame         Wrench
     Stainless steel and enameled-steel sinks weigh
less than cast-iron, and most require mounting
brackets on the underside of the countertop. Some
acrylic and resin sinks rely on silicone caulk to hold
                                                                       Shopping Tips ▸
them in place. If you are replacing a sink, but not the
countertop, make sure the new sink is the same size or                 • When purchasing a sink, you also need to buy
larger than the old sink. All old silicone caulk residue                  strainer bodies and baskets, sink clips, and a drain
must be removed with acetone or denatured alcohol,                        trap kit.
or the new caulk will not stick.                                       • Look for basin dividers that are lower than the sink
                                                                          rim—this reduces splashing.
                                                                                                                                 Invert the sink and trace around the       Drill a starter hole and cut out the      Attach as much of the plumbing
                                                                       • Drain holes in the back or to the side make for
                                                                                                                                 edges as a reference for making the        sink opening with a jigsaw. Cut right     as makes sense to install prior to
                                                                          more usable space under the sink.                      sink cutout cutting lines, which should    up to the line. Because the sink flange   setting the sink into the opening.
                                                                       • When choosing a sink, make sure the predrilled          be parallel to the outlines, but about     fits over the edges of the cutout, the    Having access to the underside of the
                                                                          openings will fit your faucet.                         1" inside of them to create a 1" ledge.    opening doesn’t need to be perfect,       flange is a great help when it comes
                                                                                                                                 If the sink comes with a template for      but, as always, you should try to do a    to attaching the faucet body, sprayer,
                                                                                                                                 the cutout, use it.                        nice, neat job.                           and strainer, in particular.

                                                                                                                                   4                                          5                                         6

                                                                                                                                 Apply a bead of silicone caulk             Place the sink in the opening. Try to     For sinks with mounting clips,
                                                                                                                                 around the edges of the sink opening.      get the sink centered right away so       tighten the clips from below using a
                                                                                                                                 The sink flange most likely is not flat,   you don’t need to move it around and      screwdriver or wrench (depending on
                                                                                                                                 so apply the caulk in the area that will   disturb the caulk, which can break        the type of clip your sink has). There
                                                                                                                                 make contact with the flange.              the seal. If you are installing a heavy   should be at least three clips on every
                                                                                                                                                                            cast-iron sink, it’s best to leave the    side. Don’t overtighten the clips—this
Drop-in sinks, also known as self-rimming sinks, have a wide sink flange that extends beyond the edges of the sink cutout. 		                                               strainers off so you can grab onto the    can cause the sink flange to flatten or
They have a wide back flange to which the faucet is mounted directly.                                                                                                       sink at the drain openings.               become warped.

182 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 183

Undermount Sink                                                                                                        Amateurs & Solid-surface ▸
                                                                                                                       Solid-surface countertop material is generally installed only by certified installers. But a simple job like mounting a non-
                                                                                                                       solid-surface undermount sink can be done by a skilled amateur if you have access to adhesive and an applicator gun

U    ndermounted sinks have become quite popular in
     contemporary kitchens for reasons that are both
practical and aesthetic. On the aesthetic side, they
                                                            not. (Some new products that claim to seal countertop
                                                            substrate edges around a sink opening are emerging,
                                                            but are not yet proven or readily available). If you
                                                                                                                       (without these, you can still mount a sink using the apron sink method shown on pages 192 to 195).

look updated and sleek. Practically, they are easier to     are not able to locate solid-surface seam adhesive or
clean than rimmed sinks because you eliminate that          undermount clips, you can use the same installation
area around the rim seal where stuff always collects.       method for undermounting that is shown in the apron
     Most sink manufacturers make sinks that are            sink mounting project on pages 190 to 195 instead.
designed for undermounting, and if you don’t mind
paying the $100 to $200 premium, a true undermount
sink is the best choice. But if your decision-making is
driven more by your frugal side, you can undermount
a self-rimming (drop-in) stainless steel sink with little
                                                                Tools & Materials ▸
difficulty using readily available undermount clips.            2HP or larger plunge router    Belt sander
(Self-rimmers also come in a much wider range of                1
                                                                    ⁄2" template following 		 Solid-surface scraps
styles). Note: You can undermount any sink you wish,                 router bit                Solid-surface seam
including heavy cast-iron models, if you support the            Roundover bit                    adhesive with
sink from below instead of hanging it from clips. Not           MDF or particleboard 		          applicator gun
all countertops are suitable for undermounting a sink.               for template              Denatured alcohol
The countertop material needs to be contiguous in               Jigsaw                         Undermount clips
nature. That is, the edges that are created when you            Drill and bits                 Silicone caulk
cut through it need to be of the same material as the           Abrasive pads                  Pipe clamps
surface. Solid-surface, granite, butcher block, and             Laminate trimmer               Pad sander
concrete are good candidates for undermounting.
Post-form and any laminated or tiled countertops are
                                                                                                                     ■ How to Make a Sink Cutout Template
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     If you are undermounting a
  Before                                         After
                                                                                                                      1                                                                                              self-rimming sink, do not use the
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     sink template provided by the
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     manufacturer. Instead, make your
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     own custom router template to use
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     with a router and pattern-following
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     bit. The template should be sized
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     and shaped so the cutout you
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     make with your pattern-following
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     bit is the same shape and about
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                       ⁄8" larger than the basin opening
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     in each direction. You can plot
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     the cutout directly onto a piece of
Undermounted sinks have a sleek                                                                                                                                                                                      MDF, or make a preliminary paper
appearance and make cleanup easy, but they                                                                                                                                                                           or cardboard template and trace it
are only a good idea in countertops that have                                                                                                                                                                        onto the MDF.
a solid construction, such as solid-surfacing,
stone, quartz, or butcher block. Laminate
and tile countertops are not compatible with
undermount sinks.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                (continued)

184 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 185

  2                                                                 3
                                                                                                                                    ■ How to Undermount a Sink
                                                                                                                                      1                                                                 2

Drill a few starter holes just inside the template outline to     Connect the starter holes by cutting just inside the
create access for your jigsaw blade. If the cutout has sharp      cutout line with a jigsaw. You can use a straightedge cutting
radii at the corners, look for a bit or hole-cutter of the same   guide for straight runs if you have little confidence in your
radius and carefully drill out the corners.                       ability to cut straight.                                          Remove the countertop from the cabinet and transport it to        Use a two-fluted, 1⁄8" pattern-following bit (preferably carbide
                                                                                                                                    a work area with good light and ventilation. Set the countertop   tipped) with a 1⁄2" shank into a plunge router with a minimum
                                                                                                                                    section on sawhorses and then clamp the router template (see      motor size of 2HP. Retract the bit and position the router so the
                                                                                              Use a belt sander or pad sander       previous page) securely so the opening is centered exactly        bit is an inch or so away from the edge of the template. Turn
  4                                                                                           to smooth out the cutting lines and
                                                                                              to remove material until the cutout
                                                                                                                                    over the planned cutout area. Make sure the router bit won’t
                                                                                                                                    be cutting into your work area.
                                                                                                                                                                                                      the router on and let it develop to full velocity. Then, plunge the
                                                                                                                                                                                                      router bit into the countertop material until the bit breaks all
                                                                                              hits the lines precisely. A drum                                                                        the way through.
                                                                                              sander attachment mounted in a
                                                                                              power drill is useful for smoothing
                                                                                              out rounded corners.                                                                                                                 Pull the router bit toward the
                                                                                                                                      3                                                                                            template edge until the bit sleeve
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   contacts the edge, then slowly cut
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   through the countertop, following
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   the template. Pace is important
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   here: Cutting too fast will cause
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   chatter, cutting too slowly will
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   cause burning or melting. Cut three
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   continuous sides of the opening,
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   hugging the template edge.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             (continued)

186 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 187

  4                                                               5                                                                  7                                                                 8

After routing three sides of the opening, stop routing          If the sink outline has any chatter or the cutout is not           Clean the blocks and the underside of the solid-surface           Drill pilot holes, 1⁄4" -dia × 3⁄4" deep, for the sink clips into
and screw a support board to the waste piece. The ends of       perfectly smooth, make another pass with a straight bit before     around the cutouts with denatured alcohol. Apply solid-surface    each mounting block. The holes should be in the centers of the
the support board should extend onto the template. Position     you remove the template. Remove the template and make              seam adhesive to the blocks and bond them to the underside        mounting blocks. Tap the brass inserts for the mounting clips
the support so it is near the center, but not in the way for    a 1⁄8" roundover cut on both the top and bottom of the sink        of the countertop, set back 3⁄4" from the cutout. Install three   into the holes in the mounting blocks.
completing the fourth side of the cut. Finish the cut. The      cutout. If you know exactly where your faucet hole or holes        blocks along the long sides of the cutout and two on the front-
support board will prevent the waste from breaking off as the   need to be, cut them with a hole saw and round over their tops     to-back sides. Clamp the blocks while the adhesive sets up.
cut nears completion.                                           and bottoms as well.

                                                                                       Mount the sink on the countertop                                                                                                      Clean the sink rim and the underside
  6                                                                                    before you reinstall it on the cabinet.
                                                                                       Cut several 1 × 1" mounting blocks
                                                                                                                                     9                                                                                       of the countertop with denatured
                                                                                                                                                                                                                             alcohol. When the alcohol has dried,
                                                                                       from the solid-surface waste cutout.                                                                                                  apply a bead of 100% silicone adhesive
                                                                                       You’ll also need to purchase some                                                                                                     caulk to the sink rim. Carefully center
                                                                                       seam adhesive to glue the mounting                                                                                                    the sink over the opening and press it
                                                                                       blocks to the underside of the                                                                                                        in place. Hand-tighten the wing nuts
                                                                                       countertop. After they’re cut, break                                                                                                  onto the mounting nuts to secure the
                                                                                       all the block edges with a stationary                                                                                                 clips that hold the sink bowl. Replace
                                                                                       sander or by clamping a belt sander                                                                                                   the countertop and hook up the faucet
                                                                                       belt-side up and using it as a stationary                                                                                             and drain. For information on installing
                                                                                       sander (breaking the edges reduces                                                                                                    a kitchen faucet see pages 196 to 199.
                                                                                       the chance that the blocks will crack).

188 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 189

Apron Sink                                                                                                                                                                                        Because they are usually mounted
                                                                                                                                                                                                  underneath the countertop, apron sinks
                                                                                                                                                                                                  tend to be fairly shallow (otherwise, most

D    espite their vintage look, apron sinks are relative
     newcomers in modern kitchen design. Also known
as farmer’s sinks or farmhouse sinks, they are notable
                                                           on the high-end side, with most models costing over
                                                           $1,000. But they create a focal point that makes them
                                                           rather unique. Plus, they have a warm, comforting
                                                                                                                                                                                                  people would strain their backs doing
                                                                                                                                                                                                  dishes in them). Make sure you know
                                                                                                                                                                                                  the exact dimensions of your sink before
                                                                                                                                                                                                  ordering countertops or planning your
for having an exposed front apron that usually projects    appearance that people who own them find appealing.
                                                                                                                                                                                                  sink installation.
past the cabinets. Although they can be double-bowl
fixtures, most apron sinks are single bowl, and most
are made from fireclay (a durable enameled porcelain).
                                                                                                                                        22"
Other materials sometimes used for apron sinks
include enameled cast iron, copper, stainless steel,
                                                               Tools & Materials ▸
and composite. The model seen here, made by Kohler             Countertop material             Wood finish
(see Resources, page 282), is a fireclay sink.                 Shims                           Brush
     Apron sinks typically are not suspended from              Carpenter’s square              Framing lumber
                                                                                                                                                                           25"
above as other undermount sinks are: they’re just              Straightedge                    Sheet stock                                          8 5⁄8"
too heavy. Instead, you either attach wood ledgers to          Jigsaw                          Caulk gun
the cabinet sides to support a board that bears the            Belt sander                     Silicone adhesive
sink from below, or you build a support platform that          Pad sander                      Strainer
rests on the floor. Either way, the sink is not actually       Spindle sander                  Drain tailpiece
connected to the countertop except with caulk at the           Router or laminate trimmer      ⁄4" plywood or MDF
                                                                                               3

seams. As kitchen sinks go, apron sinks are definitely         Drill/driver                                               Sink support for apron sinks comes
                                                                                                                          from below. A typical strategy is to build
                                                                                                                          a U-shaped ledger that’s mounted to the
                                                                                     Apron sinks, also called             walls of neighboring cabinets or supported
                                                                                     farmer’s sinks or farmhouse          with a post structure from below. If you’re
                                                                                     sinks, can be nestled into a tiled   attaching the ledgers to cabinet walls, it
                                                                                     countertop (called a tile-in) or     may be necessary to reinforce them.
                                                                                     pressed up against the underside
                                                                                     of a solid countertop. Either way,
                                                                                     they can be gorgeous.

                                                                                                                                                                                                  Some apron sinks are tiled into the
                                                                                                                                                                                                  countertop. You simply hang the sink from
                                                                                                                                                                                                  ledgers on the cabinet sides that create
                                                                                                                                                                                                  the sink opening. The faucet is mounted
                                                                                                                                                                                                  to the wide back flange of the sink (make
                                                                                                                                                                                                  sure you order a sink with the correct
                                                                                                                                                                                                  number of holes for your faucet). The tile,
                                                                                                                                                                                                  with an underlayment of cementboard, is
                                                                                                                                                                                                  butted against the sink, with a small gap
                                                                                                                                                                                                  that is filled with caulk.
                                                                                                                                                                                          Caulk

                                                                                                                                                                                                       Tile

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Underlayment
                                                                                                                                                                                 Ledger
                                                                                                                                                                        Sink

                                                                                                                                                                                                  Cabinet wall

190 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 191

■ How to Install an Apron Sink in a Butcher Block Countertop
  1                                                                    2                                                                  5                                                              6

If you are undermounting the sink, outline the sink                  Mount a downstroke blade in a jigsaw (see pages 98 to              Flip the countertop and sand the cutout along the bottom       Round over the top edges of the cutout with a piloted
opening in your countertop material. Plan the opening to             101 and be sure to read the material on working with butcher       edges of the opening to prevent any splintering.               roundover bit mounted in a small router or a laminate trimmer.
create an equal reveal of approximatel 1⁄2" on all three sides       block if that is your countertop surface). Cut out the waste
(which basically means making the opening 1" smaller than the        to form the sink opening, cutting just inside the cutting lines.
overall sink dimensions). For the 22 × 25" sink seen here, the       Support the waste wood from below so it does not break
opening cut into the butcher block is 24" wide and 21" deep          out prematurely.
(1⁄2" reveal in the back plus ½" projection of the sink in front).

  3                                                                    4                                                                  7                                                              8

Sand up to the cutting lines with a belt sander after the            Sand into the corners of the cutout with a detail sander           Apply several coats of urethane varnish to the exposed         Measure and draw layout lines for a wood support
waste is removed. The goal is to create a smooth, even edge.         or, if you own one, a spindle sander (you can mount a small-       wood around the opening. This wood will have a high level of   frame to be attached to the adjoining cabinet walls. Attach
                                                                     diameter sanding drum in an electric drill, but be sure to         water exposure, so take care to get a good, even coat. Where   the frame members (2 × 4) to the cabinet sides first and then
                                                                     practice first on some scrap wood).                                possible, match the finish of the countertop (if any).         face-screw through the front frame member and into the
                                                                                                                                                                                                       ends of side members.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           (continued)

192 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 193

  9                                                                 10                                                                    12                                                            13

Cut a support platform to size from 3⁄4" plywood or               Remove the countertop section containing the sink cutout,             Apply silicone adhesive to the sink rim and then carefully    Hook up the drain plumbing and install the faucet. If
MDF, then layout and cut a drain clearance hole (if your drain    if feasible (if you can’t remove the countertop, see sidebar next     replace the countertop section before the silicone adhesive   you are drilling through the countertop material to install a
will include a garbage disposer, make the hole large enough to    page). Then, screw the platform to the frame.                         sets up. Reattach the countertop.                             faucet, make sure your installation hole or holes align with the
accommodate the disposer easily). Also cut holes for the water                                                                                                                                        preformed holes in the back flange of the sink.
supply lines if they come up through the floor and there is not
enough room between the platform and the wall for the lines
to fit.

                                                                                                        Set the sink on the
                                                                                                                                            Option for Unremovable Countertops ▸
  11                                                                                                    platform and confirm
                                                                                                        that it is level with the
                                                                                                        cabinet tops by setting                                                                                                   If you are not able to remove
                                                                                                        a straightedge so it                                                                                                      the countertop, you’ll need to
                                                                                                        spans the sink opening.                                                                                                   raise the sink up against the
                                                                                                        If necessary, shim under                                                                                                  underside of the countertop
                                                                                                        the sink to bring it to level                                                                                             once you’ve caulked the rim.
                                                                                                        (if the sink is too high                                                                                                  Create a 3-piece 2 × 4 frame
                                                                                                        you’ll need to reposition                                                                                                 and platform (as seen in Step
                                                                                                        the frame members).                                                                                                       8) but do not attach it to the
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  cabinets. Instead, support the
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  platform with braces. With help,
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  set the sink on the platform
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  and raise it from below after
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  the silicone adhesive has been
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  applied to the sink rim. When
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  the sink rim is tight against the
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  countertop, attach the frame
                                                                                                                                                                                    Temporary                                     members to the cabinet sides
                                                                                                                                                                                    braces
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  with screws.

194 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 195

Kitchen Faucets                                                                                                                  ■ How to Install a Kitchen Sink Faucet
                                                                                                                                   1                                                                    2
M     ost new kitchen faucets feature single‑handle
      control levers and washerless designs that rarely
require maintenance. Additional features include
                                                                  all the fittings needed for attaching a food disposer or
                                                                  dishwasher to the sink drain system.

brushed metallic finishes, detachable spray nozzles,
or even push-button controls.
     Connect the faucet to hot and cold water
                                                                      Tools & Materials ▸                                         Shown from
lines with easy‑to‑install flexible supply tubes                      Adjustable wrench       Scouring pad                        back of sink
made from vinyl or braided steel. If your faucet has a                Basin wrench or 		      Scouring cleaner                    cabinet for
separate sprayer, install the sprayer first. Pull the                   channel‑type pliers   Plumber’s putty                     clarity
sprayer hose through the sink opening and attach it to                Hacksaw                 Flexible vinyl or braided steel
the faucet body before installing the faucet.                         Faucet                    supply tubes
     Where local codes allow, use plastic tubes                       Putty knife             Drain components
for drain hookups. A wide selection of extensions                     Screwdriver             Penetrating oil
and angle fittings lets you easily plumb any sink                     Silicone caulk
configuration. Manufacturers offer kits that contain

                                                                                                                                 Shut off the hot and cold water at the faucet stop valves.           Set the base plate onto the sink flange so it is correctly
                                                                                                                                 Assemble the parts of the deck plate that cover the outer            aligned with the predrilled holes in the flange. From below,
                                                                                                                                 mounting holes in your sink deck (unless you are installing          tighten the wing nuts that secure the deck plate to the
                                                                                                                                 a two‑handle faucet or mounting the faucet directly to the           sink deck.
                                                                                                                                 countertop, as in an undermount sink situation). Add a ring
                                                                                                                                 of plumber’s putty in the groove on the underside of the
                                                                                                                                 base plate.

                                                                                                                                   3                                                                    4

                                                                                                                                      Pullout
                                                                                                                                      hose

                                                                                                                                                                                                      Mounting
                                                                                                                                                                                                      nut                                                  Retainer
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           screws

                                                                                                                                 Retract the pullout hose by drawing it out through the               Slip the mounting nut and washer over the free ends of
                                                                                                                                 faucet body until the fitting at the end of the hose is flush with   the supply tubes and pullout hose, then thread the nut onto
                                                                                                                                 the bottom of the threaded faucet shank. Insert the shank and        the threaded faucet shank. Hand tighten. Tighten the retainer
Modern kitchen faucets tend to be single‑handle models, often with useful features such as a pull‑out head that functions as a   the supply tubes down through the top of the deck plate.             screws with a screwdriver to secure the faucet.
sprayer. This Price Pfister™ model comes with an optional mounting plate that conceals sink holes when mounted on a predrilled
sink flange.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (continued)

196 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 197

                                                                                                                                       Variation: One‑piece Faucet with Sprayer ▸

  5                                              6                                           7                                           1                                       2                                      3
                                                                                             Water
                                                                                             supply                                                                             Friction
                                                                                             tube                                                                               washer
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Tailpiece

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Supply
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      tube

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Coupling
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      nut

                                                                                                                                                                                            Mounting
                                                                                                                                                                                            nut

                                                                                                                                       Apply a thick bead of silicone          Slip a friction washer onto each       Connect the supply tubes to
Slide the hose weight onto the                Connect the end of the pullout tube          Hook up the water supply tubes to the       caulk to the underside of the           tailpiece and then hand tighten a      the faucet tailpieces. (Make sure
pullout hose (the weight helps keep           to the outlet port on the faucet body        faucet inlets. Make sure the lines are      faucet base and then insert the         mounting nut. Tighten the mounting     the tubes you buy are long enough
the hose from tangling, and it makes it       using a quick connector fitting.             long enough to reach the supply risers      tailpieces of the faucet through the    nut with channel‑type pliers or a      to reach the stop valves and that
easier to retract).                                                                        without stretching or kinking.              appropriate holes in the sink deck.     basin wrench. Wipe up any silicone     the coupling nuts will fit the tubes
                                                                                                                                       Press down lightly on the faucet to     squeeze‑out on the sink deck with a    and tailpieces).
                                                                                                                                       set it in the caulk.                    wet rag before it sets up.

  8                                                                   9
                                                                                                                                         4                                       5                                      6
                                                                                                                                                                               Plumber
                                                                                                                                                                               putty

                                                                                                                                                                               Friction
                                                                                                                                                                               washer

                                                                                                                                                                                 Mounting
                                                                                                                                                                                 nut

                                                                                                                                                        Sprayer
                                                                                                                                                        tailpiece

                                                                                                                                       Apply a 1⁄4" bead of plumber’s putty    From beneath, slip the friction        Screw the sprayer hose onto the
                                                                                                                                       or silicone caulk to the underside      washer over the sprayer tailpiece      hose nipple on the bottom of the
                                                                                                                                       of the sprayer base. With the base      and then screw the mounting nut        faucet. Hand tighten and then give
                                                                                                                                       threaded onto the sprayer hose,         onto the tailpiece. Tighten with       the nut one-quarter turn with
                                                                                                                                       insert the tailpiece of the sprayer     channel‑type pliers or a basin         channel-type pliers or a basin
                                                                                                                                       through the opening in the sink deck.   wrench. Wipe off any excess putty or   wrench. Turn on the water supply at
                                                                                                                                                                               caulk on the sink deck from around     the shutoff, remove the aerator, and
                                                                                                                                                                               the base.                              flush debris from the faucet.
Connect the supply lines to the supply risers at the                Attach the spray head to the end of the pullout hose and
stop valves. Make sure to get the hot lines and cold lines          turn the fitting to secure the connection. Turn on the water
attached correctly.                                                 supply and test. Tip: Remove the aerator in the tip of the spray
                                                                    head and run hot and cold water to flush out any debris.

198 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 199

Kitchen Drains & Traps

K    itchen sink drains don’t last forever, but on the
     plus side, they’re very easy and inexpensive to
replace. The most common models today are made
                                                                        trap, often with a baffle in the T‑fitting where the
                                                                        outlet line joins with the tailpiece from the other bowl.
                                                                        If you are installing a disposer, consider installing
                                                                                                                                           Drain Kits ▸
of PVC plastic pipe and fittings held together with                     individual traps to eliminate the baffle, which reduces            Kits for installing a new sink drain include all the pipes,
slip fittings. In addition to making the installation                   the flow capacity by half.                                         slip fittings, and washers you’ll need to get from the
fairly forgiving, the slip fitting makes the drain                                                                                         sink tailpieces (most kits are equipped for a double bowl
easy to disassemble if you get a clog. The project                                                                                         kitchen sink) to the trap arm that enters the wall or floor.
shown here is a bit unusual by today’s standards,
because it does not include either a dishwasher drain                        Tools & Materials ▸                                           For wall trap arms, you’ll need a kit with a P‑trap. For             Chromed brass
or a garbage disposer. But you will see how to add                                                                                         floor drains, you’ll need an S-trap. Both drains normally            P-trap
                                                                             Flat screwdriver              Plumber’s putty
each of these drain systems to your kitchen sink in the                                                                                    are plumbed to share a trap. Chromed brass or PVC with
                                                                             Spud wrench                   Teflon tape
following chapters.                                                                                                                        slip fittings let you adjust the drain more easily and pull it
                                                                             Trap arm                      Washers
     You can buy the parts for the kitchen drain                                                                                           apart and then reassemble if there is a clog. Kitchen sink
                                                                             Mineral spirits               Waste-T fitting
individually (you can usually get better quality                                                                                           drains and traps should be 11⁄2" O.D. pipe—the 11⁄4" pipe
                                                                             Cloth                         S- or P-trap
materials this way) or in a kit (see photo, next page).                                                                                    is for lavatories and doesn’t have enough capacity for a
                                                                             Strainer kit
Because most kitchen sinks have two bowls, the kits                                                                                        kitchen sink.
include parts for plumbing both drains into a shared                                                                                                                                                           P-trap
                                                                                                                                                                                                               (for wall drain)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                S-trap
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                (for floor drain)

                                                                                                                                           Tips for Choosing Drains ▸
                                A

                            B

                                                                                     E

                            C

                                        F

                                                      G
                                                                                                                                           Wall thickness varies in sink                 Slip joints are formed by tightening     Use a spud wrench to tighten
                                                                                                                                           drain pipes. The thinner plastic              a male‑threaded slip nut over a          the strainer body against the
                                    D                                                                                                      material is cheaper, but it is more           female‑threaded fitting, trapping and    underside of the sink bowl. Normally,
                                                                                                                                           difficult to obtain a good seal than          compressing a beveled nylon washer       the strainer flange has a layer of
                                                                                                                                           with the thicker, more expensive              to seal the joint.                       plumber’s putty just above the sink
                                                                                                                                           tubing. The thin product is best                                                       drain and a pair of washers (one
                                                                                                                                           reserved for lavatory drains, which                                                    rubber, one fibrous) to seal below.
Kitchen sink drains include a strainer basket (A), tailpiece (B), continuous waste T (C), P- or S-trap (D), outlet drain lines (E), trap   are far less demanding.
arm (F), and wall stubout (G).

200 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 201

■ How to Hook Up a Kitchen Sink Drain
  1                                                                  2                                                                     5                      Outer
                                                                                                                                                                  drainpipe                                   6                            Outer drainpipe

                                                                                                                                                                                                                 Waste-T
                                                                                                                                          Waste-T                                                                                            Trap arm

                                                                                                                                                              Trap arm

                                                                                                                                                                                                                   P-trap

                                                                                                                                         Joint the short end of the outlet drainpipe to the tailpiece for   Attach the long leg of a P-trap to the waste‑T and attach the
If you are replacing the sink strainer body, remove the old        Apply plumber’s putty around the perimeter 			                        the other sink bowl and then attach the end of the long run to     shorter leg to the downward‑facing opening of the trap arm.
one and clean the top and bottom of the sink deck around the       of the drain opening and seat the strainer assembly into 		           the opening in the waste‑T. The outlet tube should extend into     Adjust as necessary and test all joints to make sure they are
drain opening with mineral spirits. Attach the drain tailpiece     it. Add the washers below as directed and tighten the                 the T 1⁄2" or so—make sure it does not extend in far enough to     still tight, and then test the system.
to the threaded outlet of the strainer body, inserting a non-      strainer locknut with a spud wrench (see photo, previous              block water flow from above.
beveled washer between the parts if your strainer kits include     page) or by striking the mounting nubs at the top of the body
them. Lubricate the threads or apply Teflon tape so you can get    with a flat screwdriver.
a good, snug fit.

                                                                                                                                             Variation: Drain in Floor ▸
  3          Drain tailpieces
                                                                     4
                                                                                                                                                  Waste-T
                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Waste-T
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Bottom
      Drain stubout

                                                                                                                                                                         Top of S-trap                        Top of S-trap
                                                                         Waste-T
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Outlet
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              pipe
          Trap arm
                                                                                                                                                                    Floor drain stubout

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Drain
                Escutcheon

Attach the trap arm to the male‑threaded drain stubout in          Attach a waste‑T-fitting to the drain tailpiece, orienting the
the wall, using a slip nut and a beveled compression washer.       opening in the fitting side so it will accept the outlet drain line       If your drain stubout comes up out of the floor instead        Attach the other half of the S‑trap to the stubout
The outlet for the trap arm should point downward. Note: The       from the other sink bowl. If the Waste‑T is higher than the top           of the wall, you’ll need an S‑trap to tie into it instead of   with a slip fitting. This should result in the new fitting
trap arm must be higher on the wall than any of the horizontal     of the trap arm, remove it and trim the drain tailpiece.                  a P‑trap. Attach one-half of the S‑trap to the threaded        facing downward. Join the halves of the S‑trap together
lines in the set‑up, including lines to dishwasher, disposer, or                                                                             bottom of the waste-T.                                         with a slip nut, trimming the unthreaded end if necessary.
the outlet line to the second sink bowl.

202 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 203

Hot Water Dispenser                                                                                                          ■ How to Install a Hot Water Dispenser
I t’s still easy to find a refrigerator without a cold
  water dispenser in its door, but you have to walk               Tools & Materials ▸                                          1                                                                     2
past a lot of product before you see one. This says
something about people liking convenience. In many                Power drill with 3⁄4"‑dia. bit   Switched receptacle

ways, a hot water dispenser is even more convenient               Utility knife                    Measuring tape

than a cold water dispenser. There are boxes and                  Wire stripper                    Wire connectors

boxes of beverages and food that need only a trickle              Screwdrivers                     Brass plug

of hot water to achieve their destiny: coffee, tea, hot           Adjustable wrench                Hot water dispenser kit

chocolate, instant soup, hot cereals, and just plain old          14/2 NM electrical cable         Cable connectors

hot water and lemon to name a few. And there’s no                 Flexible cable conduit           15‑amp circuit breaker

faster way to get this hot water than with a hot water            Duplex electrical box            Tubing cutter

dispenser. These units are designed to fit in the spare           Conduit box connector
                                                                                                                                                                                                    14/2 Cable from
hole on many kitchen sink decks. But, if the sink                                                                                                                                                   service panel
doesn’t have this hole, you can replace the spray hose
with the dispenser. Or, if you want to keep the hose,
just drill an extra hole in your sink or countertop to
accommodate the dispenser faucet.
      Note: Installing this appliance requires both
plumbing and wiring work. If you are unsure of your
skills in these areas, hire a professional. (Be sure to                                                                      Drill an access hole for a new power cable (in flexible               Fish a 14/2 or 12/2 cable from the electric service panel up
check your local codes before starting.)                                                                                     conduit) in the bottom of the sink compartment cabinet. Use a         through the hole in the floor. Strip the sheathing from the cable
                                                                                                                             drill and a 3⁄4"‑dia. bit. Go into the basement and drill a hole up   with a utility knife. Also strip the insulation from the wires with
                                                                                                                             through the flooring that will align with the first hole or make      a wire stripper. Do not nick the wire insulation.

    Switch Receptacle ▸                                                                                                      other arrangements to run circuit wire.

                            Grounding screw terminal
     Connecting
     tab
                                Silver screw terminal
                                                                                                                               3                                                                     4

                                                 Neutral
                                                 wires

     Feed wire           Wire to
                         light
             Brass screw fixture
             terminal         Grounding wires

    Three wires are connected to the switch/receptacle.
    One hot wire is the feed wire that brings power into
    the box. It is connected to the side of the switch that
    has a connecting tab. The other hot wire carries power
    out. It is connected to the brass screw terminal on the
    side that does not have a connecting tab. The white,                                                                     Slide a piece of flexible conduit over the wires, so the              Install a switched receptacle. Mount a duplex metal box
    neutral wire is pigtailed to the silver screw terminal.                                                                  wires are protected from the point where they leave the               on the cabinet wall. Connect the black power wire to the brass
    The grounding wires must be pigtailed to the switch/                                                                     cabinet floor to where they enter the electrical box. Attach the      screw on the switch. Attach the white neutral wire to the
    receptacle green grounding screw and to the grounded                                                                     conduit to the box with a box connector so at least 8" of wire        silver screw on the receptacle. Attach the ground wire to the
                                                                                                                             reaches into the box.                                                 receptacle ground terminal.
    metal box.                                                On-demand hot water is not only convenient, it can help to
                                                              conserve both energy and water.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           (continued)

204 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 205

  5                                              6                                             7                                          10                                          11                                           12

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note: Hire an
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      electrician if
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       you are not
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      experienced
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      with wiring.

Tie into the water supply. Water              Determine the best place for the               To replace a spray hose with the           Attach the two copper water tubes           Slide the end of the plastic                 Install the heater power supply
for the dispenser comes from the cold         dispenser heater, usually on the back          dispenser faucet, remove the nut that      to the heater with compression fittings.    vent tube onto the nipple on top of          cable in the service panel. Begin by
water supply line under the kitchen           cabinet wall, so its pigtail plug will reach   holds the sprayer to the sink. Then        Tighten them with a wrench. On the          the tank and attach it according to the      turning off the main power breaker.
sink. Mount a tee on this pipe, below its     the switched receptacle. Screw its             remove the end of the hose from its        model seen here, the heater unit has        manufacturer’s instructions. On some         Then, remove the outside door panel
shutoff valve, by alternately tightening      mounting bracket to the wall and hang          port on the bottom of the faucet using     three tubes. One supplies cold water        models a spring clip is used for this job;   and remove one of the knockout plates
the tee bolts on both sides with              the heater on this bracket.                    an adjustable wrench. This will free the   to the heater, one supplies hot water       other models require a hose clamp.           from the top or side of the box. Install
a wrench.                                                                                    hose so it can be pulled out from above    to the faucet, and a third clear plastic                                                 a cable clamp inside this hole, push the
                                                                                             the sink. Plug the spray hose part on      hose acts as a vent and is attached to an                                                cable through the clamp, and tighten the
                                                                                             the faucet.                                expansion tank within the heater.                                                        clamp to secure the cable.

  8                                                                      9                                                                13                                          14                                           15

                                                                                                                                        Strip the sheathing from the cable          Loosen the lug screw on a standard           Once a new breaker is installed,
                                                                                                                                        inside the panel and remove the             15‑amp breaker and put the end of the        the service panel cover has to be
                                                                                                                                        insulation from the ends on the black       black (hot) cable wire under this lug.       modified to fit over it. Break out the
Squeeze the supply tubes of the dispenser faucet together             Join the faucet to the sink supply tee with a piece of            and white cable wires. Loosen a lug         Tighten the lug with a screwdriver. Then     protective plate that covers the breaker
so they can fit into the hole, and drop it in place. The unit is      flexible tubing. Measure this piece, make the cut with a tubing   screw on the neutral bus bar and push       install the breaker in the hot bus bar by    position with pliers. Screw the cover
held securely by a washer and locking screw that is tightened         cutter, and install compression nuts and ferrules on both ends.                                                                                            to the panel, and turn on the main
                                                                                                                                        the white wire under the lug. Attach the    pushing it into place.
from below the sink.                                                  Slide one end of the tubing into the valve and tighten the nut                                                                                             breaker. Turn on the water supply
                                                                                                                                        ground wire to the grounding bus bar.                                                    to the dispenser and plug it into the
                                                                      with a wrench.                                                    Tighten both these screws securely.                                                      receptacle. Turn on the receptacle
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 switch, wait fifteen minutes, and check
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 that the system is working properly.

206 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 207

Pot Filler                                                                                                                      ■ How to Install a Pot Filler
                                                                                                                                  1                                               2                                          3
K   itchen design trends are moving ever closer to
    replicating commercial kitchens in the home. One
example of this trend is the pot filler. A long‑neck
faucet that mounts on the wall behind the cooktop,
a pot filler allows you to dispense water directly into
large pots on the cooktop. This saves lugging pots of
water from the sink to the stove.
     Although horizontally mounted models are
available, most pot fillers are attached to the wall.
Almost all are designed for cold water only. Some
have two valves, one at the wall and another at the
end of the spout. Other models can be turned on with
a foot pedal for safe, hands‑free use. A pot filler will
require code‑approved supply pipe 1⁄2" in most cases)
connected with a permanent union at another supply
line or the main. The best time to run a new supply                                                                             Shut off the water supply and                   Plan the route for the new supply line     Drill 3⁄4" holes in the framing for the
is during a remodel. But retrofitting a new supply                                                                              locate the cold-water supply riser at the       beginning at the T‑fitting and working     supply tubes. Install protector plates
line and mounting a pot filler is not too difficult as a                                                                        kitchen sink. Cut into the riser and install    toward the cooktop area. Determine         if the holes are within 11⁄4" of the stud
standalone project. Using PEX supply pipe will make                                                                             a T‑fitting, or replace the existing shutoff    the height of the new line and then        edge. Run 1⁄2" PEX from the supply
                                                               A pot filler is a cold-water tap that you install above your     valve on the riser with a multiple‑outlet       snap chalklines from the sink to the       riser through the holes to the pot filler
running the new supply line in finished walls easier.          cooktop so you can add water to large stock pots without         shutoff valve, with an outlet for the 1⁄2"      cooktop. With the electrical power shut    location (inset).
                                                               having to carry a full pot of water around the kitchen.          supply pipe for the pot filler.                 off, remove wall coverings 2" above and
                                                                                                                                                                                below the chalkline and at the location
                                                                                                                                                                                for the pot filler outlet. Make sure the
                                                                                                                                                                                location is high enough to clear your
    Tools & Materials ▸                                                                                                                                                         tallest stock pot.

    Hack saw                    Pot filler                     Reciprocating saw               Wallboard
    PEX tools                   Protector plates               Wallboard tools                 patching materials
    PEX pipe                    PEX fittings                   Pipe joint compound                                                4                                               5                                          6             Inlet

                                                                                   Plan the route for the new supply line. In
                                                                                                                                                                                                                             Flange
                                                                                   most cases, you will enter the stud cavity
                                                                                   of the wall and run a new line directly
                                                                                   upward, past the backsplash height of
                                                           A                       the countertop (A). If the countertop
                                                                                   backsplash is removable, avoid wallboard
                                                                                   patching by installing the tubing behind
                                                   B
                                                                                   the backsplash (B). You may also be able
                                                                                   to run the supply line underneath the
                                                                                   kitchen if there is an unfinished
                                                                                   basement (C).

                                                                                                                                Attach the new PEX supply line to               At the cooktop, install the faucet         Cut and install the wallboard patch.
                                                                                                                                the T‑fitting at the supply riser, installing   union as specified by the manufacturer.    Fit the flange over the inlet. Apply pipe
                                                                                                                                an accessible shutoff valve on the              Add blocking as needed. The pot filler     joint compound to the threads of the
                                                                                                                                new line.                                       installed here attaches to a drop‑ear      faucet body. Assemble and adjust the
                     C                                                                                                                                                          L‑fitting mounted to the blocking. Apply   faucet according to the manufacturer’s
                                                                                                                                                                                pipe joint compound to the faucet inlet    instructions. Test the faucet before
                                                                                                                                                                                and thread it onto the L‑fitting.          refinishing the wallboard.

208 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 209

Carbon Water Filter                                                                                                                        ■ How to Install an Under‑Counter Filter System
                                                                                                                                             1                                                                  2
C    arbon‑activated water filters are the most popular
     systems for home drinking water because they
are inexpensive, easy to install, and they effectively
                                                                           A separate, countertop‑mounted spout delivers
                                                                      the filtered water. When shopping for a filter system,
                                                                      compare ratings for contaminant reduction as well
improve the taste and odor of most municipal tap                      as flow rate and filter service life. Under‑counter
water. Most systems remove common contaminants,                       units typically offer the greatest service life per
such as chlorine, lead, cysts, and particulates. Filters              filter cartridge, followed by countertop models.
are readily available from home centers, hardware                     Faucet‑mounted filters typically offer considerably
stores, and online through many manufacturers.                        shorter service life before requiring a new cartridge.
     There are three main types of carbon filters:                    When comparing prices, be sure to calculate the
faucet‑mounted, countertop, and under‑counter.                        long‑term costs for cartridge replacement.
Faucet‑mounted install directly to the kitchen faucet
and have a simple diverter switch to provide filtered
water directly from the tap. These are the easiest to
use of the three systems, and they take up no counter                      Tools & Materials ▸
or cabinet space. Countertop models also feed from
the faucet spout but have a separate filter unit that                      Adjustable wrench                Screwdrivers
sits on your countertop. Diverted water flows through                      Channel‑type pliers              Teflon tape                    Shut off the cold water supply to the kitchen faucet at            Secure the mounting bracket to the filter unit, then mount
the filter and out through a spout on the filter unit.                     Drill and bits                   Plumber putty                  the fixture shutoff valve or the main house valve; drain the       the unit at a convenient location under the sink, following the
                                                                                                                                           faucet. Remove the supply tubing from the faucet stud using a      manufacturer’s directions. Be sure to leave plenty of room for
Under‑counter filters install under the sink and                           Tubing cutter or utility knife   Filter system
                                                                                                                                           wrench. Wrap the stud with Teflon tape, then thread the filter’s   removing the filter housing for filter replacement.
connect directly to the cold water supply piping.                                                                                          water supply fitting onto the stud and tighten carefully. Apply
                                                                                                                                           the tape and connect the supply tubing to the fitting.

                                                                                                                                             3                                                                  4

Faucet‑mounted filters are the easiest to install. Remove             Countertop water filters also are easy to install. First,
                                                                                                                                           Remove the sprayer from the sink, if necessary, or cut a           Cut lengths of tubing to run between the water supply,
the faucet aerator, then thread the filter unit onto the spout        remove the faucet aerator. Then, thread the filter’s diverter
                                                                                                                                           new hole through the countertop, following the countertop          filter unit, and spout, making sure the cuts are square and
and hand‑tighten. Slowly turn on the cold water tap, then             valve onto the spout using the appropriate adapter and
                                                                                                                                           manufacturer’s recommendations (some materials require a           the tubing ends are free of scratches, kinks, and rough spots.
check for leaking. If necessary, carefully tighten the collar using   gaskets. Place the filter unit and supply tubing in a convenient
                                                                                                                                           professional fabricator). Assemble the filter spout as directed,   Connect the tubing at the push‑in (or other) fittings. Test and
pliers. Flush the filter before use as recommended.                   location. Test the system and check for leaks, carefully
                                                                                                                                           and then mount the spout into the sink hole, using plumber         flush the system as directed.
                                                                      tightening the diverter with pliers if necessary. Flush the filter
                                                                                                                                           putty as a sealant.
                                                                      as recommended.

210 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 211

Reverse-Osmosis Filtration System                                                                                                  Point-of-use Filters ▸
                                                                                                                                   Point-of-use water filtration systems typically are installed in the sink base cabinet, with a separate faucet from the main

N     ot all water is created equal. Some water tastes
      better than other water. Some water looks better
than other water. And some has more impurities, too.
                                                                    removed with a reverse-osmosis (RO) system like the
                                                                    one shown here.
                                                                         These filters are designed to treat cooking and
                                                                                                                                   kitchen faucet. The setup shown here has an extra filter to supply a nearby refrigerator icemaker.

Because no one wants to drink bad water, the bottled                drinking water. The system holds the treated water in
water business has exploded over the past twenty                    a storage tank and delivers it to a sink‑mounted faucet
years. Home filtration systems have also grown by                   on demand. RO units feature multiple filter cartridges:
leaps and bounds, in part because there are so many                 in this case a pre-filter unit, followed by the RO                                                                  Drinking water faucet
different types of filters available.                               membrane, followed by a carbon post-filter.
     For example, sediment filters will remove rust,
sand, and suspended minerals, like iron. A carbon
filter can remove residual chlorine odors, some
pesticides, and even radon gas. Distillation filters
                                                                         Tools & Materials ▸
can remove bacteria and organic compounds, while a
                                                                         Plastic gloves               Teflon tape
traditional water softener can neutralize hard water.
                                                                         Screwdrivers                 Saddle valve
Many of the most toxic impurities, heavy metals
                                                                         Electric drill               Rubber drain saddle
like mercury, lead, cadmium, and arsenic, are best
                                                                         Adjustable wrench

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        T-coupling

                                                                                                                                                                                       Filtration unit

                                                                                                                                                                                                             Additional filter            Refrigerator
                                                                                                                                                                                                             for refrigerator             icemaker line
                                                                                                                                                                                                             icemaker

Reverse-osmosis filters can be highly effective for removing specific contaminants from drinking water. Because the filtration
process wastes a lot of fresh water, it’s a good idea to have your water professionally tested before investing in an RO system.

212 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 213

■ How to Install a Reverse-osmosis Water Filter
  1                                                                    2                                                                  5                                                                    6

                                                                                                                                        Connect the filter to the tank with plastic tubing. In most          Use a push-type compression fitting on the end of the
Remove the cartridge from the bag and install it in the filter       Establish the best location for the filter inside your kitchen     units, the joint between the two is made with a compression          tubing to connect the water storage tank and the faucet. To
unit (be sure to wear plastic gloves). The RO membrane filter is     sink cabinet, following manufacturer’s instructions. Then drive    fitting. On this filter, the fitting is a push-type collar. Simply   install it, push the end of the fitting over the bottom of the
shipped in a separate bag that is filled with antibacterial fluid.   mounting screws in the cabinet wall to support the unit.           insert the hose into the collar until it will not go any farther.    faucet shank until the fitting bottoms out.
Make sure to touch only the ends of the cartridge when you
handle it or you can damage the membrane.

                                                                                                                                          7                                                                    8
  3                                                                    4

                                                                                                                                        Attach a plastic space (if provided) and jamb nut to the             Remove the cover from an unused sink hole or remove the
                                                                                                                                        shank of the faucet. After the nut is finger tight, snug it          spray hose or bore a mounting hole in the sink or into the
Assemble the filtration system and then hang it on the               Wrap the threads of the valve a couple of times with Teflon        securely with an adjustable wrench. This unit came with              countertop. Once you have prepared a suitable hole for the
cabinet wall. The best system layout may be to locate the filter     tape and screw it into the tank. Finger-tighten it, then turn it   a C‑shaped collar and jamb nut, but a round collar would             faucet stem, insert it from above.
on one wall and the storage tank on the opposite wall.               one more turn with an adjustable wrench.                           need to have hoses threaded through it prior to mounting
                                                                                                                                        the faucet.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    (continued)

214 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 215

                                                                                                                                         Installing a Whole-House Water Filtration System ▸
                                                                                                                                         A whole-house water filtration system is installed along
  9                                                                     10                                                               the supply pipe carrying water to the house, located
                                                                                                                                         after the water meter, but before any other appliances
                                                                                                                                         in the pipeline. A whole-house system reduces the same
                                                                                                                                         elements as an under-sink system and can also help reduce
                                                                                                                                         the iron flowing into the water softener, prolonging its life.

                                                                                                                                         Always follow the manufacturer’s directions for your
                                                                                                                                         particular unit. If your electrical system is grounded through
                                                                                                                                         the water pipes, make sure to install ground clamps on
                                                                                                                                         both sides of the filtration unit with a connecting jumper
                                                                                                                                         wire. Globe valves should be installed within 6” of the intake
                                                                                                                                         and the outtake sides of the filter.

                                                                                                                                         Filters must be replaced every few months, depending on
                                                                                                                                         the manufacturer. The filtration unit cover unscrews for
                                                                                                                                         filter access.                                                   Shut off the main water supply and turn on
                                                                                                                                                                                                          the faucets to the drainpipes. Position the unit after
                                                                                                                                                                                                          the water meter, but before any other appliances
                                                                                                                                                                                                          in the supply pipe. Measure and mark the pipe to
                                                                                                                                                                                                          accommodate the filtration unit. Cut the pipe at the
Replace the shutoff valve at the supply riser with a new              Attach the filter supply tube to the port on the shutoff valve                                                                      marks with a pipe cutter. Join the water meter side of
                                                                                                                                                 A                                                        the pipe with the intake side of the unit and house the
valve containing an additional outlet for tubing. The water           with a compression fitting. Push the end of the tubing onto the
supply to the filter comes from the cold-water supply line that       valve, then push the ferrule against the valve and thread the                                                                       supply side of the pipe with the outtake side of the unit.
services the kitchen sink faucet.                                     compression nut into place. Finger-tighten it, then turn it one                                                                     Tighten with a wrench.
                                                                      more full turn with a wrench.
                                                                                                                                          B
                                                                                                                                                                                          C

  11                                                                    12

                                                                                                                                                                                 D

                                                                                                                                                                                     E
                                                                                                                                                                                                          Install a filter and screw the filtration unit cover to the
                                                                                                                                                                                                          bottom of the filtration unit. Attach a jumper wire to the
                                                                                                                                         A whole-house water filtration system: (A) intake                pipes on the other side of the unit, using pipe clamps.
                                                                                                                                         side, (B) supply pipe from the water meter pipe,                 Open the main water supply lines to restore the water
                                                                                                                                         (C) outtake side to the house supply pipe, (D) filter, and       supply. Allow faucets to run for a few minutes, as you
The filter must also be tied into the drain system. The best          Attach the tubing from the drain to the auxiliary port on the      (E) filtration unit cover.                                       check to make sure that the system is working properly.
way to do this is to replace the drain tailpiece with a new fitting   tailpiece. Finish up by turning on the water and checking the
that contains an auxiliary port.                                      system for leaks. Be sure to filter and drain at least two tanks
                                                                      of water to clean any contaminants from the system before
                                                                      drinking the water.

216 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Fixtures & Appliances ■ 217

Flooring Y our kitchen floor is more than just a surface—it also helps to create the room’s style by adding color, texture, and personality. You can use flooring to complement your countertops and cabinets or create a point of contrast. Using different types of flooring can help define task and traffic areas, giving a large kitchen floor a bit more style. Flooring choices can help the kitchen flow into other rooms or create more visible boundaries. Almost any material can and has been used as kitchen flooring, and with new processes of factory lamination, many inexpensive and easy-to-install options are available. The only floor covering that is truly not suited to kitchen use is carpeting. Non- slip area rugs, however, are a good way to add color, texture, and help break up a large expanse of one material. Different flooring options have different merits, especially in the kitchen. It pays to think carefully about what you want, because the cost and labor involved in flooring projects mean you won’t soon want to change it.

In This Chapter • Flooring Selection • Sheet Vinyl • Resilient Tile • Laminate Flooring

                                                       ■ 219

Flooring Selection                                                                                                          ■ Sheet Vinyl
                                                                                                                            Sheet vinyl creates a versatile, flexible surface. Sheets
                                                                                                                            come in 6 ft. and 12 ft. wide rolls, with either a felt
T   he floor is the largest surface in a kitchen and
    therefore has great potential for setting the
kitchen’s tone. Options for kitchen flooring have
                                                            can lead to fatigue if you are standing and cooking
                                                            for long periods. The hardness also is completely
                                                            unforgiving if you drop a piece of glassware, and
                                                                                                                            or a polyvinyl chloride (PVC) backing, depending
                                                                                                                            on the type of installation. Installation is easy. Sheet
                                                                                                                            vinyl with felt backing is glued to the floor using the
expanded immensely in the past few years. Many of           the tile itself is likely to fracture if you drop a heavy       full-spread method, meaning the entire project area is
these options are perfect for do-it-yourselfers looking     pot or pan.                                                     covered with adhesive. More rigid PVC-backed sheet
to give their kitchen a stylish facelift. Or perhaps             If you are willing to overlook some environmental          vinyl needs to be glued only along the edges (called
your kitchen has a resilient sheet floor that is in good    considerations, vinyl flooring products are well                the perimeter-bond method). And newer, extra-thick
shape but has a dated pattern or colors. A new floating     suited for kitchens. Sheet vinyl is impervious, easy to         “no-glue” vinyl will lie flat and hold its position with
floor can be installed over existing resilient flooring     clean, and available in a greatly expanded assortment           little or no glue and no fasteners.
in a weekend––or even just a matter of hours in a           of styles and colors, many of which mimic other                       Sheet vinyl is priced per square yard and
smaller kitchen.                                            flooring types. It is also very comfortable underfoot.          is considered one of the most inexpensive floor
     Not all types of flooring are suitable for kitchens.   Resilient vinyl tile has similar good points. Newer             coverings. Most building centers carry a limited
Carpeting is perhaps the worst choice, since it traps       laminate floors are good choices as well. Boasting the          selection, but if you shop at a flooring store you’ll find
odors and moisture and presents cleaning nightmares.        look of wood (and, increasingly, other flooring types),         virtually unlimited colors and patterns, many of which
Solid wood floors are a better choice than carpeting,       laminate flooring products have a very hard wear layer          do a very good job of emulating other floor types, such
but they are fairly susceptible to damage from sources      that holds up well to abuse but without the hardness            as parquet and ceramic tile or even natural stone.
you are likely to encounter in the kitchen, including       of concrete. Following a more in-depth examination              Largely because the manufacturing process for vinyl
dropped pans or knives and spilled liquids or steam.        of kitchen flooring options, you’ll find three how-to           produces toxins and pollutants, resilient sheet flooring
Ceramic tile floors are popular in kitchens, but suffer     sequences that show you exactly how our preferred               and tile are not high on the list of green floor covering    Resilient sheet vinyl has long been a kitchen standard.
from a few notable drawbacks. The grout lines tend to       kitchen floor coverings (vinyl, vinyl tile, and laminate)       products. Their relatively light weight, however, means
                                                                                                                                                                                         It is available in hundreds of colors and patterns at flooring
present cleaning problems, the hardness of the surface      are installed.                                                                                                               distributors and design centers.
                                                                                                                            they can be transported with some efficiency.

                                                                                         Kitchen floors should be
                                                                                         water and moisture resistant
                                                                                                                            ■ Resilient Tile
                                                                                                                            Resilient floor tile is made of vinyl. Some types have
                                                                                         and very easy to clean. If given
                                                                                         a choice, some homeowners
                                                                                                                            a homogenous structure and are rigid (these resemble
                                                                                         prefer a floor that conceals       linoleum when laid) and others are of multilayered
                                                                                         spills. This cork floor, when      construction with a photographic pattern layer covered
                                                                                         treated with a durable water       by a clear wear layer. Tiles typically come in 12"
                                                                                         resistant finish, has the added    squares and are available with or without self-adhesive
                                                                                         advantages of an on-trend
                                                                                                                            backing. The self-adhesive versions are usually thin,
                                                                                         appearance and a soft
                                                                                         feel underfoot.                    lower in quality, and tend to become unstuck fairly
                                                                                                                            easily.
                                                                                                                                 Resilient tiles are easy to install, but because tile
                                                                                                                            floors have a lot of seams, they’re less suitable for
                                                                                                                            high-moisture areas than sheet vinyl. They also require
                                                                                                                            a very smooth layer of underlayment. The rigid,
                                                                                                                            homogeneous vinyl tile normally does not have a hard
                                                                                                                            wear layer, so it is susceptible to scratching and should
                                                                                                                            be treated regularly with floor wax or other protective
                                                                                                                            coatings. Multilayer vinyl tile is designed as a no-wax
                                                                                                                            floor covering product.

                                                                                                                                                                                         Resilient vinyl tiles are laid in much the same way
                                                                                                                                                                                         as ceramic tiles, but they create a surface that is
                                                                                                                                                                                         more comfortable.

220 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Flooring ■ 221

                                                                                                                                                                                          softer than natural-color products. It’s also important
■   Laminate Flooring                                                                                                    ■   Bamboo                                                       to buy from a reputable, experienced manufacturer to
                                                                                                                                                                                          ensure high performance standards and (hopefully)
Strip flooring made from laminated materials                                                                             As a popular wood alternative that’s far too nice to be
has taken over a big portion of the residential                                                                          considered “the next best thing to wood,” bamboo is              ethical and sustainable practices in harvesting and
floor coverings market, especially among DIYers.                                                                         steadily making its way into the mainstream flooring             producing the materials.
Laminate flooring offers many of the visual benefits                                                                     market. Because it can be harvested every three to
of hardwood, with better quality products doing a
convincing job of replicating the warmth and even
                                                                                                                         five years (and without killing the plant, as an added
                                                                                                                         bonus), bamboo is classified as a “rapidly renewable
                                                                                                                                                                                          ■ Cork
the texture of real wood. Although some laminate                                                                         resource.” Hardwood trees, by contrast, can take                 Cork is a natural material that boasts a cook-friendly
flooring is designed to be set into mastic, the majority                                                                 twenty-five years or more to reach maturity prior to             “give” underfoot and an uncommon advantage over
of the products sold today are floating floors, often                                                                    harvesting.                                                      other kitchen floors: it’s quiet. Due to its porous
with profiled tongue-and-grooved edges that click                                                                             Bamboo flooring is available in solid-strip                 structure, cork has remarkable sound-deadening
together to form a mechanical joint. When assembled,                                                                     and engineered versions. The latter has a similar                properties, which can be a welcome feature in a
the planks form a solid mass that “floats” on a layer of                                                                 construction to engineered wood flooring and can                 room full of hard, sound-reflecting surfaces. As a raw
cushioned underlayment. This makes laminate very                                                                         be installed with floating or glue-down methods.                 material, cork is the dead bark stripped from dead oak
easy to install, and its growing popularity has done                                                                     Solid bamboo products install much like traditional              trees (harvesting doesn’t damage the tree), but most
away with earlier limitations on colors and patterns.                                                                    hardwood––they’re typically nailed or glued to the               cork flooring is made with material recycled from cork
                                                                                                                         subfloor––and are sold prefinished or can be sanded              stopper manufacturing.
                                                                                                                                                                                               Cork flooring materials come in glue-down tiles
■ Hardwood Floors                                                                                                        and finished on-site just like hardwood.
                                                                                                                              When shopping for bamboo flooring, compare
                                                                                                                         products and varieties for their sustainability in
                                                                                                                                                                                          and glue-down or snap-together planks and may
                                                                                                                                                                                          include a wood, layered cork, or PVC backing.
Hardwood strip flooring is a very traditional floor
covering with many benefits. It is durable, beautiful,      Laminate flooring comes in narrow panels or strips that      kitchens. Vertical-grain (edge grain) bamboo typically
comfortable to walk and work on, and it can be              have click-together tongue-and-grooved edges and ends.       stands up better to moisture than horizontal grain (flat
resurfaced and refinished several times over its useful                                                                  grain), while carbonized bamboo (which has been
life. It is also somewhat susceptible to water damage                                                                    steamed to produce darker coloring) may be somewhat
and to dents, gouges, and other forms of damage
that can happen easily in kitchens. It is a relatively
expensive floor covering. While planks are the most
common type of solid wood flooring, parquet tiles
created by assembling narrow wood strips into tiles
are readily available. Oak and maple are the most
common hardwood flooring species available. Fir
and pine flooring is not hard to find, but it is too soft
for the rigors of a kitchen environment. Typically,
wood flooring has tongue-and-grooved edges and is
installed by direct nailing to a plywood subfloor. An
underlayment of rosin paper is recommended. It can
also be glued down.

                                                            Solid hardwood flooring is perfectly acceptable for most     A kitchen floor made of grass. Bamboo (a woody grass) is a       Cork lends a rich, natural character to kitchen floors and helps
                                                            kitchen installations. Its natural wood tones can never be   popular and widely available alternative to hardwood flooring.   to keep noise levels down.
                                                            perfectly duplicated by other flooring types.

222 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Flooring ■ 223

Sheet Vinyl                                                                                              ■ How to Make a Cutting Template
                                                                                                           1                                          2                                      3
P   reparing a perfect underlayment is the most
    important phase of resilient sheet vinyl
installation. Cutting the material to fit the contours
                                                         Tools & Materials ▸
of the room is a close second. The best way to ensure    Linoleum knife         Heat gun

accurate cuts is to make a cutting template. Some        Framing square         ⁄16" V-notched trowel
                                                                                1

manufacturers offer template kits, or you can make       Compass                Straightedge

one by following the instructions on page 225. Be sure   Scissors               Vinyl flooring

to use the recommended adhesive for the sheet vinyl      Non-permanent 		       Masking tape

you are installing. Many manufacturers require that          felt‑tipped pen    Heavy butcher or brown

you use their glue for installation. Use extreme care    Utility knife              wrapping paper

when handling the sheet vinyl, especially felt-backed    Straightedge           Duct tape

products, to avoid creasing and tearing.                 ⁄4" V-notched trowel
                                                         1
                                                                                Flooring adhesive
                                                         J-roller               ⁄8" staples
                                                                                3

                                                         Stapler                Metal threshold bars
                                                         Flooring roller        Nails
                                                         Chalkline

                                                                                                         Place sheets of heavy butcher              Follow the outline of the room,        To fit the template around
                                                                                                         paper or brown wrapping paper              working with one sheet of paper at a   pipes, tape sheets of paper on either
                                                                                                         along the walls, leaving a 1⁄8" gap. Cut   time. Overlap the edges of adjoining   side. Measure the distance from the
                                                                                                         triangular holes in the paper with a       sheets by about 2" and tape the        wall to the center of the pipe, then
                                                                                                         utility knife. Fasten the template to      sheets together.                       subtract 1⁄8".
                                                                                                         the floor by placing masking tape
                                                                                                         over the holes.

                                                                                                           4                                          5                                      6

                                                                                                         Transfer the measurement                   Fit the hole cutout around the         When completed, roll or loosely
                                                                                                         to a separate piece of paper. Use          pipe. Tape the hole template to the    fold the paper template for carrying.
                                                                                                         a compass to draw the pipe diameter        adjoining sheets.
                                                                                                         on the paper, then cut out the hole
                                                                                                         with scissors or a utility knife. Cut a
                                                                                                         slit from the edge of the paper to
                                                                                                         the hole.

224 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Flooring ■ 225

■ How to Install Perimeter-bond Sheet Vinyl
  1                                        2                                         3                                            7                                           8                                             9

Unroll the flooring on any large,        For two-piece installations,              Make a paper template (see page              Cut the seams for two-piece                 Remove both pieces of scrap                   Fold back the edges of both sheets.
flat, clean surface. To prevent          overlap the edges of the sheets by at     225) and position it. Trace the outline of   installations using a straightedge as       flooring. The pattern should now run          Apply a 3" band of multipurpose flooring
wrinkles, sheet vinyl comes from the     least 2". Plan to have the seams fall     the template onto the flooring using a       a guide. Hold the straightedge tightly      continuously across the adjoining             adhesive to the underlayment or old
manufacturer rolled with the pattern-    along the pattern lines or simulated      non-permanent felt-tipped pen.               against the flooring, and cut along the     sheets of flooring.                           flooring, using a 1⁄4" V-notched trowel or
side out. Unroll the sheet and turn it   grout joints. Align the sheets so the                                                  pattern lines through both pieces of                                                      wallboard knife.
pattern-side up for marking.             pattern matches, then tape the sheets                                                  vinyl flooring.
                                         together with duct tape.

                                                                                                                                  10                                          11                                            12
  4                                        5                                         6

                                                                                                                                Lay the seam edges one at a time            Apply flooring adhesive underneath            If you’re applying flooring over a
Remove the template. Cut the sheet       Cut holes for pipes and other             Roll up the flooring loosely and             onto the adhesive. Make sure the seam       flooring cuts at pipes or posts and           wood underlayment, fasten the outer
vinyl with a sharp linoleum knife or     permanent obstructions. Cut a slit from   transfer it to the installation area. Do     is tight, pressing the gaps together with   around the entire perimeter of the room.      edges of the sheet with 3⁄8" staples
a utility knife with a new blade. Use    each hole to the nearest edge of the      not fold the flooring. Unroll and position   your fingers, if needed. Roll the seam      Roll the flooring with the roller to ensure   driven every 3". Make sure the staples
a straightedge as a guide for making     flooring. Whenever possible, make slits   the sheet vinyl carefully. Slide the edges   edges with a J-roller or wallpaper          good contact with the adhesive.               will be covered by the base molding.
longer cuts.                             along pattern lines.                      beneath undercut door casings.               seam roller.

226 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Flooring ■ 227

                                                          Do not use carpet tape for this product, as it will
                                                                                                                        Installation Notes for No-glue Vinyl Flooring ▸
■Variation: No-glue 		                                    cause discoloration. Use standard threshold transition
Sheet Vinyl                                               moldings where the sheet vinyl meets other
                                                          floor surfaces.
The latest in the sheet-vinyl world is a “loose-lay”
(no-glue) product. It has a fiberglass backing, which
makes it cushier than standard felt-backed vinyl.
The fiberglass backing also makes this sheet product
thicker and more dimensionally stable. Consequently,
it only needs to be glued at seams or under heavy
appliances. Also, rather than using glue, you use
acrylic double-sided adhesive tape.
     No-glue sheet vinyl is installed in much the
same way as other resilient sheet goods. Cutting
the material to size is the most difficult part of the
project. Fortunately, the major manufacturers have kits
available to help you do it right.
     This loose-lay sheet vinyl can be installed over
                                                                                                                        Leave gaps. To allow for the normal movement and               Place acrylic double-face tape in areas that will be
many surfaces, including a single layer of sheet vinyl
                                                                                                                        expansion of the floor and wall surfaces, the flooring must    under heavy appliances such as stoves and refrigerators.
or vinyl tile, underlayment-grade plywood, concrete,                                                                                                                                   Make an X with three pieces of tape—one long piece
                                                                                                                        be cut 3⁄16" to 1⁄4" away from all vertical surfaces such as
or ceramic tile. Do not install over particleboard,                                                                     walls, cabinets, or pipes. Use a jamb saw to undercut door     and two short pieces—so that the tape does not overlap.
cushioned vinyl flooring, carpet, strip wood, or plank                                                                  trim—this will allow for expansion. Make sure vinyl is not     Place acrylic double-face tape at doorways and under
                                                          Supplies for installing no-glue sheet vinyl include a
flooring. Use embossing leveler to fill textured vinyl    floor leveler and patching compound for preparing
                                                                                                                        contacting the wall surface behind the door trim. Check        seam lines. Leave the paper covering in place and press
or ceramic grout lines, or use patching compound                                                                        the fit of the no-glue flooring and then carefully remove      the tape down so it adheres well to the subfloor.
                                                          the floor, reinforced double-sided tape, and a seaming
on plywood to create a flat, smooth surface.                                                                            the flooring.
                                                          kit for larger installations.

    Tip ▸
                                                                                          Thicker than standard
                                                                                          sheet vinyl flooring,
                                                                                          no-glue sheet vinyl is
                                                                                          designed to remain flat and
                                                                                          stay put without the use of
                                                                                          glues or other adhesives.

                                                                                                                        Center the tape under the two sides at seam lines.             Drive nails into the wall surface—not through the
                                                                                                                        Press one side of the vinyl into place first. Place the        vinyl flooring—when installing the baseboard or base
                                                                                                                        second vinyl sheet and press it into place. Use a seam         shoe. Anchoring the flooring with perimeter nails may
                                                                                                                        sealer kit to seal the seams.                                  result in buckling of the vinyl surface when the floor
                                                                                                                                                                                       expands or contracts. Also, do not press the molding
                                                                                                                                                                                       down into the vinyl. Leave a small gap between the mold-
                                                                                                                                                                                       ing and the floor surface so the vinyl is not constricted.

228 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Flooring ■ 229

Resilient Tile                                                                                                                        ■ How to Install Resilient Tile
                                                                                                                                        1                                                                   2
A    s with any tile installation, resilient tile requires
     carefully positioned layout lines. Before com‑
mitting to any layout, conduct a dry run to identify
                                                                    quarter-turn method, in which each tile has its pattern
                                                                    grain running perpendicular to that of adjacent
                                                                    tiles. Whichever method you choose, be sure to be
potential problems.                                                 consistent throughout the project.
     Keep in mind the difference between reference
lines and layout lines. Reference lines mark the center
of the room and divide it into quadrants. If the tiles
don’t lay out symmetrically along these lines, you’ll
                                                                         Tools & Materials ▸                                                                                                    y

need to adjust them slightly, creating layout lines.
                                                                         Tape measure                Resilient tile
Once layout lines are established, installing the tile is
                                                                         Chalkline                   Flooring adhesive
a fairly quick process. Be sure to keep joints between
                                                                         Framing square              1
                                                                                                      ⁄8" spacer blocks
the tiles tight and lay the tiles square.                                                                                                                                                                                                           y
                                                                         Utility knife               Metal threshold bars
     Tiles with an obvious grain pattern can be                          1
                                                                          ⁄16" notched trowel            and screws
laid so the grain of each tile is oriented identically                                                                                                                                                        x
                                                                         Ceramic tile cutter
throughout the installation. You can also use the                                                                                                                                           x

                                                                                                                                      Lay out perpendicular reference lines that divide the room          Check the reference lines for squareness using the 3-4-5
                                                                                                                                      into roughly equivalent quadrants.                                  triangle method. Measure along reference line X and make a
                                                                                                                                                                                                          mark 3 ft. from the centerpoint. Measure from the centerpoint
                                                                                                                                                                                                          along reference line Y and make a mark at 4 ft.

                                                                                                                                        3                                                                   4

                                                                                                                                                                               x
                                                                                                                                                                    x1

                                                                                                                                                                    y

                                                                                                                                      Create a new line that is parallel to reference line X 		           Dry-fit tiles along the new line, X1. If necessary, adjust the
                                                                                                                                      and runs through a tile joint near line X if it's necessary to      layout line as in steps 1 and 2.
                                                                                                                                      shift the layout. The new line, X1, is the line you’ll use when
Check for noticeable directional features, like the grain of the vinyl particles. You can set the tiles in a running pattern so the   installing the tile. Use a different colored chalk to distinguish
directional feature runs in the same direction (top) or in a checkerboard pattern using the quarter-turn method (bottom).             between lines.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 (continued)

230 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Flooring ■ 231

                                                                                                                                               Tip ▸
                                                                                                                                                                                                                9
  5                                                                  6

                                                                                                                                              To mark tiles for cutting around outside corners,
                                                                                                                                              make a cardboard template to match the space,
                                                                                                                                              keeping a 1⁄8" gap along the walls. After cutting               Cut the tile to fit using a utility knife and straightedge. Hold
Apply adhesive around the intersection of the layout lines         Spread adhesive over most of the installation area, covering               the template, check to make sure it fits. Place the             the straightedge securely against the cutting line to ensure a
using a trowel with 1⁄16" V-shaped notches. Hold the trowel at a   three quadrants. Allow the adhesive to set according to the                template on a tile and trace its outline.                       straight cut. Option: You can use a ceramic-tile cutter to make
45° angle and spread adhesive evenly over the surface.             manufacturer’s instructions, then begin to install the tile at the                                                                         straight cuts in thick vinyl tiles (see inset).
                                                                   intersection of the layout lines. You can kneel on installed tiles
                                                                   to lay additional tiles.

  7                                                                  8                                                                      10                                                                  11

                                                                                                                     B

                                                                                                      A

Complete the first three quadrants, and then spread                Cut tiles to fit along the walls. Place the tile to be cut (A) face
adhesive over the remaining quadrant and finish setting 		         up on top of the last full tile you installed. Position a 1⁄8"‑thick
the tile.                                                          spacer against the wall, then set a marker tile (B) on top of the      Install the cut tiles next to the walls. If you’re precutting all   Continue installing the tile in the remaining quadrants until
                                                                   tile to be cut. Trace along the edge of the marker tile to draw a      the tiles before installing them, measure the distance between      the room is completely covered. Check the entire floor. If you
                                                                   cutting line.                                                          the wall and install the tiles at various points in case the        find loose areas, press down on the tiles to bond them to the
                                                                                                                                          distance changes.                                                   underlayment. Install metal threshold bars at room borders
                                                                                                                                                                                                              where the new floor joins another floor covering.

232 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Flooring ■ 233

Laminate Flooring                                                                                                        Installation Tips ▸

L  aminate flooring comes in a floating system that
   is simple to install, even if you have no experience
with other home-improvement projects. You may
                                                             at a home-improvement or flooring store and install
                                                             laminate flooring with the step-by-step instructions
                                                             offered in the following pages.
install a floating laminate floor right on top of plywood,
concrete slab, sheet vinyl, or hardwood flooring. Just
be sure to follow the manufacturer’s instructions.
     The flooring is available in planks or squares in a
                                                                 Tools & Materials ▸
variety of different sizes, colors, and faux finishes—           Hammer                        Drill with Forstner bit
including wood and ceramic. The part you see is really           Circular saw                  Hole saw
a photographic print. Tongue-and-grooved edges lock              Utility knife                 Jigsaw
the pieces together, and the entire floor floats on the          Underlayment                  Painter’s tape
underlayment. At the end of this project there are a             ⁄2" wall spacers
                                                                 1
                                                                                               Clamps
few extra steps to take if your flooring manufacturer            Tapping block                 Rubber mallet
recommends using glue on the joints.                             Scrap rigid foam insulation   Drawbar
     The rich wood tones of beautiful laminate                   Speed square                  Thin cloth and ratchet
planks may cause you to imagine hours of long, hard              Scissors                      Finish nails
installation work, but this is a DIY project that you can        Manufacturer glue             Strap clamps              Ripcut the planks from the back side to avoid                      Place another piece of flooring next to the
do in a single weekend. Buy the manufactured planks              Adhesive tape                 Threshold and screws      splintering the top surface. For accurate straight cuts,           piece marked for cutting to provide a stable surface for
                                                                                                                         mark the cut with a chalk line. If your pencil line is not         the foot of the saw. Also, clamp a cutting guide to the
                                                                                                                         straight, double-check your tracing—your wall may not be           planks at the correct distance from the cutting line to
                                                                                                                         perfectly straight, in which case you should cut along your        ensure a straight cut.
                                                                                                                         hand-drawn pencil line.

                                                                                                                         If you need to cut the planks to fit snugly against another plank or a wall with an obstacle such as a heat vent:
                                                                                                                         Measure in to the appropriate cutline to fit the board flush with the adjacent board or wall (on the other side of the
                                                                                                                         obstacle). Draw a line across the plank in this location. Then measure the obstacle and transfer those measurements to
                                                                                                                         the plank. Drill a starter hole just large enough to fit your jigsaw blade into it. Cut the plank along the drawn lines, using a
                                                                                                                         jigsaw. Set the board in place by locking the tongue-and-grooved joints with the preceding board.

234 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Flooring ■ 235

■ How to Install a Floating Floor
  1                                                                  2                                                                   5                                                                   6

Start in one corner and unroll the underlayment to the             Work from the left corner of the room to the right and set
opposite wall. Cut the underlayment to fit using a utility knife   wall spacers and dry lay planks (tongue side facing the wall)       Clamp the board to a work table face down on top of rigid           To create a tight fit for the last plank in the first row, place
or scissors. Overlap the second underlayment sheet according       against the wall. The spacers allow for expansion. If you are       foam insulation or plywood. The foam reduces chipping. Clamp        a spacer against the wall and wedge one end of a drawbar
to the manufacturer’s recommendations, and secure the              flooring a room more than 26 ft. long or wide, you need to buy      a speed square on top of the plank, as though you are going to      between it and the last plank. Tap the other end of the drawbar
pieces in place with adhesive tape.                                appropriate-sized expansion joints. Note: Some manufacturers        draw another line parallel to the cutline—use this to eye your      with a rubber mallet or hammer. Protect the laminate surface
                                                                   suggest facing the groove side to the wall.                         straight cut. Place the circular saw’s blade on the waste side of   with a thin cloth.
                                                                                                                                       the actual cutline.

  3                                                                  4                                                                   7                                                                   8

                      Final uncut plank
                      ends here

Set a new plank right side up, on top of the previously laid       Press painter’s tape along the cutline on the top of the plank      Continue to lay rows of flooring, making sure the joints are        Fit the final row: Place two planks on top of the last course;
plank, flush with the spacer against the wall at the end run.      to prevent chipping when cutting. Score the line drawn in step      staggered. This prevents the entire floor from relying on just a    slide the top plank up against the wall spacer. Use the top
Line up a speed square with the bottom plank edge and trace        3 with a utility knife. Turn the plank over and extend the pencil   few joints, which keep the planks from lifting. Staggering also     plank to draw a cutline lengthwise on the middle plank. Cut the
a line. That’s the cutline for the final plank in the row.         line to the back side.                                              stengthens the floor, because the joints are shorter and more       middle plank to size using the same method as in step 3, just
                                                                                                                                       evenly distributed.                                                 across the grain. The very last board must be cut lengthwise
                                                                                                                                                                                                           and widthwise to fit.

236 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Flooring ■ 237

■ How to Work Around Obstacles                                                                                                       ■ How to Install Laminate Flooring Using Adhesive
  1                                                                   2                                                                1                                                                    2

  Marking outside edge
  of the pipe

            Mark indicates right
            outside edge of
            the pipe

Position a plank end against the spacers on the wall next to        Snap the plank into the previous row, then position the plank    Dry-fit each row, then completely fill the groove of the plank       Close the gaps between the end joints and the lengthwise
the obstacle. Use a pencil to make two marks along the length       end against the obstacle. Make two marks with a pencil, this     with the glue supplied or recommended by the manufacturer.           joints using a rubber mallet and block to gently tap the edge or
of the plank, indicating the points where the obstacle begins       time on the end of the plank to indicate where the obstacle                                                                           end of the last plank. Use a drawbar for the last planks butted
and ends.                                                           falls along the width of the board.                                                                                                   up to a wall. Wipe away excess glue in the joints with a damp
                                                                                                                                                                                                          cloth before it dries.

  3                                                                   4                                                                3                                                                    4
                                                                                                                                                                                                             New floor                             Floor in
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   adjacent room

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   Transition

Use a speed square to extend the four lines. The space at           Install the plank by locking the tongue-and-groove joints        Use strap clamps to hold a few rows of planks together as            Install transition thresholds at room borders where the
which they intersect is the part of the plank that needs to be      with the preceding board. Fit the end piece in behind the pipe   adhesive dries (about an hour). Fit one end of the strap clamp       new floor joins another floor covering. These thresholds are
removed to make room for the obstacle to go through it. Use a       or obstacle. Apply manufacturer-recommended glue to the cut      over the plank nearest the wall and the other end (the one with      used to tie together dissimilar floor coverings, such as laminate
drill with a Forstner bit or a hole saw the same diameter as the    edges, and press the end piece tightly against the adjacent      the ratchet lever) over the last plank. Use the ratchet to tighten   floorings and wood or carpet. They may also be necessary to
space within the intersecting lines, and drill through the plank    plank. Wipe away any excess glue with a damp cloth.              straps until the joints are snug.                                    span a distance in height between flooring in one room and
at the X. You’ll be left with a hole; extend the cut to the edges                                                                                                                                         the next.
with a jigsaw.

238 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Flooring ■ 239

Lighting L ighting does many jobs in the kitchen. It can set the mood, illuminate the task at hand, highlight a detail, or simply create beautiful patterns. Despite how important lighting is, a great many kitchens are poorly lit. One common kitchen lighting problem is the centrally placed ceiling fixture with no other lighting sources. Unfortunately, this central fixture creates strong shadows at every workstation because the cook’s body is always between the light source and the work area. Fortunately, this can be remedied in a number of creative and beautiful ways highlighted in this chapter. Another kitchen lighting scheme, considered a step up from the single fixture, was the suspended ceiling with banks of fluorescent lights. The problem with fluorescent lighting is that it can make everything look green. In this chapter you will learn that light sources have different impacts on color. We’ll cover lighting for tasks, accent and ambient lighting, and decorative lighting using photo examples of each. Also included are how-to directions for installing track and cable lighting, under-, in-, and above-cabinet lighting, recessed lights, and a ceiling fan with a light fixture.

In This Chapter • Lighting Selection • Ceiling Lights • Canister Lights • Undercabinet Lights

                                                   ■ 241

Lighting Selection                                                                                                                   ■ Artificial Lighting
K   itchen lighting is a big deal—for homeowners
    everywhere and, of course, for the entire kitchen
remodeling industry. When confronted with the
                                                                    fixtures cluttering the plan. Most people like bright
                                                                    kitchens, and with good reason: It’s the home’s
                                                                    primary gathering place and the stage for most of
                                                                                                                                     Kitchen lighting is often broken down into three
                                                                                                                                     main categories based on function. Ambient
                                                                                                                                     lighting provides the room with most of its general
                                                                                                                                                                                                             When it comes to overhead lighting, one or two
                                                                                                                                                                                                       well‑placed fixtures will meet the demands of most
                                                                                                                                                                                                       kitchens. The most effective overhead fixtures are
endless variety of fixture options, designers and their             the household’s everyday “work.” A kitchen must be               illumination. This is most often achieved with bright             ceiling‑mounted units that project light all around as
clients can be tempted to go a little nuts, often ending            warm and inviting for all users at any hour. With that           overhead fixtures that reflect light off of surrounding           well as onto the ceiling. Glass or acrylic globes offer
up with a complex array of interesting yet marginally               in mind, it’s important to note that a green lighting            surfaces and set the overall light level in the room. The         the best illumination, while fixtures with opaque
effective lights. By contrast, lighting a kitchen with              plan is not about putting up with dim lighting or                cumulative light from other fixtures also contributes to          sides or shades limit brightness by focusing the
a green focus can be quite straightforward. The                     commercial‑style ambience; it’s about setting the right          ambient lighting. Task lighting provides focused light            light downward.
main objective should be comfortable and effective                  fixtures in the right places. It’s also about maximizing         in specific work areas, such as the cooktop, sink, and                  One of the most popular choices for overhead
illumination without unnecessary and inefficient                    natural daylight.                                                countertops. The third category, accent lighting, is              lighting is the recessed “can” fixture, which people
                                                                                                                                     used more sparingly and creatively to highlight special           like for its flush installation that doesn’t break up
                                                                                                                                     features or for decorative effect.                                the ceiling plane. However, because all of the light is
                                                                                                                                          Ambient and task lighting together make up                   directed downward, you need several fixtures to yield
                                                                                                                                     the core of a kitchen plan. With those types of                   the same levels as one or two globe‑type fixtures; thus,
                                                                                                                                     lighting satisfied, accent fixtures can be added to               it is a less‑green option. If you do opt for recessed
                                                                                                                                     provide layering and enhance the dynamics of light                cans, choose products rated “IC‑AT,” meaning the
                                                                                                                                     and shadow.                                                       fixture housing can be covered with insulation and the
                                                                                                                                                                                                       cans are airtight to limit air infiltration.

In a green kitchen, natural daylight, reflective surfaces, and judicious use of fixtures create a bright, dynamic environment with
limited energy use.                                                                                                                  The kitchen on the left has several recessed fixtures just for overhead lighting, while the greener kitchen on the right takes
                                                                                                                                     advantage of reflective surfaces and is brightly illuminated with only one overhead fixture.

242 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Lighting ■ 243

     When it comes to task lighting, nothing gets                    often call for more atmospheric lighting. Dimmers
the job done more effectively or efficiently than
under‑cabinet fluorescent tube fixtures. These
                                                                     let you set the light level to suit the mood of the
                                                                     specific meal or activity. Some compact fluorescent
                                                                                                                                                          ■ Natural Lighting
inexpensive units fit into the recess below most                     lamps (CFLs) and fixtures are available with dimming
standard cabinets and can be plugged into a                          capability, so be sure to get the right products for                                 Nothing adds more life to a kitchen than a window.         and warmth in the winter when the sun is at a lower
countertop receptacle or hard‑wired with a wall‑switch               the application.                                                                     With a view to the outdoors, cooking and cleaning          angle. Of course, not every kitchen can accommodate
control (see pages 254 to 257). Their energy efficiency                                                                                                   up feel less like work, and the room doesn’t have          windows or has the luxury of an exterior view. But
is unmatched by other fixture types, providing about                                                                                                      the sense of isolation that can plague windowless          good alternatives exist. Skylights work well in kitchens
50 lumens per watt (or lpw—the true measure of                                                                                                            kitchens. Operable windows on more than one                because they dramatically brighten the room even
lighting efficiency). A single bulb can burn for up to                                                                                                    wall can usher in generous cross‑breezes to flush          on cloudy days, and they psychologically expand the
20,000 hours before needing replacement.                                                                                                                  the kitchen with fresh air. And all that natural light     space. As with windows, skylights should face north
     Other popular types of under-cabinet lighting                                                                                                        reduces the need for artificial lighting during the day.   or east whenever possible. If glare and heat gain are
include halogen, xenon, and LED. Of the three, LED                                                                                                             When adding windows to a kitchen, orientation is      unavoidable, look into skylights with prismatic or
are the most energy‑efficient but by far the most                                                                                                         a critical consideration. Glare and heat gain, primarily   translucent glazing, or provide means for shading the
expensive. Halogen lights, which contain incandescent                                                                                                     from south‑ and west‑facing windows, can hinder            unit when needed. Where an attic above the kitchen
bulbs, are popular for their bright, even light, but they                                                                                                 visibility and make the room uncomfortably hot with        makes a skylight impractical, a tubular skylight may be
come with two significant drawbacks: They operate                                                                                                         the afternoon sun. North‑facing windows offer more         a viable alternative. Another way to bring natural light
at only 20 lpw and they get very hot—hot enough to                                                                                                        even light throughout the day, while east‑facing           into a kitchen is to remove a wall or bank of cabinets
warm a stack of plates or even melt chocolate in the                                                                                                      windows can bring in pleasant morning sun without          to join the kitchen with an adjacent room that has
cabinet above the fixture. Xenon bulbs produce about                                                                                                      the heat gain from midday and afternoon sun                windows. If the kitchen has a standard entry door, you
15 lpw and may require a separate transformer that                                                                                                        exposure. On southern windows, you can use exterior        can replace it with a glazed unit or add a transom or
you have to hide as part of the installation.                                                                                                             awnings to block the hot summer sun but let in light       awning window above to increase daylighting.
                                                                     Fluorescent under‑cabinet lights run cool (unlike
     Ambient (and decorative) lighting may be less
                                                                     incandescents) and provide the most light with the least
important from a practical view, but it can play                     amount of electricity. The simplest way to add under‑cabinet
a critical role in the overall quality of light in the               lighting is with plug‑in fixtures (inset), while hard‑wired                                                                                                                 Adding a well‑placed
kitchen. Eating areas, such as a bar or breakfast nook,              installations
                                                                          Author   don’t use upISBNoutlet
                                                                                                    #     space. Author's review                                                                                                                 window is always a good
                                                                           Green Living                 0781760607          (if needed)                                                                                                          investment, particularly
                                                                         Fig. #                Document name                              OK     Correx
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 in kitchens.
                                                                           F08                  F08.eps
                                                                         Artist                      Date                     Initials    Date
                                                                                                               12/05/2007
                                                                          Accurate Art, Inc.
                                                                                                     Check if revision
    Positioning Task Lights ▸                                            BxW             2/C        4/C
                                                                                                                            CE's review
                                                                                                                                          OK     Correx

                                                                         Final Size (Width x Depth in Picas)
    Here’s a good rule of thumb for effective task lighting:                                                      Initials
                                                                           32w x 17d fixtures don’t. Always place task
                                                                     soffit‑mounted                                        lightsDate
    Let nothing come between the light and the task.                 where your body or head won’t cast a shadow over
    Lights placed under cabinets, inside range hoods, and            your work.
    directly over sinks follow the rule; overhead lights and

      Recessed
      soffit                                              Overhead
      fixture                                             fixture

                                                                Under-
      Shadows                                                   cabinet
      created by                                                fixture
      cabinets                                                  has no
      and cook’s                                                obstructions
      body

244 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Lighting ■ 245

Ceiling Lights

C    eiling fixtures don’t have any moving parts and
     their wiring is very simple, so, other than changing
bulbs, you’re likely to get decades of trouble‑free
                                                            Tools & Materials ▸                                                                                                                                                              Shown cutaway

service from a fixture. This sounds like a good thing,      Replacement light fixture    Insulated screwdrivers
                                                                                                                          Electrical box
but it also means that the fixture probably won’t fail      Wire stripper                Combination tool                                                                   Metal braces
and give you an excuse to update a room’s look with         Voltage sensor               Wire connectors                                                                                                                                               Joist

a new one. Fortunately, you don’t need an excuse.                                                                                                                                                              Brace
Upgrading a fixture is easy and can make a dramatic                                                                                                                     Hot wire
impact on a room. You can substantially increase the
light in a room by replacing a globe‑style fixture by one                                                                                                                                                                                     Wallboard
                                                                                                                                                      Grounding wire
with separate spotlights, or you can simply install a
new fixture that matches the room’s décor.
                                                                                                                                Neutral wire

                                                                                        Installing a new ceiling                                                           Mounting strap
                                                                                        fixture can provide more
                                                                                        light to a space, not to
                                                                                                                                                                                                If the new fixture is much heavier than the original fixture,
                                                                                        mention an aesthetic lift. It’s         Grounding                                                       it will require additional bracing in the ceiling to support the
                                                                                        one of the easiest upgrades             screw
                                                                                                                                                                                                electrical box and the fixture. The manufacturer’s instructions
                                                                                        you can do.
                                                                                                                                                                                                should specify the size and type of box. If the ceiling is finished
                                                                                                                                                                                                and there is no access from above, you can remove the old
                                                                                                                                                                                   Mounting     box and use an adjustable remodeling brace appropriate
                                                                                                                                                                                   screws
                                                                                                                                                                                                for your fixture (shown). The brace fits into a small hole in
                                                                                                                                                                                                the ceiling (inset). Once the bracing is in place, install a new
                                                                                                                                                                                                electrical box specified for the new fixture.

                                                                                                                            Fixture base

                                                                                                                                                Tab
                                                                                                                                                                      Brass screw
                                                                                                                                                                      terminal
                                                                                                                           Socket (cutaway)

                                                                                                                                                                        Shade

                                                                                                                                                                                Filament

                                                                                                                          No matter what ceiling light fixtures look like on the                Inexpensive light fixtures have screw terminals mounted
                                                                                                                          outside, they all attach in basically the same way. An electrical     directly to the backside of the fixture plate. Often, as seen here,
                                                                                                                          box in the ceiling is fitted with a mounting strap, which holds the   they have no grounding terminal. Some codes do not allow
                                                                                                                          fixture in place. The bare wire from the ceiling typically connects   this type of fixture, but even if your hometown does approve
                                                                                                                          to the mounting strap. The two wires coming from the fixture          them, it is a good idea to replace them with better quality, safer
                                                                                                                          connect to the black and the white wires from the ceiling.            fixtures that are UL‑approved.

246 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Lighting ■ 247

■ How to Replace a Ceiling Light
  1                                                                    2                                                                5                                                                 6

Shut off the power to the ceiling light and remove the shade         Remove the twist connectors from the fixture wires or            Lift the new fixture up to the ceiling (you may want a            Support the fixture with a ladder or a helper and then join
or diffuser. Loosen the mounting screws and carefully lower          unscrew the screw terminals and remove the white neutral         helper for this) and attach the bare copper ground wire from      the white wire lead and the white fixture wire with a wire
the fixture, supporting it as you work (do not let light fixtures    wire and the black lead wire (inset).                            the power supply cable to the grounding screw or clip on the      connector (often supplied with the fixture).
hang by their electrical wires alone). Test with a voltage sensor                                                                     mounting strap. Also attach the ground wire from the fixture to
to make sure no power is reaching the connections.                                                                                    the screw or clip.

  3                                                                    4                                                                7                                                                 8

Check the ends of the wires coming from the ceiling                  Attach a mounting strap to the ceiling fixture box if there is   Connect the black power supply wire to the black fixture          Position the new fixture mounting plate over the box
electrical box before you install the new fixture. They should be    not one already present. Your new light may come equipped        wire with a wire connector.                                       so the mounting screw holes align. Drive the screws until the
clean and free of nicks or scorch marks. If they’re dirty or worn,   with a strap, otherwise you can find one for purchase at any                                                                       fixture is secure against the ceiling.
clip off the stripped portion with your combination tool. Then       hardware store.
strip away about 3⁄4" of insulation from the end of each wire.

248 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Lighting ■ 249

Canister Lights

R    ecessed lights are versatile fixtures suited for
     a variety of situations. Fixtures rated for
outdoor use can also be installed in roof soffits and
overhangs for accent and security lighting. Recessed
fixtures can also be installed over showers or tubs.
Be sure to use fixture cans and trims rated for
bathroom use.
     There are recessed lighting cans in all shapes and              Rating symbol                      Rating symbol
sizes for almost every type of ceiling or cabinet. Cans
                                                                                                                                                             A
are sold for unfinished ceilings (new construction) or               Choose the proper type of recessed light fixture for your                                                                                                                     C
                                                                     project. There are two types of fixtures: those rated for                                                                            B
for finished ceilings (retrofit installation). Cans are
                                                                     ­installation within insulation (left), and those which must be
also rated as insulation compatible or for uninsulated
                                                                      kept at least 3" from insulation (right). Self‑contained thermal
ceilings. Be sure to use the correct one for your ceiling             switches shut off power if the unit gets too hot for its rating.
to prevent creating a fire hazard.                                    A recessed light fixture must be installed at least ½" from
                                                                      combustible materials.

    Tools & Materials ▸                                                                                                                                                              D
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        E

    Recessed‑lighting can for new 		                Circuit tester                 Chalkline              Drywall saw
                                                                                                                                         Recessed ceiling light housings come in many sizes and styles for various purposes and budgets. Some are sold with trim
      construction or remodeling and trim           Cable ripper                   Pliers                 NM cable                       kits (below) included. Some common types are: new construction recessed housing (sold in economical multipacks) (A); airtight
    Tape measure                                    Combination tool               Fish tape              Wire staples                   recessed housings (for heated rooms below unheated ceilings) (B); shallow recessed housings (for rooms with 2 × 6" ceiling joists)
                                                                                                                                         (C); small aperture recessed housing (D); recessed slope ceiling housing (for vaulted ceilings) (E).

                                                                                                                                                                                                          B                                  C
                                                                                                                                                                       A

                                                                                                                                                                  D                                       E                                       F

Recessed ceiling lights often are installed in series to provide exacting control over the amount and direction of light. Spacing        Trim kits for recessed ceiling lights may be sold separately. Common types include: recessed open trim with baffle (A, F);
the canisters in every other ceiling joist bay is a common practice.                                                                     recessed eyeball trim (B); baffle trim (C); shower light trim (D); airtight recessed open trim (E).

250 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Lighting ■ 251

■ How to Install Canister Lights
  1                                                                   2                                                                   5                                                                     6

                                                                                                                                        Connect the feeder wires to the fixture wires inside                 Attach your trim kit of choice. Normally, these are hung
Mark the location for the light canister. If you are                Install the housing for the recessed fixture. Housings              the junction box. Twist the hot lead together with the black         with torsion spring clips from notches or hooks inside the
installing multiple lights, measure out from the wall at the        for new construction (or remodeling installations where the         fixture wire, as well as the black lead to other fixtures further    canister. This should be done after the ceiling is installed and
start and end of the run, and connect them with a chalkline         installation area is fully accessible from either above or below)   downline. Also connect the neutral white wires. Join the ground      finished for new construction projects. With certain types of
snapped parallel to the wall. If the ceiling is finished, see the   have integral hanger bars that you attach to each joist in the      wires and pigtail them to the grounding screw or clip in the         trim kits, such as eyeball trim, you’ll need to install the light
next page.                                                          joist bay.                                                          box. Finish the ceiling, as desired.                                 bulb before the trim kit.

  3                                                                   4
                                                                                                                                        ■ How to Connect a Recessed Fixture Can in a Finished Ceiling
                                                                                                                                          1                                              2                                             3

                                                                                                                                        Make the hole for the can. Most               Remove a knockout from the                     Retrofit cans secure themselves
                                                                                                                                        fixtures will include a template for          electrical box attached to the can.            with spring-loaded clips into the
                                                                                                                                        sizing the hole. Fish 14/2 cable from the     Thread the cable into the box; secure it       hole. Install the can in the ceiling by
                                                                                                                                        switch location to the hole. Pull about       with a cable clamp. Remove sheathing           depressing the mounting clips so the
                                                                                                                                        16" of cable out of the hole for making       insulation. Connect the black fixture          can will fit into the hole. Insert the can
Run electric cable from the switch to each canister location.       Run the feeder cables into the electrical boxes attached to         the connection.                               wire to the black circuit wire, the white      so that its edge is tight to the ceiling.
Multiple lights are generally installed in series so there is no    the canister housings. You’ll need to remove knockouts first                                                      fixture wire to the white circuit wire,        Push the mounting clips back out so
need to make pigtail connections in the individual boxes. Make      and make sure to secure the cable with a wire staple within 8"                                                    and then connect the ground wire to            they grip the drywall and hold the fixture
sure to leave enough extra cable at each location to feed the       of the entry point to the box.                                                                                    the grounding screw or grounding wire          in place. Install the trim piece.
wire into the housing and make the connection.                                                                                                                                        attached to the box.

252 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Lighting ■ 253

Undercabinet Lights                                                                                                                  ■ How to Install a Hardwired Undercabinet Light
                                                                                                                                       1                                                                   2
H    ardwired undercabinet lights illuminate the
     kitchen countertop and sink areas that fall in the
shadow of ceiling lights. Most of these light fixtures,
                                                                    cabinet location, and out the wall to supply the fixture
                                                                    that’s mounted to the underside of the upper cabinet.
                                                                         You can purchase undercabinet lights that
which are often called strip lights, utilize fluorescent,           are controlled by a wall switch, but most products
halogen, or xenon bulbs that emit very low levels of                have an integral on/off button so you can control                        Circuit with
                                                                                                                                             extra capacity
heat and are therefore very efficient.                              lights individually.
     If you are doing a kitchen remodel with all‑new
cabinets, run the new light circuit wiring before the
cabinets are installed. For a retrofit, you’ll need to find
an available power source to tie into. Options for this                  Tools & Materials ▸                                           Adjoining room

do not include the dedicated 20‑amp small-appliance
circuits that are required in kitchens. The best bet is                  Circuit tester             Undercabinet lighting kit
to run new circuit wire from a close‑by ceiling light                    Utility knife              Hanging straps                                                  Kitchen

switch box, but this will mean cutting into the walls                    Wallboard saw              14/2 NM cable
to run cable. Another option is to locate a receptacle                   Hammer                     Wire connectors
that’s on the opposite side of a shared wall, preferably                 Screwdriver                Switch box                        Wall shown cutaway
next to a location where a base cabinet is installed in                  Drill and hole saw         Switch
the kitchen. By cutting an access hole in the cabinet                    Jigsaw                     Electrical junction box          Look in the adjoining room for a usable power source in             Cut a hole in the base cabinet back panel to get access to
                                                                         Cable Clamp                Panel adhesive                   the form of a receptacle that has a box located in the wall         the wall behind it in roughly the area where you know the
back, you can tie into the receptacle box and run cable
                                                                                                                                     behind your base cabinets. Unlike the small-appliance circuit       next‑door receptacle to be. Use a keyhole saw or drywall saw
through the wall behind the cabinets, up to the upper                    Wire stripper
                                                                                                                                     with outlets in your backsplash area, these typically are not       and make very shallow cuts until you have positively identified
                                                                                                                                     dedicated circuits (which can’t be expanded). Make sure             the locations of the electrical box and cables. Then finish the
                                                                                                                                     that the receptacle’s circuit has enough capacity to support        cuts with a jigsaw.
                                                                                                                                     another load. Shut the power to the receptacle off at the main
                                                                                                                                     service panel and test for power.

                                                                                                                                       3                                                                   4

                                                                                                                                     Drill an access hole into the kitchen wall for the cable 		         Cut a small access hole (4 × 4" or so) in the back panel of
Undercabinet lights provide directed task lighting that brings sinks and countertop work surfaces out from the shadows.              that will feed the undercabinet light. A 1⁄2" dia. hole should be   the base cabinet directly below the undercabinet light location.
Hardwired lights may be controlled either by a wall switch or an onboard on/off switch located on the fixture. Note: Do not supply   about the right size if you are using 12-ga. or 14-ga. sheathed
power for lights from a small-appliance circuit.                                                                                     NM cable.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              (continued)

254 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Lighting ■ 255

  5                                                                  6                                                                  8                                                                 9

Feed the cable into the access hole at the light location until    String the cable into a piece of flexible conduit that’s long
the end reaches the access hole below. Don’t cut the cable         enough to reach between the two access holes in the base           Remove the receptacle from the box you are tying into and         Install the undercabinet light. Some models have a
yet. Reach into the access hole and feel around for the free       cabinets. Attach a connector to each end of the conduit to         insert the new circuit cable into one of the knockouts using a    removable diffuser that allows access to the fixture wires,
cable end and then pull it out through the access hole once        protect the cable sheathing from the sharp edges of the cut        cable clamp. Check a wire capacity chart to make sure the box     and these should be screwed to the upper cabinet prior
you’ve found it. Cut the cable, making sure to leave plenty of     metal. Tip: To make patching the cabinet back easier, drill a      is big enough for the new conductors. Replace it with a larger    to making your wiring hookups. Other models need to be
extra on both ends.                                                new access hole for the cable near the square access hole.         box if necessary. Reinstall the receptacle once the connections   connected to the circuit wires before installation. Check your
                                                                                                                                      are made.                                                         manufacturer’s installations.

  7                                                                                                                                     10                                                                11

Hang the conduit with hanger straps attached to the base           Variation: If you are installing more than one undercabinet
cabinet frame or back panel, drilling holes in the side walls of   light, run the cable down from each installation point as you
the cabinet where necessary to thread the conduit through.         did for the first light. Mount an electrical junction box to the   Connect wires inside the light fixture according to the light     Cut patches of hardboard and fit them over the access
On back panels, use small screws to hang the straps instead of     cabinet back near the receptacle providing the power. Run          manufacturer’s directions. Make sure the incoming cable is        holes, overlapping the edges of the cutouts. Adhere them to
brads or nails. Support the conduit near both the entrance and     the power cables from each light through flexible conduit and      stapled just before it enters the light box and that a cable      the cabinet backs with panel adhesive.
the exit holes (the conduit should extend past the back panels     make connections inside the junction box. Be sure to attach        clamp is used at the knockout in the box to protect the cable.
by a couple of inches).                                            the junction box cover once the connections are made.              Restore the power and test the light.

256 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Lighting ■ 257

Easy Updates

S ometimes all your kitchen requires to get a new lease on life is one or two quick projects. From a fresh coat of paint to a clever pantry conversion, the projects on the following pages could be classified as “high payback” on your investment of time and money. An easy update may have a purely visual purpose, such as painting walls or cabinets. It may be more of an organizational improvement, such as a pantry conversion project. It may add a new dimension to your kitchen as a living space, as when building a built-in banquette. Or the main purpose could be improving the safety of your family by taking a few simple childproofing measures. Some easy updates are chosen for reasons of simple practicality, such as adding soffits above your wall cabinets to house new lighting or conceal ductwork from a vent fan. Replacing a plain window with a garden window is another way to make a practical improvement to your kitchen light. Whatever the purpose of your easy update, bear in mind that quick and easy should never mean sloppy. Always use caution and care when undertaking any home improvement or repair project.

This chapter shows: • Painting • Childproofing • Convert a Closet to Pull-out Pantry • New Banquette • Garden Window • Framed Soffits

                                                 ■ 259

Painting                                                                                                                    ■ How to Patch Peeling Paint
                                                                                                                              1                                      2                                       3
K   itchen walls need to be washed before painting.
    A dirty, greasy wall will absorb paint unevenly and
is more likely to cause sags or drips even in properly
applied paint. Some surface dirt will even bleed
through, causing staining. Use a trisodium
phosphate cleaner and carefully follow the
manufacturer’s instructions.
     Many kitchens are painted with high-gloss
paint. You may need to de-gloss the old paint surface
to ensure proper adhesion of the new paint. This
can be done with a chemical paint de-glosser or by
sanding. The de-glosser must be used with sufficient
ventilation, and you should wear a respirator.
     Move the stove and refrigerator if they are not
built in and paint behind them. This prevents paint
from dripping or spattering onto cooling fans or into
vent areas. For professional results, check your walls
for damage and repair the wallboard or plaster as                                                                           Scrape away loose paint with a         Apply spackle to the edges of the       Sand the patch area with 150‑grit
                                                                Wash kitchen walls thoroughly before painting. Grease and   putty knife or paint scraper.          chipped paint with a putty knife or a   ­production sandpaper. The patch area
needed. Carefully mask and tape all trim and cabinets,          dirt will prevent paint from adhering fully.                                                       flexible wallboard knife.                should feel smooth to the touch.
and cover countertops and the floor with drop cloths.

                                                                    Tools & Materials ▸                                     ■ How to Mask Trim
                                                                    Putty knife                 Sandpaper
                                                                    Paint scraper
                                                                    Trisodium phospate
                                                                                                Spackle
                                                                                                Masking tape
                                                                                                                                                                      1                                      2

    Surface Preparation Tips ▸

                                                                                                                            Masking and draping materials          Use pregummed paper or wide             After applying the tape, run the
                                                                                                                            include (clockwise from top left):     masking tape to protect wood            tip of a putty knife along the inside
    Apply lightweight spackle to holes with a putty knife       Water or rust stains may indicate water damage. Check       plastic and canvas drop cloths,        moldings from paint splatters.          edge of the tape to seal it against
    or your fingertip. This keeps repair areas small. Let the   for leaking pipes and soft plaster, make needed repairs,    self‑adhesive plastic, masking tape,   Leave the outside edge of the           seeping paint. After painting, remove
    spackle dry. Sand until smooth.                             then seal the area with stain‑covering sealer.              and pre­gummed masking papers.         masking tape loose.                     ­the tape as soon as the paint is too
                                                                                                                                                                                                            dry to run.

260 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Easy Updates ■ 261

■ How to Use a Paintbrush                                                                                                                 ■ How to Paint Ceilings
  1                                                2                                                3
                                                                                                                                                             2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              3

                                                                                                                                                                            1

                                                                                                                                                                                           3 × 3’

                                                                                                                                          Paint ceilings with a roller handle extension. Use eye protection while painting overhead. Start at the corner farthest from the
                                                                                                                                          entry door. Cut in the edges with a brush, then paint the ceiling along the narrow end in 3-ft. × 3-ft. sections. Apply the paint with
                                                                                                                                          a ­diagonal stroke. Distribute the paint evenly with back‑and‑forth strokes. For the final smoothing strokes, roll each section toward
                                                                                                                                          the wall containing the entry door, lifting the roller at the end of each sweep.
Dip the brush, loading one‑third                 Cut in the edges using the narrow              Brush wall corners using the wide
of its bristle length. Tap the bristles          edge of the brush, pressing just               edge of the brush. Paint open areas
against the side of the can. Dipping
deeper overloads the brush. Dragging
                                                 enough to flex the bristles. Keep an
                                                 eye on the paint edge, and paint with
                                                                                                with a brush or roller before the
                                                                                                brushed paint dries.
                                                                                                                                          ■ How to Paint Walls
the brush against the lip of the can             long, slow strokes. Always paint from
causes the bristles to wear.                     a dry area back into wet paint to
                                                 avoid lap marks.

■ How to Paint With a Paint Roller
  1                                                                     2

                                                                                                                                                                                  2 × 4’

                                                                                                3               1             2
                           1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                3

                                                                                                                                                                                     1

                                                                                                                                                                                     2

                                                                                                                                          Paint walls in 2-ft. × 4-ft. sections. Start in an upper corner, cutting in the ceiling and wall corners with a brush,
With the loaded roller, make a diagonal sweep (1)                     Draw the roller straight down (2) from the top of the
                                                                                                                                          then rolling the section. Make the initial diagonal roller stroke from the bottom of the section upward, to avoid dripping paint.
about 4 feet long on the surface. On walls, roll upward on the        diagonal sweep. Shift the roller to the beginning of the
                                                                                                                                          Distribute the paint evenly with horizontal strokes, then finish with downward sweeps of the roller. Next, cut in and roll the section
first stroke to avoid spilling paint. Use slow roller strokes to      diagonal and roll up (3) to complete the unloading of the roller.
                                                                                                                                          directly underneath. Continue with adjacent areas, cutting in and rolling the top sections before the bottom sections. Roll all finish
avoid splattering.                                                    Distribute paint over the rest of the section with horizontal
                                                                                                                                          strokes toward the floor.
                                                                      back‑and‑forth strokes.

262 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Easy Updates ■ 263

Childproofing                                                                                                                    Kitchen Safety ▸
                                                                                                                                 The main dangers in the kitchen are extreme heat, sharp

F   lames, sharp knives, toxic cleaners––it's no wonder                                                                          objects, and poisons. You can also avert tragedy by simply
    the kitchen is one of the most dangerous rooms                                                                               being consistent about the following:
in your house. Here, we'll present a variety of ways to
childproof your kitchen. Some projects take just a few                                                                           Turn pot handles: When cooking, always turn your pot
seconds. Others, like picking the right cabinet latches,                                                                         and pan handles toward the back of the stove to minimize
require a little more planning. However, the extra                                                                               the risk of hot food pouring onto a child.
effort you take to keep your child out of harm's way is
                                                                                                                                 Keep cords out of reach: Children who have access
time well spent.
                                                                                                                                 to cords may pull kitchen appliances down on top of
     There are many childproofing gadgets and safety
                                                                                                                                 themselves. Never let cords, including telephone cords,
devices you can buy for your kitchen that are very
                                                                                                                                 dangle freely.
simple to install and use. In fact, many require no
tools at all.
                                                                                                                                 Remove tablecloths and runners: As soon as children
                                                                                                                                 can crawl, they start pulling on everything within reach.
                                                                                                                                 Anything that is sitting on a tablecloth, such as a hot cup
                                                                                                                                 of coffee or sharp centerpiece, is in danger of landing on a
                                                                                                                                 child that reaches for a tablecloth.
    Poison Control ▸
                                                                                                                                 Guard your garbage: Put your garbage in a place your
                                                              Appliance latches and straps are installed on refrigerators,       child cannot reach. Equip your garbage container with a
    According to Consumer Product Safety Commission,
                                                              freezers, microwaves, ovens, dishwashers, and display
    more than one million poisonings of children under                                                                           latch and do not forget to secure it.
                                                              cabinets. There are many styles of latches and straps to
    the age of five are reported each year. In fact, about    choose from. Some hold up much better than others. Only
                                                              buy latches and straps specifically designed for the type of       Skip refrigerator magnets: Small magnets on
    90% of all accidental poisonings occur in the home,
                                                              appliance you want to secure. For instance, the latch (shown       refrigerators and bulletin boards can pose a choking
    and the typical victim is a child under the age of six.
                                                              above) is designed for refrigerators and will not withstand oven   hazard. Magnets shaped like food are especially tempting.
    More children die of poisoning each year than of all
                                                              heat.
    infectious diseases combined.                                                                                                                                                               Fire extinguishers: Keep a working fire extinguisher
                                                                                                                                 Bathing Safety: Never bathe a child in the kitchen sink        rated for kitchen use in an accessible spot. On the side
                                                                                                                                 while the dishwasher is running. Hot water from the            of a wall cabinet near (but not directly above) the stove is
    Poisons can be found all over your home, but the
                                                                                                                                 dishwasher may back up into the sink, scalding your baby.      a good choice. Look for an ABC extinguisher for general
    most dangerous poisons are generally found in                                                                                                                                               kitchen use.
    the bathroom, garage, and kitchen. Almost every
    household cleanser is toxic to some extent. Plus,
    there are many other common items found in
    kitchens that are also poisonous. For instance, did you
    know vanilla extract consumed in large quantities can
    poison a child?

    When poison-proofing your kitchen, start with the
    most obvious hazards. For most parents, the search
    begins under the kitchen sink. Next, really think about
                                                                                                                                                                                                Cabinet safety latches are one of the most important
    what is in your kitchen. What do you need? What do
                                                                                                                                                                                                childproofing devices used in a kitchen. They effectively
    you no longer use?                                                                                                                                                                          keep children out of drawers and cabinets, but they are
                                                                                                                                                                                                not "one size fits all." In fact, many kitchens require at
    Finally, be prepared. Post the number of your local                                                                                                                                         least two different types of latches to fit the various types
    poison control center near your phone. You can also                                                                                                                                         of drawers and cabinets. After installing the two-part
                                                                                                                                                                                                safety latches, test your work by opening and closing the
    receive help from the American Association of Poison
                                                                                                                                                                                                drawer a few times. The two pieces should latch tightly
    Control Centers’ national emergency hotline. Their        Stove knob covers: These plastic covers keep the
                                                                                                                                                                                                when the drawer closes. It should not reopen without the
                                                              controls on an oven from being turned. They are literally a
    number is (800) 222-1222.                                                                                                                                                                   proper pressure to unlock.
                                                              snap to install. Also consider installing stove knob covers on
                                                              outdoor grills.

264 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Easy Updates ■ 265

Convert a Closet to Pull-out Pantry                                                                                      ■ How to Install a Pullout Pantry
                                                                                                                           1                                                                 2
Y    ou can transform a small walk-in closet into
     a highly efficient pullout pantry by replacing
ordinary shelving with slide-out drawers. This is a
                                                            than simply framing. A solid wall surface prevents
                                                            items from falling off shelves. Closet pantries come in
                                                            many shapes and sizes. The pantry we are remodeling
great way to customize your kitchen and make it more        is a 24 × 24" pantry with only a slight setback and
user-friendly. You can find slide-out drawers for do-it-    shelves only along the back.
yourself installation at online sellers. Look for shelves
and rollers that are rated to 75 or 100 pounds so you
don't have to worry about overload.
     There are many options when planning a project
                                                                Tools & Materials ▸
such as this. You can purchase shelf rollers that mount
                                                                Stud finder               2×4
to the back of the closet and to the doorframe, or you
                                                                Tape measure              Lattice trim
can purchase shelf rollers that attach to the closet
                                                                Level                     Shelves
walls of the pantry. Each requires some modification
                                                                Table saw                 Roller hardware
to the closet structure. This project uses side-mounted
                                                                1×4
rollers. If you have a pantry with sides that are set
back from the door to accommodate shelves along
the sides as well, you will need to build out the wall
                                                                                                                         Remove any existing shelves from the closet. Use a 		             Mark the hardware locations. First, measure the setback
surfaces of the side walls to be flush with the door                                                                     stud finder to locate the studs on the side walls. Mark the       of the wall from the door frame on each side. Include the
frame. It is best to create a solid wall surface, rather                                                                 locations of the studs. Measure the width of the door opening.    doorstop trim in your measurement. This depth equals the
                                                                                                                         Make sure to measure at more than one location in case the        thickness of the spacers you will need for mounting the roller
                                                                                                                         door opening is not true. Use this measurement to order the       hardware. Mark the locations of each shelf on the side walls.
                                                                                        A group of pull-out pantry       sliding shelves.                                                  Use a carpenter's level or laser level to make sure your shelf
                                                                                       trays dramatically increases                                                                        marks are level.
                                                                                       the storage capabilities of the
                                                                                       former closet.
                                                                                                                           3                                                                 4

                                                                                                                         Install spacer blocks. Cut the spacers to length from             Assemble and install the shelves. Mount the roller hardware
                                                                                                                         material of the appropriate thickness, as determined by your      to the spacers. Check for level using a carpenter's level or
                                                                                                                         measurements. If you have a table saw, you can rip spacers        torpedo level. Install the shelves on the rollers.
                                                                                                                         to thickness, otherwise use combinations of 1 x 4, 2 x 4, and
                                                                                                                         lattice trim to achieve the desired depth. Mount the spacers to
                                                                                                                         the studs, centered over the shelf height lines.

266 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Easy Updates ■ 267

New Banquette                                                                                                                 ■ How to Build a Banquette
                                                                                                                                                             C
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Cutting List ▸
                                                                                                                                  E         E         E                  E

A    lmost everyone loves sitting in a booth at a
     restaurant—why not have one at home? Aside
from providing an intimate, cozy setting for eating,
                                                           booth, carefully remove the base shoe or molding
                                                           along both walls using a pry bar. Using a stud finder,
                                                           mark the stud locations along both walls. Use masking
                                                                                                                                                                                                                       Part

                                                                                                                                                                                                                         A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Name

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 Kickboard, long
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     Measurements

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      15½" × 60"
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Material

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    ¾" plywood
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Number

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      1

games, or homework, a banquette or booth solves a          tape to mark the stud locations to avoid marking on                                                                                                           B        Kickboard, short    15½" × 42"    ¾" plywood        1
                                                                                                                                                                 A
                                                                                                                                    E
critical space issue. An L-shaped booth eliminates the     the wall surface.                                                                                                 J                                           C       Ledger, long          60"		        2 × 4		           1
                                                                                                                                                FRAMING
space needed to pull out chairs on two sides, plus, it                                                                                          PLAN VIEW
                                                                                                                                                                                                                         D        Ledger, short        42"		        2 × 4		           1
allows children to sit closer together. Three kids can                                                                    D         E
                                                                                                                                                                                             LEFT END
                                                                                                                                                                                             ELEVATION
occupy booth space that is smaller than that required                                                                                                                            K                                       E       Braces                16½"		       2 × 4		           8
for two kids on two chairs. This project can add even          Tools & Materials ▸
                                                                                                                                                                                                           I
                                                                                                                                                                                                                         F       Cleat, long           60"		        2 × 2		           1
more usable space by creating a roll-out storage unit                                                                               E                                            D
                                                               Tape measure           ⁄4" paintable interior plywood
                                                                                      3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                         G        Cleat, short         42"		        2 × 2		           1
under the booth seats.
                                                               Stud finder            2 × 4 lumber                                  E
     This project creates an L-shaped, built-in booth in                                                                                                                                                       E         H        Seat, long           22" × 60"    ¾" plywood        1
                                                               Pry bar                1 × 2 lumber
a kitchen corner. It does not show you how to redirect                                                                                                                                                         B
                                                               Circular saw           #8 screws (1 5⁄8", 2", 21⁄2", 3")                                                                      18”                          I       Seat, short          22" × 38"*   ¾" plywood        1
air vents or electrical outlets. Make sure you take into                                                                      LEFT SIDE ELEVATION
                                                               Cordless screwdriver   1 ⁄2" finish head screws
                                                                                          1
                                                                                                                                                             J                                                           J       Seat backs            60" × 24"    ¾" plywood        2
account the thickness of cushion foam if you plan on
                                                               Carpenter’s square     Finish nails
upholstering the backs. The plans assume you’ll use                                                                                                                                                            J
                                                                                                                                                                                                                         K       Seat cleats           60"*		       1 × 2 		          2
                                                               Level                  Edge banding
2" foam for seat cushions and back cushions. Thicker                                                                                                                                                               K
                                                               Bevel gauge            Trim molding                                                                                                                       L       End pieces            20" × 40"*   ¾" plywood        2
cushions will make the bench too shallow. Booth
                                                               Compass                Painter’s caulk                                                                                                 E
seating is most comfortable if the seats are 16 to 19"                                                                                                               E                       E                     H
                                                                                                                                                                                     I                                 * cut to fit
                                                               Jigsaw                 Wood putty                                                     E
deep. The total height for the seat should be 18” to                                                                                                                                                           C
                                                               Hammer                 Paint
19" to fit a standard 29"-tall table.
                                                               Masking tape
     This project is designed to be painted, but if you
                                                                                                                                                                                                     18”
wish to match your wood kitchen cabinets, you can
use veneer plywood. Before beginning to build the                                                                                                                                                F
                                                                                                                                                                                                     A             L
                                                                                                                                                 D       B               G

                                                                                                                                1                                                                                            2

                                                                                                                              Cut the kickboards, ledgers, and braces to length. Attach                                Cut the long cleat to length. Measure 18" out from
                                                                                                                              braces at each end of a ledger using two 2 ⁄2" screws. Evenly
                                                                                                                                                                                         1                             the wall and draw a line parallel to the wall. Align the cleat
                                                                                                                              space the other braces and attach. Attach the kickboard to the                           with the inside edge of the line and attach to the floor
                                                                                                                              braces using 15⁄8" screws. Use a carpenter’s or combination                              using 2½" screws.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 (continued)
                                                                                                                              square to make sure all joints are squared.

268 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Easy Updates ■ 269

  3                                                                  4                                                                 8                                             9                                                10

Turn the brace and the kickboard assembly right side up            Assemble the short bench and attach it to the studs and           Lean the second back against the              Place the end blanks against                     Before attaching the ends, use
and place against the wall and cleat. Check for level and make     cleat following steps 1 through 3. Make sure the second bench     wall with its base 6" from the wall.          each end and trace the bench                     the jigsaw to radius the pointed
sure that the kickboard butts firmly against the cleat. Attach     butts firmly against the first bench.                             Slide the short back cleat behind the         profile. Create a rounded or angular             bench ends to prevent bruises. Apply
the ledger to the studs using two 3" screws per stud. Attach                                                                         back and mark its location. Use a             bench end that extends at least                  wood glue to the ends of the bench
the kickboard to the cleat using 15⁄8" screws.                                                                                       compass to scribe the angle of the            11⁄2" beyond the bench profile. This             backs, kickboard, and bench tops.
                                                                                                                                     long back onto the short back.                “lip” will prevent the cushions from             Attach the ends to the braces and
                                                                                                                                     Cut along this mark using a circular          slipping off the end. Cut the bench              bench using finish head screws every
                                                                                                                                     saw. Attach the cleat and seat back                                                            6" to 8". Apply edge banding to the
                                                6                                            7
                                                                                                                                                                                   ends, using a jigsaw.
  5                                                                                                                                  as in step 7.                                                                                  bench ends.

                                                                                                                                       11                                                                                                              End panel
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       cut out for
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       storage
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       access

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               ¾” MDF

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Castors

Attach the long bench top using               Lean one seat back against the wall          Attach the cleat to the seat top,                                                                                              Reuse cutout portion
15⁄8" screws. Center the screws over          so the bottom edge is 6" from the            using 15⁄8" screws. Make sure the                                                                                              of end panel as drawer cap
the braces and not the kickboard.             wall. Slide the long back cleat behind       cleat is parallel to the wall. Apply
Measure from the edge of the long             the back and mark its location. Use          edge banding to the top edge of the
                                                                                                                                     Attach the molding of your choice to the front edges of the bench with          Variation: A wheeled drawer can add some
bench to the outside edge of the              a bevel gauge to determine the edge          back. Replace the back and attach it
                                                                                                                                     finish nails. Reattach the base molding if desired, or use trim molding         storage space to your banquette. Before attaching
brace for the exact length of the             bevel for the back. Remove the back          to the cleat using 15⁄8" screws. Attach   to create panels, as pictured here. Fill all screw holes with wood putty,       the bench end, cut out an opening. Create a box
short bench. Cut and attach the short         and bevel the edge with a circular           it to the wall studs using 2" screws.     and sand smooth. Run a bead of painter’s caulk along the joint between          with wheels and a drawer front to fit the opening.
bench top.                                    saw or table saw.
                                                                                                                                     the bench top and back, the joint where the two bench backs meet, and
                                                                                                                                     between the bench back and wall. Smooth with a wet finger. Paint with
                                                                                                                                     a high-quality wood primer and satin, semigloss, or gloss paint. Make
                                                                                                                                     cushions, if desired.

270 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Easy Updates ■ 271

Garden Window                                                                                                                 ■ How to Install a Garden Window
                                                                                                                                1                                                                  2
A    lthough often found in kitchens, a garden window
     is an attractive option for nearly any room in your
home. Projecting out from the wall 16" to 24", garden
                                                               Installation methods for garden windows vary by
                                                           manufacturer. Some units include a nailing flange that
                                                           attaches to the framing and holds the window against
windows add space to a room, making it feel larger.        the house. Other models hang on a separate mounting
The glass roof and box-like design make them ideal         frame that attaches to the outside of the house. In this
growing environments for plants or display areas for       project, the garden window has a built-in mounting
collectibles. Garden windows also typically include        sleeve that slides into the rough opening and is
front- or side-opening windows. These allow for            attached directly to the rough framing.
ventilation and are usually available in either awning
or casement style.
     Home stores often stock garden windows in
several common sizes. However, it may be difficult
                                                               Tools & Materials ▸
to locate a stock window that will fit in your existing        Tape measure                  Wood strips
window rough opening. In cases like this you must              Hammer                        2 × 4s
rebuild the rough opening to the proper size. It may be        Level                         Shims
worth the added expense to custom-order your garden            Framing square                Building paper
window to fit into the existing rough opening.                 Circular saw                  3" screws
                                                                                                                              Prepare the project site and remove the interior and               Check the rough opening measurements to verify the
     The large amount of glass in a garden window                                                                             exterior trim, then remove the existing window.                    correct window sizing. The rough opening should be about 1⁄2"
                                                               Wood chisel                   Drip edge                                                                                           larger than the window height and width. If necessary, attach
has a direct effect on the window’s energy efficiency.         Stapler                       Construction adhesive                                                                               wood strips to the rough framing as spacers to bring the
When purchasing a garden window, as a minimum,                 Drill and bits                4d siding nails                                                                                     opening to the required size.
look for double-pane glass with low-emissivity (low-E)         Caulking gun                  8d galvanized casing nails
coatings. More expensive super-efficient types of glass        Utility knife                 Paintable silicone caulk
are available for severely cold climates.                      Garden window kit
                                                                                                                                3                                                                  4

                                                                                A garden window’s glass roof makes
                                                                                it an ideal sunspot for houseplants, and it
                                                                                can also help a room feel larger.

                                                                                                                              Use a level to check that the sill of the rough opening is level   Insert the garden window into the opening, pressing it
                                                                                                                              and the side jambs are plumb. Use a framing square to make         tight against the framing. Support the unit with notched 2 ×
                                                                                                                              sure each corner is square. The rough framing must be in good      4s under the bottom edge of the window until it has been
                                                                                                                              condition in order to support the weight of the garden window.     fastened securely to the framing.
                                                                                                                              If the framing is severely deteriorated or out of plumb or
                                                                                                                              square, you may need to reframe the rough opening.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      (continued)

272 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Easy Updates ■ 273

  5                                                                    6                                                               9                                                                 10

Position the inside edge of the window sleeve to be                  Make sure the garden window is level, then hold a piece         Insert shims between the window sleeve and the rough              Locate and mark the studs nearest the edges of the
flush with the interior wall surface. Check the sill of the garden   of window trim in place along the exterior of the window and    frame at each hole location along the top and the sides to        window using a stud finder. Cut two pieces of siding to fit
window for level. Shim beneath the lower side of the sill, if        trace the outline onto the siding. Remove the window. Cut the   prevent bowing of the window frame. Fasten the window             behind the brackets, and tack them in place over the marked
necessary, to make it level.                                         siding down to the sheathing using a circular saw.              to the framing using 3" screws. Continue checking for level,      studs with 4d siding nails. Position the support brackets with
                                                                                                                                     plumb, and square as the screws are tightened.                    the shorter side against the siding and the longer side beneath
                                                                                                                                                                                                       the window. Fasten the brackets to the window and the studs
                                                                                                                                                                                                       using the included screws.

  7                                                                    8                                                               11                                                                12

                                                                                                                                     Cut a piece of drip edge to length, apply construction            Cut all protruding shims flush with the framing using a
Install strips of building paper between the siding and the          Drill countersunk pilot holes every 12" to 16" through the      adhesive to its top flange, and slide it under the siding above   utility knife or handsaw. Insulate or caulk the gaps between
sheathing. Wrap them around the framing and staple them in           window sleeve into the rough header, jack studs, and sill.      the window. Cut each trim piece to size. Position the trim and    the window sleeve and the wall. Finish the installation by
place. On the sides, work from the bottom up so each piece                                                                           attach it using 8d galvanized casing nails driven through pilot   reinstalling the existing interior trim or installing new trim.
overlaps the piece below. Reposition the window and reshim.                                                                          holes. Seal the edges of the trim with a bead of paintable
Make sure the space between the window and the siding is                                                                             silicone caulk approximately 3⁄8" wide.
equal to the width of the trim on all sides.

274 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Easy Updates ■ 275

Framed Soffits                                                                                                                ■ How to Install a Soffit
                                                                                                                                1                                                                      2
A    soffit is a structure that hangs down from a ceiling
     or overhang, usually filling the cornice area where
the wall meets the ceiling. You may choose to install
                                                              If you are creating a soffit that will be supporting a
                                                              ceiling cabinet from the soffit (there is no wall behind
                                                              the cabinet), you should use 2 × 4 lumber. Build new
soffits above the wall cabinets to create a solid wall        soffits over the existing wall and ceiling surfaces.
surface. You may want to add a soffit to conceal the          This is important because soffits create a pathway
ductwork from an exhaust fan. Or, you might use a             for airflow, so for insulation and fire prevention they
soffit to create a visual barrier (as well as a barrier to    should be separated from the wall and ceiling cavities.
airborne food particles, odors, and grease) between           If your kitchen remodel is starting from stud level,
the kitchen and the dining areas in an open floor             install and mud the wall and ceiling surfaces before
plan. Soffits are also great for hiding recessed lighting     building the soffits.
fixtures if it is not possible to install recessed lighting
in the existing ceiling.
     If you are installing new cabinets, the soffits
need to be built and installed first. This means you
                                                                  Tools & Materials ▸
need to do the cabinet layout on the walls, then                  Tape measure        Wallboard screws
construct the soffits, taking care to make them                   Chalkline           Cordless drill
level and plumb. Soffits above the cabinets may be                Level               Circular saw                            Mark the desired outline of the soffits onto the ceiling. Use          Build a ladderlike framework of 2 × 2s for the soffit sides. If
flush with the cabinets, extend a few inches for a                Stud finder         Utility knife                           a carpenter's square to mark square corners. Use a chalk line          you cannot find straight 2 × 2s, use a table saw to rip 2 × 4s in
slight visual reveal, or extend farther (at least 8") to          2 × 2 lumber        6", 8", and 10" mudding knives          to mark long straight sections. Use a stud finder to locate the        half. Attach the crossbars at regular intervals of 16" or 24" on
accommodate canister light fixtures.                              2 × 4 lumber        Wallboard compound
                                                                                                                              ceiling joists and the wall studs in the area of the soffits.          center using 21⁄2" screws. Create the ladder so the crossbars
     You can construct soffits with 2 × 2 lumber. Size            21⁄2" screws        Wallboard corner tape
                                                                                                                                                                                                     will not be aligned with the ceiling joists and wall studs when
the soffit based on the size of the ductwork or the                                                                                                                                                  the framework is installed.
                                                                  ⁄8" wall board
                                                                  5

lighting that will be installed, but take care not to
make them too small, as this will look unappealing.
                                                                                                                                3                                                                      4
                                                                                           Build a soffit with framing
                                                                                           lumber and drywall to open up
                                                                                           new possibilities for installing
                                                                                           task lighting or running
                                                                                           ventilation ductwork.

                                                                                                                              If the joists are perpendicular to the soffit, screw the               If the joists are parallel to the soffit location, cut 2 × 4s
                                                                                                                              soffit framework to the joists, aligned with the chalklines. If not,   to a length 11⁄2" shorter than the width of the soffit. Screw these
                                                                                                                              go to the next step.                                                   boards into the ceiling joists and toe-screw the ends into the
                                                                                                                                                                                                     ceiling wall plate.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (continued)

276 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Easy Updates ■ 277

  5                                                               6                                                                8                                                                   9

Attach the soffit framework to the ends of the 2 × 4s with      Use a level or laser level to mark the wall even with the        Install lighting or ductwork, if needed. Extend the                 Finish installing lights, and then check to make sure they
drywall screws.                                                 bottom of the installed soffit framework. Cut 2 × 2s to the      mounting bars on recessed fixtures to reach framing members.        work. Once you’ve determined that the lights work properly,
                                                                length of the soffit and attach this cleat to the wall aligned                                                                       have the work inspected by an electrician and/or a local
                                                                with the mark.                                                                                                                       building inspector. With approval, you can begin to close
                                                                                                                                                                                                     up the soffit.

    Tip ▸                                                         7                                                                10                                                                  11
    If the joists are parallel to the soffit and the soffit
    is less than 16" wide, such as above shallow wall
    cabinets, you may need to remove the ceiling
    surface and install crossbraces between the
    joists. Remember that the ceiling surface must be
    reinstalled as a fire block before installing the soffit.

                                                                Cut crossmembers to fit between the bottom of the                Cut and install 5⁄8" wallboard over the framework using             Apply joint compound and tape to the wallboard. Use
                                                                framework and the wall cleat. Attach the crossmembers by         wallboard screws. Attach the bottom sections first, then cut        corner tape along all the edges. Sand smooth and finish with
                                                                toe-screwing into the cleat and end screwing through the         and attach the sides. Note: Required minimum wallboard              primer and paint.
                                                                framework side. Place the crossmembers every 16" on center.      thickness is dictated by local building codes. Be sure to consult
                                                                                                                                 them before you begin installing wall coverings.

278 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Easy Updates ■ 279

Conversion Charts                                                                                                                                        Drill Bit Guide
Metric Conversions
                                                                                                                                                         Twist Bit                   Self-piloting                        Spade Bit                Adjustable Counterbore                           Hole Saw
To Convert:                   To:                        Multiply by:                To Convert:              To:                  Multiply by:

Inches                        Millimeters                25.4                        Millimeters              Inches               0.039
Inches                        Centimeters                2.54                        Centimeters              Inches               0.394
Feet                          Meters                     0.305                       Meters                   Feet                 3.28
Yards                         Meters                     0.914                       Meters                   Yards                1.09
Square inches                 Square centimeters         6.45                        Square centimeters       Square inches        0.155
Square feet                   Square meters              0.093                       Square meters            Square feet          10.8
Square yards                  Square meters              0.836                       Square meters            Square yards         1.2
Ounces                        Milliliters                30.0                        Milliliters              Ounces               .033
Pints (U.S.)                  Liters                     0.473 (lmp. 0.568)          Liters                   Pints (U.S.)         2.114 (lmp. 1.76)
Quarts (U.S.)                 Liters                     0.946 (lmp. 1.136)          Liters                   Quarts (U.S.)        1.057 (lmp. 0.88)
Gallons (U.S.)                Liters                     3.785 (lmp. 4.546)          Liters                   Gallons (U.S.)       0.264 (lmp. 0.22)
Ounces                        Grams                      28.4                        Grams                    Ounces               0.035
Pounds                        Kilograms                  0.454                       Kilograms                Pounds               2.2

Converting Temperatures                                                              Lumber Dimensions                                                   Counterbore, Shank & Pilot Hole Diameters
Convert degrees Fahrenheit (F) to degrees Celsius (C) by following this simple       Nominal - U.S.       Actual - U.S. (in inches)        Metric
                                                                                                                                                                      Screw Size                      Counterbore Diameter for                    Clearance Hole for                           Pilot Hole Diameter
formula: Subtract 32 from the Fahrenheit temperature reading. Then, multiply that    1×2                  3
                                                                                                            ⁄4 × 1 ⁄2
                                                                                                                  1
                                                                                                                                           19 × 38 mm                                                       Screw Head                               Screw Shank                    Hard Wood                  Soft Wood
number by 5⁄9. For example, 77°F - 32 = 45. 45 × 5⁄9 = 25°C.                         1×3                  3
                                                                                                            ⁄ 4 × 2 1⁄ 2                   19 × 64 mm
                                                                                     1×4                  3
                                                                                                            ⁄ 4 × 3 1⁄ 2                   19 × 89 mm                          #1                               .146 (9⁄64)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        5⁄64                            3⁄64                     1⁄32
To convert degrees Celsius to degrees Fahrenheit, multiply the Celsius temperature   1×5                  3
                                                                                                            ⁄ 4 × 4 1⁄ 2                   19 × 114 mm
reading by 9⁄5. Then, add 32. For example, 25°C × 9⁄5 = 45. 45 + 32 = 77°F.          1×6                  3
                                                                                                            ⁄ 4 × 5 1⁄ 2                   19 × 140 mm                                                          1⁄4                                     3⁄32                            3⁄64                     1⁄32
                                                                                                                                                                               #2
                                                                                     1×7                  3
                                                                                                            ⁄ 4 × 6 1⁄ 4                   19 × 159 mm
       Fahrenheit                                     Celsius                        1×8                  3
                                                                                                            ⁄ 4 × 7 1⁄ 4                   19 × 184 mm                                                          1⁄4                                     7⁄64                            1⁄16                     3⁄64
                                                                                                                                                                               #3
       55°                                                         15°               1 × 10               3
                                                                                                            ⁄ 4 × 9 1⁄ 4                   19 × 235 mm
       50°                                                         10°               1 × 12               3
                                                                                                            ⁄4 × 111⁄4                     19 × 286 mm                         #4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                1⁄4                                     1⁄8                             1⁄16                     3⁄64
       45°
       40°                                                         5°                1 1⁄ 4 × 4           1 × 3 1⁄ 2                       25 × 89 mm
       35°                                                                           1 1⁄ 4 × 6           1 × 5 1⁄ 2                       25 × 140 mm                                                          1⁄4                                     9⁄64                            5⁄64                     1⁄16
       30°
                                   Freezing                        0°                                                                                                          #5
       25°
                                                                                     1 1⁄ 4 × 8           1 × 7 1⁄ 4                       25 × 184 mm
                                                                   -5°
       20°                                                                           1 1⁄4 × 10           1 × 9 1⁄ 4                       25 × 235 mm                                                          5⁄16                                    5⁄32                            3⁄32                     5⁄64
       15°                                                         -10°                                                                                                        #6
       10°
                                                                                     1 1⁄4 × 12           1 × 111⁄4                        25 × 286 mm
       5°                                                          -15°              1 1⁄ 2 × 4           1 1⁄ 4 × 3 1⁄ 2                  32 × 89 mm                                                           5⁄16                                    5⁄32                            3⁄32                     5⁄64
       0°                                                                                                                                                                      #7
                                                                                     1 1⁄ 2 × 6           1 1⁄ 4 × 5 1⁄ 2                  32 × 140 mm
                                                                                     1 1⁄ 2 × 8           1 1⁄ 4 × 7 1⁄ 4                  32 × 184 mm                                                          3⁄8                                     11⁄64                           1⁄8                      3⁄32
                                                                                                                                                                               #8
                                                                                     1 1⁄2 × 10           1 1⁄ 4 × 9 1⁄ 4                  32 × 235 mm
                                                                                     1 1⁄2 × 12           11⁄4 × 111⁄4                     32 × 286 mm
Metric Plywood Panels                                                                                                                                                          #9
                                                                                                                                                                                                                3⁄8                                     11⁄64                           1⁄8                      3⁄32
                                                                                     2×4                  1 1⁄ 2 × 3 1⁄ 2                  38 × 89 mm
Metric plywood panels are commonly available in two sizes: 1,200 mm × 2,400
                                                                                     2×6                  1 1⁄ 2 × 5 1⁄ 2                  38 × 140 mm                                                          3⁄8                                     3⁄16                            1⁄8                      7⁄64
mm and 1,220 mm × 2,400 mm, which is roughly equivalent to a 4 × 8-ft. sheet.                                                                                                  #10
                                                                                     2×8                  1 1⁄ 2 × 7 1⁄ 4                  38 × 184 mm
Standard and Select sheathing panels come in standard thicknesses, while Sanded
                                                                                     2 × 10               1 1⁄ 2 × 9 1⁄ 4                  38 × 235 mm                                                          1⁄2                                     3⁄16                            5⁄32                     9⁄64
grade panels are available in special thicknesses.                                                                                                                             #11
                                                                                     2 × 12               11⁄2 × 111⁄4                     38 × 286 mm
Standard Sheathing Grade                        Sanded Grade
                                                                                     3×6                  2 1⁄ 2 × 5 1⁄ 2                  64 × 140 mm
7.5 mm               (5⁄16 in.)               6 mm              (4⁄17 in.)                                                                                                     #12                              1⁄2                                     7⁄32                            9⁄64                     1⁄8
                                                                                     4×4                  3 1⁄ 2 × 3 1⁄ 2                  89 × 89 mm
9.5 mm               (3⁄8 in.)                8 mm              (5⁄16 in.)
                                                                                     4×6                  3 1⁄ 2 × 5 1⁄ 2                  89 × 140 mm
12.5 mm              (1⁄2 in.)                11 mm             (7⁄16 in.)
15.5 mm              (5⁄8 in.)                14 mm             (9⁄16 in.)
18.5 mm              (3⁄4 in.)                17 mm             (2⁄3 in.)            Liquid Measurement Equivalents                                      Abrasive Paper Grits - (Aluminum Oxide)
20.5 mm              (13⁄16 in.)              19 mm             (3⁄4 in.)            1 Pint                   = 16 Fluid Ounces    = 2 Cups
22.5 mm              (7⁄8 in.)                21 mm             (13⁄16 in.)          1 Quart                  = 32 Fluid Ounces    = 2 Pints                 Very Coarse                             Coarse                           Medium                            Fine                           Very Fine
25.5 mm              (1 in.)                  24 mm             (15⁄16 in.)          1 Gallon                 = 128 Fluid Ounces   = 4 Quarts
                                                                                                                                                                     12 - 36                          40 - 60                          80 - 120                             150 - 180                      220 - 600

280 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Conversion Charts ■ 281

Photo Resources                                                                                                                      Photo Credits
Aristokraft Cabinetry Styles, Solutions and More                 iStock Photo                                                        p. 3 LivedIn Images                          p. 85 LivedIn Images
www.aristokraft.com                                              www.istockphoto.com                                                 p. 4 Eric Roth                               p. 86 © Tony Giammarino
p. 40 (left)                                                     p. 6, 11 (top left), 12 (lower), 16 (lower right), 17 (top left),                                                www.TonyGiammarino.com
                                                                 160 (lower), 228 (inset lower), 246                                 p. 6 iStock Photo
Armstrong Flooring                                                                                                                                                                p. 88 (lower) Cambria
                                                                                                                                     p. 8
www.armstrong.com/flooring                                       Kohler Plumbing                                                     (top) Todd Caverly                           p. 89 (top) DuPont Corian
p. 220, 221 (top), 230 (left)                                    Fixtures, Faucets, Furniture, Engines, Generators                   (lower left) © Giammarino/design K. Kowach   p. 90 (lower) Green Mountain Soapstone Co.
                                                                 www.kohler.com                                                      www.TonyGiammarino.com
Broan-NuTone                                                     p. 16 (top left & right), 17 (lower right), 120, 196, 208, 245      (lower right) Plato Woodworking              p. 96 © Eric Roth for Thomas Buekborough
Bath Fans, Ventilation Fans, Range Hoods, Trash                                                                                                                                   p. 124 (top) Julie Caruso
Compactors                                                       LivedIn Images                                                      p. 9
www.broan.com                                                    www.livedinimages.com                                               (top) Eric Roth                              p. 129 IKEA
p. 250                                                           p. 18, 85, 219, 224, 240                                            (lower left) © Tony Giammarino
                                                                                                                                                                                  p. 130 Todd Caverly
                                                                                                                                     www.TonyGiammarino.com
Cambria Natural Quartz Countertops                               Karen Melvin Photography                                            (lower right) Urban Homes, NY                p. 131
www.cambriausa.com                                               www.karenmelvin.com                                                                                              (top left) Shutterstock
                                                                                                                                     p. 10
p. 88 (lower)                                                    p. 243 (left)                                                                                                    (top right) IKEA
                                                                                                                                     (top) Todd Caverly
                                                                                                                                                                                  (lower left) © Tony Giammarino
                                                                                                                                     (lower) NKBA/Marcy Walls
Julie Caruso, photographer                                       National Kitchen & Bath Association (NKBA)                                                                       www.TonyGiammarino.com
p. 124 (top)                                                     www.nkba.org                                                        p. 11                                        (lower right) IKEA
                                                                 p. 10 (lower) Marcy Walls                                           (top left) iStock Photo                      p. 146 GE Appliances
Todd Caverly, architectural photographer                                                                                             (top right) GE Appliances
www.toddcaverly.com                                              Neil Kelly Cabinets                                                 (lower) Jessie Walker                        p. 153 (lower right) GE Appliances
p. 8 (top), 10 (top), 30, 130                                    www.neilkelly.com                                                   p. 12                                        p. 154
                                                                 p. 16 (lower left), 242                                             (top) Photolibrary                           (top) © Tony Giammarino
Diamond Cabinets                                                                                                                     (lower) iStock Photo                         www.TonyGiammarino.com
www.diamondcabinets.com                                          Photolibrary
p. 40 (right)                                                    www.photolibrary.com                                                p. 13                                        p. 156 Photos courtesy of Price Pfister
                                                                 p. 12 (top), 14 (lower left), 15 (lower), 17 (top right)            (top) IKEA                                   p. 157 (right) Energy Star / Department of Energy
DuPont Corian                                                                                                                        (lower) IKEA
www2.Dupont.com                                                  Plato Woodwork, Inc.                                                                                             p. 160 (lower) iStock Photo
                                                                                                                                     p. 14
p. 89 (top)                                                      www.platowoodwork.com                                                                                            p. 165 GE Appliances
                                                                                                                                     (top) Shutterstock
                                                                 p. 8 (lower right)
                                                                                                                                     (lower left) Photolibrary                    p. 178 (top left) GE Appliances
Eco-Friendly
www.ecofriendlyflooring.com                                      Price Pfister                                                       (lower right) IKEA                           p. 196 Kohler
p. 223 (right)                                                   Kitchen Faucets, Bathroom Faucets, Showerheads,                     p. 15                                        p. 208 (top) Kohler
                                                                 Accessories                                                         (top) Shutterstock
Eco-Timber                                                       www.pricepfister.com                                                (lower) Photolibrary                         p. 212 General Electric
Sustainable Hardwood and Bamboo Flooring                         p. 156 (all)                                                                                                     p. 219 LivedIn Images
www.ecotimber.com                                                                                                                    p. 16
p. 223 (left)                                                    Eric Roth, photographer                                             (top left & right) Kohler                    p. 220 Armstrong Flooring
                                                                 www.ericrothphoto.com                                               (lower left) Neil Kelley Cabinets            p. 221 (top) Armstrong Flooring
Energy Star                                                      p. 4, 9 (top), 96 for Thomas Buekborough                            (lower right) iStock Photo
www.energystar.gov                                                                                                                                                                p. 223
                                                                                                                                     p. 17                                        (left) Eco-timber
p. 157 (right)                                                   Andrea Rugg, photographer                                           (top left) iStock Photo
                                                                 www.andrearugg.com                                                                                               (right) Eco-friendly
                                                                                                                                     (top right) Photolibrary
Tony Giammarino, photographer                                    p. 17 (lower left)                                                  (lower left) Andrea Rugg                     p. 224 LivedIn Images
www.tonygiammarino.com                                                                                                               (lower right) Kohler                         p. 228 (inset lower) iStock Photo
p. 8 (lower left) design K. Kowach, 9 (lower left), 86, 131      Shutterstock
(lower left), 154 (top)                                          www.shutterstock.com                                                p. 18 LivedIn Images                         p. 230 (left) Armstrong Flooring
                                                                 p. 14 (top), 15 (top), 122 (lower right), 131 (top left)            p. 30 Todd Caverly                           p. 241 LivedIn Images
GE Appliances (General Electric)
www.geappliances.com                                             SieMatic                                                            p. 31 GE Appliances                          p. 242 Neil Kelly Cabinets
p. 11 (top right), 31, 146, 178 (top left)                       www.siematic.com                                                    p. 37 SieMatic                               p. 243
                                                                 p. 37                                                                                                            (left) © Karen Melvin Photography
Green Mountain Soapstone Co.                                                                                                         p. 40
                                                                                                                                     (left) Aristokraft                           (right) Urban homes, NY
www.greenmountainsoapstone.com                                   Urban Homes
p. 90 (lower)                                                    www.uhny.com                                                        (right) Diamond                              p. 245 Kohler
                                                                 p. 9 (lower right), 243 (right)                                     p. 56 IKEA                                   p. 246 iStock Photo
IKEA Home Furnishings
www.ikea.com                                                     Jessie Walker, photographer                                         p. 57                                        p. 250 (lower) Broan NuTone
p. 13 (top & lower), 14 (lower right), 56, 57 (top left), 129,   www.jessiewalker.com                                                (top left) IKEA                              p. 259 IKEA
131 (top right), 258                                             p. 11 (lower)                                                       (top right) Kohler

282 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Photo Credits ■ 283

Resources                                                                                                             Index
American Institute of Architects                            Kitchen Cabinet Manufacturers Association                 A                                              base cabinets, 52–53                  granite countertops, installing,
800-242-3837                                                703-264-1690                                                                                             corner cabinets, 48                      121-123
                                                                                                                      Accent lighting, 243
www.aia.org                                                 www.kcma.org
                                                                                                                      Accessibility issues                           face-frame cabinets, 54–55            laminate countertops
                                                            Kohler                                                       cabinets, 40–41                             freestanding cabinets, 56–57             building own
American Lighting Association
                                                            800-456-4537                                                 sinks, 155                                  preparing walls, 46–47                		      about, 102
800-274-4484
www.americanlightingassoc.com                               www.kohler.com                                            Air-conditioning & building codes,23           removing old, 44–45                   		      steps in, 104–108
                                                                                                                      Ambient lighting, 243, 244                     wall cabinets, 49–51                  		      tips, 103
American Society of Interior Designers                      National Kitchen & Bath Association (NKBA)                Appliances                                 lighting under                               installing, 93–95
202-546-3480                                                800-843-6522                                                 childproofing, 264, 265                     about, 244, 254                       overview of materials for, 85–91
www.asid.org                                                www.nkba.org                                                 costs, 31                                   installing hardwired, 255–257         post-form countertops,
                                                                                                                         energy saving, 157                      making island from, 132–133                  installing, 93–95
Association of Home Appliance Manufacturers                 National Wood Flooring Association                           industry standards, 21                  painting, 82–83                           tile countertops, building
202-872-5955                                                800-422-4556                                                 overview of types, 152–154              raising, 66                                  about, 110–111
www.aham.org                                                                                                                                                     sizes, 38                                    bi-level for islands, 134–137
                                                            www.woodfloors.org                                           stainless steel, cleaning, 152
                                                                                                                      Apron sinks, installing                    stock vs. custom, 38                         steps in, 113–119
Black & Decker Corp.
Power tools, home products                                  Repair-It-All                                                about, 190–191                          See also Custom cabinets                     tips, 112
800-544-6986                                                (Vinyl & leather repair kits, page 109)                      in butcher block countertops,         Canister lighting                         Country style kitchen ideas, 8, 16
www.blackanddecker.com                                      440-774-3900                                                    192–195                              about, 243, 250–251                     Crown molding, attaching to
                                                            www.repair-it-all.com                                                                                installing, 252–253                     cabinets, 67
Center for Inclusive Design & Environmental Access                                                                                                             Carbon water filters, installing          Cup hinges, adjusting, 55
School of Architecture and Planning University of Buffalo   Resilient Floor Covering Institute                        B                                          under-counter, 210–211                  Custom cabinets
716-829-3485                                                301-340-8580                                              Backsplashes, tile                       Ceiling fixtures                            attaching crown molding, 67
www.ap.buffalo.edu                                          www.rfci.com                                                 about, 124                              advantages & disadvantages,               building
                                                                                                                         installing, 125–127                         241, 243                                 about, 70
Center for Universal Design                                 Rockler Woodworking & Hardware                               options, 111                            installing, 246–249                          base cabinets, 73, 78–91
NC State University                                         (Glass clips, page 67)
919-515-3082                                                                                                          Bamboo, about, 17, 223                   Ceilings, painting, 263                        cutting sheet goods, 71
                                                            800-279-4441                                              Banquette, building, 268–271             Childproofing, 264–265                         hanging wall cabinets, 72, 74-77
www.design.ncsu.edu
                                                            www.rockler.com                                           Base cabinets                            Classic kitchen ideas, 9, 15                   overlay doors, 71
Construction Materials Recycling Association                                                                             building custom, 73, 78–91            Codes & standards, 20–23                    costs, 70
630-548-4510                                                The Tile Council of America                                  freestanding, 56–57                   Commercial-style kitchen idea, 14           display idea, 66
www.cdrecycling.org                                         864-646-8453                                                 installing new, 52–53                 Concrete countertops                        installing glass panel doors in, 67
                                                            www.tileusa.com                                              making island from, 132–133             about, 91                                 vs. stock cabinets, 38
Energy & Environmental Building Association                                                                           Bi-level tile islands,building,134–137     islands, building
952-881-1098                                                U.S. Environmental Protection Agency-Indoor Air Quality                                                  about, 138–139
                                                                                                                      Building codes, 22–23
www.eeba.com                                                www.epa.gov                                               Building inspectors, 35                        steps in, 140–145                   D
Energy Star                                                                                                           Butcher block countertops                Contemporary kitchens                     Dishwashers
888-762-7937                                                                                                             about, 89, 96–97                        frameless cabinets for, 39                about, 153, 164
www.energystar.gov                                                                                                       building, 98–101                        freestanding cabinets for, 56–57          installing on raised platform,
                                                                                                                         installing apron sinks in, 192–195      ideas, 12, 17                                170-171
Kampel Enterprises                                                                                                                                             Cooktops, 152                               loading efficiently, 165
(SeamFil laminate repair compound, page 109)                                                                                                                   Cork flooring, about, 223                   replacing, 166–169
800-837-4971                                                                                                          C                                        Corner cabinets, installing, 48           Display cabinets, making, 66
www.kampelent.com                                                                                                     Cabinets                                 Costs                                     Doors
                                                                                                                        accessibility of, 40–41                  of building custom cabinets               building codes, 23
                                                                                                                        childproofing, 265                       from scratch, 70                          installing glass panel cabinet, 67
                                                                                                                        costs, 70                                Energy Star appliances and, 157         Drains & traps
                                                                                                                        face-frame vs. frameless, 39             estimating, 31–32                         about, 200–201
                                                                                                                        industry standards, 21–22                financing, 33                             hooking up sink, 202–203
                                                                                                                        installing                             Countertops                               Drawers, building overlay, 81
                                                                                                                           glass panel doors in, 67              butcher block countertops               Drawer slides, 62
                                                                                                                           pull-down storage, 64–65                  building, 98–101                    Drop-in self-rimming sinks,
                                                                                                                           slide-out storage, 60–63                  installing apron sinks in,192–195     installing, 182–183
                                                                                                                           swing-up shelves, 58–59               concrete countertops for islands        Drying racks, idea, 11
                                                                                                                        installing new                               about, 138–139
                                                                                                                           about, 42–43, 48                          building, 140–145

284 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Index ■ 285

E                                           		 no-glue, 228–229                      		     steps in, 140–145               N                                           vent fans for                             		      in butcher block
Eat-in kitchens                             		 perimeter-bond, 226–227                  two-level tile, 134–137             National Electric Code (NEC), 23               about, 154, 178                        		        countertops 192-195
   building banquette, 268–271              overview of materials for, 220–223       creating from stock-cabinet, 132-133   Natural lighting, 245                          installing, 180–181                       self-rimming drop-in, 182–183
   ideas, 12, 16                         Floor plans, 24–29                          ideas, 130–131                         Natural stone countertops, about, 91      Recessed canister lighting                     undermount
   industry standards for eating         Fluorescent lighting                        industry standards, 22                                                             about, 243, 250–251                       		      about, 184
      surface, 21, 22                       disadvantages, 241                       vent hoods for                                                                     installing, 252–253                       		      making cutout template,
Edge-grain (wood), 97                       under-cabinet, 244                          about, 146                          O                                         Refrigerators                               		        185-186
Electrical service                       Food disposers                                 installing, 147–149                 Open plan kitchen layout, 18, 19            about, 153                                		      steps in, 187–189
   building codes, 23                       about, 154, 172–173                                                             Ovens, about, 152–153                       childproofing, 265                     Slide-out storage shelving
   childproofing, 265                       installing, 174–177                                                             Overlay doors, building, 71                 icemakers                                 about, 60–61
   switch receptacle wiring, 204         Framed soffits, installing, 276–279     L                                          Overlay drawers, building, 81                  about, 160                             installing, 62–63
Electric ranges                          Freestanding cabinets, installing,      Laminate countertops                                                                      installing, 161–163                 Small kitchens
   about, 152                               56–57                                   about, 87, 92                                                                     Resilient tile flooring                     ideas, 9, 13
   installing, 158                       Free-standing furnishings idea, 14         building own                            P                                           about, 221, 230                           layout, 18, 19
Elevation plans, 24–29                                                                 about, 102                           Painting                                    installing, 231–233                    Soffits, installing framed, 276–279
End-grain (wood), 97                                                                   steps in, 104–108                        cabinets, 82–83                       Reverse-osmosis filtration systems,      Solid surface countertops, 88, 185
Energy Star & Energy Guide labels, 157   G                                             tips, 103                                ceilings, 263                           installing point-of-use, 212–216       Stainless steel countertops, about, 89
Engineered stone countertops,            Galley kitchens                            installing post-form, 93–95                 ideas, 9, 14, 15                      Revolving credit, about, 33              Stock cabinets. See Cabinets
   about, 91                               ideas, 9, 13                             repairing & maintaining, 109                walls, 160–162                        Rustic style kitchen ideas, 8, 16        Stone countertops
Environmentally friendly                   layout, 18, 19                        Laminate flooring                          Pantry, making pull-out, 266–267                                                      about, 91, 120
   appliances, 157                       Garden windows                             about, 222, 234                         Paper-resin countertops, about, 91                                                    idea for islands, 131
   lighting, 243, 244                      about, 272                               installing floating floor               Planning                                  S                                           installing, 121–123
   making countertops more, 91             installing, 273–275                         steps in, 236–237                        budgeting, 30–32                      Safety, 264–265                          Storage
European hinges, adjusting, 55           Gas ranges                                    tips, 235                                codes & standards, 20, 21–23          Seating areas                               idea for open, 17
Eurostyle/European-style cabinets,         about, 152                                  using adhesive, 239                      financing options, 33                    building banquette, 268–271              installing
   39, 57                                  installing, 159                             working around obstacles, 238            layouts, 18–19, 20–21                    idea, 10                                    pull-down shelving, 64–65
                                         Glass composite countertops,            Layouts, 18–21                                 timeline for project, 34–35           Self-rimming drop-in sinks,                    slide-out shelving, 60–63
                                           about, 91                             Lighting                                   Plans                                        installing, 182–183                         swing-up shelves, 58–59
F                                        Glass panel cabinet doors                  building codes, 23                          about, 24–25                          Shaker style kitchen idea, 8                   vertical dividers, 68–69
Face-frame cabinets                        ideas, 8, 16                             canister                                    creating, 26–27                       Sheet goods, cutting, 71                    making pull-out pantry, 266–267
   installing, 54–55                       installing, 67                              about, 243, 250–251                      symbols used, 28–29                   Sheet vinyl flooring                     Stoves
   vs. frameless, 39                     Government-backed loans,                      installing, 252–253                  Plumbing, building codes for, 23             about, 221, 227                          about, 152
Face-grain (wood), 97                      about, 33                                categories, 243, 244                    Point-of-use reverse-osmosis                 installing                               childproofing, 264
Faucets                                  Granite countertops                        ceiling fixtures                        filtration systems, installing, 212–216         cutting template, 25                  installing, 158–159
   about, 196                              about, 120                                  advantages & disadvantages, 		       Poison control, 264                             no-glue, 228–229                      island vent hoods, 145–149
   installing, 197–198                     installing, 121–123                              241, 243                        Portable islands, idea, 131                     perimeter-bond, 226–227               vent fans
   installing one-piece with                                                           installing, 246–249                  Post-form countertops                     Shelving                                       about, 154, 178
   sprayer, 199                                                                     fluorescent                                 about, 87, 92                            idea for open, 17                           installing, 180–181
   making knockouts, 140–141             H                                             disadvantages, 241                       installing, 93–95                        installing                            Swing-up shelves, installing in
   types of, 156                         Hardwood flooring, about, 222                 under-cabinet, 244                   Pot fillers, installing, 208–209                pull-down storage, 64–65              cabinets, 58–59
Financing options, 33                    Heating, ventilation &                     natural, 245                            Professionals, using                            slide-out storage, 60–63           Switch receptacle wiring, 204
Flooring                                   air-conditioning (HVAC) systems          undercabinet                                for designing, 24, 25                       swing-up shelves in cabinets,
   bamboo, about, 223                      building codes, 23                          about, 244, 254                          for HVAC system, 23                              58–59
   cork, about, 223                      Hinges, European, 55                          installing, 255–257                      knowing when to, 35                   Sinks                                    T
   hardwood, about, 222                  Home equity loans, about, 33               using reflection to increase, 9, 16     Pull-down storage shelving, installing,      about, 155                            Task lighting, 243, 244
   installing                            Home improvement loans, about, 33       Loans, about, 33                               64–65                                    for butcher block countertops, 97     Tile backsplashes
      laminate                           Homework areas idea, 10                 L-shape kitchen layout, 18, 19                                                          drains & traps                           about, 124
   		      about, 222, 234               Hot water dispensers                                                                                                               about, 200–201                        installing, 125–127
   		      steps in, 236–237               about, 204                                                                       Q                                               hooking up, 202–203                   options, 111
   		      tips, 235                       installing, 205–207                   M                                          Quartz countertops                           faucets                               Tile countertops
   		      using adhesive, 239                                                   Mortgage refinancing, about, 33              about, 88                                     about, 156, 196                       about, 87
   		      working around                                                        Multi-purpose kitchens                       for islands, 131                              installing, 197–198                   building
           obstacles, 238                I                                        eat-in                                                                                    installing one-piece with                about, 110–111
      resilient tile                     Icemakers                                    building banquette, 268–271                                                        		      sprayer, 199                        steps in, 113–119
   		      about, 221, 230                  about, 160                                ideas, 12, 16                         R                                               making knockouts, 140–141                tips, 112
   		      steps in, 231–233                installing, 161–163                       industry standards for eating 		      Ranges                                          types of, 156                         for islands
      sheet vinyl                        Islands                                          surface, 21, 22                     about, 152                                 ideas, 16, 17, 57                           building bi-level, 134–137
   		      about, 221, 224                  building                              entertainment idea, 10                      childproofing, 264                            installing                               idea, 131
   		      cutting template, 225               concrete                           laundry idea, 11                            installing, 158–159                           apron                                    Timeline for projects, 34–35
                                            		      about, 138–139                                                            island vent hoods, 145–149                 		      about, 190–191                Traps & drains

286 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens Index ■ 287

  about, 200–201                      installing, 180–181                  Water filters, installing
  hooking up sink, 202–203          Vent hoods for islands                   carbon under-counter, 210–211
Two-level tile islands, building,     about, 146                             reverse-osmosis filtration point-
  134–137                             installing, 147–149                       of-use systems, 212–216
                                    Ventilation                            whole-house filtration systems, 217
                                      building codes, 23                   Windows
U                                     types, 179                             building codes, 22
Undercabinet lighting               Vertical dividers, installing, 68–69     garden
  about, 244, 254                   Views, taking advantage of, 11              about, 272
  installing, 255–257                 building codes, 23                        installing, 273–275
Undermount sinks, installing          types, 179                           Wood countertops
  about, 184                        Vertical dividers, installing, 68–69     about, 89, 96–97
  making cutout template, 185–186   Views, taking advantage of, 11           building, 98–101
  steps in, 187–189                                                          installing apron sinks in, 192–195
Uniform Plumbing Codes (UPC), 23                                           Wood flooring, 222
Universal Design                    W                                      Work area idea, 10
  cabinets, 40–41                   Wall cabinets
  sinks, 155                         building custom hanging, 72,
U-shape kitchen layout, 18, 19           74–77
                                     installing new, 49–51
                                    Walls
V                                    painting, 160–162
Vent fans                            preparing for cabinet installation,
  about, 154, 178                        46–47

288 ■ the Complete Guide to Kitchens

Rather have me do it?

Kitchen upgrades add real value. I do them right.